Quarterlytics / Energy / Oil & Gas Refining & Marketing / CrossAmerica Partners LP

CrossAmerica Partners LP

capl · NYSE Energy
Claim this profile
Ticker capl
Exchange NYSE
Sector Energy
Industry Oil & Gas Refining & Marketing
Employees 179
← All annual reports
FY2014 Annual Report · CrossAmerica Partners LP
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Stability in Growth

2 0 1 4   A N N U A L   R E P O R T

Stability in Growth

To Our Unitholders:

This past year was marked by numerous accomplishments, including several acquisitions, a secondary offering, a 

continued increase in the quarterly cash distribution and CST Brands’ (NYSE: CST) completion of the purchase of 100 

percent of the membership interests of Lehigh Gas GP LLC, the general partner of Lehigh Gas Partners LP. 

On October 1, the companies announced that Lehigh Gas Partners LP changed its name to CrossAmerica Partners 

LP (NYSE: CAPL). We believe that the new name, CrossAmerica Partners, truly reflects our combined vision for growth 

of CST and CrossAmerica across North America. The acquisition of the general partner by CST provides 
the unitholders of CAPL with a symbiotic relationship with CST that will fuel the future growth of 

CrossAmerica. 

In the second quarter, we announced the acquisition of wholesale motor fuel supply contracts and motor fuel stations 

in the Chicago market and the acquisition of Petroleum Marketers, Inc. In the fourth quarter, we announced or 

completed more than $230 million in acquisitions in four separate transactions. CST and CAPL purchased the assets 

of Nice N Easy and announced an agreement to jointly purchase 22 convenience stores in San Antonio and Austin, 

Texas, from Landmark Industries. The companies also announced the first dropdown of wholesale fuel assets from 

CST. Separately, CrossAmerica announced the purchase of Erickson Oil. All of the announced transactions were 

closed during the first quarter of 2015. 

To fuel our acquisition growth during the year and beyond, we had our second follow-on offering in 
September 2014. We issued 4.1 million common units for total net proceeds to CrossAmerica of $135 million.

While 2014 was a transformational year for CrossAmerica, our commitment to our unitholders remains the 
same: to make our quarterly cash distributions and increase those distributions over time. The results 
of that commitment during 2014 were extraordinary. The total return (price appreciation plus distributions) 
of CrossAmerica units was 48.1% for 2014 versus 4.8% for the Alerian MLP Index, a widely followed 
composite index of the 50 most prominent energy MLPs, for 2014. 

As a company, we have a responsibility to give back – to energize the communities where we live and work. Our 

employees are an energetic group. Through the CrossAmerica Community Energy Program, we encourage our 

employees to put their volunteer energy to work for the good of their neighbors and the communities where they live. 

As we reflect on the last year, we are proud of our dedicated team and their numerous accomplishments, grateful for 

their dedication and tireless efforts that made these achievements possible and look forward to a successful 2015.

Kimberly S. Lubel 

Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 

Chairman of the Board

President and CEO

C R O S S A M E R I C A   P A R T N E R S   
2 0 1 4   A N N U A L   R E P O R T

 
CrossAmerica Partners LP 
at a Glance

CrossAmerica Partners, headquartered in Allentown, PA, is a leading wholesale distributor of motor fuels and owner 

and lessee of real estate used in the retail distribution of motor fuels. Its general partner, CrossAmerica GP LLC, is a 

wholly owned subsidiary of CST Brands, Inc., one of the largest independent retailers of motor fuels and convenience 

merchandise in North America. 

Formed in 2012, CrossAmerica Partners distributes fuel to more than 1,100 locations and owns or leases nearly 750 

sites in 21 states: Pennsylvania, New Jersey, Ohio, Florida, New York, Massachusetts, Kentucky, New Hampshire, 

Maine, Tennessee, Maryland, Delaware, Illinois, Indiana, West Virginia, Virginia, Texas, Minnesota, Michigan, 

Wisconsin and South Dakota. The Partnership has long-term established relationships with several major oil brands, 

including ExxonMobil, BP, Shell, Chevron, Sunoco, Valero, Gulf and Citgo. CrossAmerica Partners ranks as one of 

ExxonMobil’s largest distributors by fuel volume in the United States and in the top 10 for additional brands. For 

additional information, please visit www.crossamericapartners.com.

Total Return

CAPL

AMZ

48.1%

4.8%

Total return for CAPL is defined as distributions received per common unit during 

calendar year 2014 plus the ending price as of 12/31/14 relative to the closing price of 

CAPL on 12/31/13. The AMZ index is the Alerian MLP Index, which is widely regarded 

as the leading gauge of large- and mid-cap energy Master Limited Partnerships. The 

total return for the AMZ index is calculated based on the closing value of the AMZX (the 

total return index of the AMZ) as of 12/31/14 relative to the closing price on 12/31/13. 

Site Count

658

556

Wholesale Gallons 
Distributed

Total Fuel Gross 
Profit

887.7

68.6

637.8

44.5

12/31/2013

12/31/2014

2013

2014

2013

2014

C R O S S A M E R I C A   P A R T N E R S   
2 0 1 4   A N N U A L   R E P O R T

Board of Directors

Kimberly S. Lubel 
Chairman of the Board, President &  
Chief Executive Officer, CST Brands, Inc.

Charles M. Nifong 
Vice President, Finance &  
Chief Investment Officer

Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
President & Chief Executive Officer, 
CrossAmerica GP

Gene Edwards 1, 2 
Retired Executive Vice President &  
Chief Development Officer,  
Valero Energy Corporation

Stephen Lattig 
Vice President, Wholesale East

George W. Wilkins 
Vice President, Wholesale West

Annual Certifications

Corporate Information

Transfer Agent & Registrar 
American Stock Transfer & Trust Company 
409 Hayward Avenue N., Suite 2 
St. Paul, MN 55128

Independent Registered Public  
Accounting Firm 
Grant Thornton LLP 
2001 Market Street, Suite 700 
Philadelphia, PA 19103

Unitholder Tax Information 
phone: 1-855-820-0421 
email: CrossAmericaK1Help@deloitte.com  
web: www.partnerdatalink.com/crossamerica

Investor Relations 
Karen G. Yeakel 
Vice President, Investor Relations 
CrossAmerica Partners LP 
610-625-8126 
karen.yeakel@cstbrands.com

Corporate Headquarters 
CrossAmerica Partners LP 
645 Hamilton Street, Suite 500 
Allentown, PA 18101 
610-625-8000 

© 2015 Lehigh Gas Partners LP.  
All Rights Reserved.

For more information, please visit  

www.crossamericapartners.com

Justin A. Gannon 1, 2 
Independent Consultant & Private Investor

Clayton E. Killinger 
Senior Vice President &  
Chief Financial Officer, CST Brands

The certifications required by Section 302 
of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002  have 
been filed with the SEC and are included 
as Exhibits 31.1 and 31.2 to this  
annual report.

Stephan F. Motz 
Senior Vice President &  
Chief Development Officer, CST Brands

Forward-Looking and 
Cautionary Statements

Except for the historical information 
and discussions contained herein, 
statements contained in this annual 
report may constitute “forward-looking 
statements” within the meaning of the 
Private Securities Litigation Act of 1995. 
Achieving the results described in these 
statements involves a number of risks, 
uncertainties, and other factors that could 
cause actual results to differ materially, 
as discussed in our filings with the 
Securities and Exchange Commission, 
and beginning on page 1 of the attached 
Form 10-K.

Investor Information

A copy of our annual report on Form 
10-K is attached. Copies of our quarterly 
reports on Form 10-Q, as filed with the 
Securities and Exchange Commission, are 
available without charge to unitholders 
upon request.

Trademarks

CAPL and CrossAmerica are trademarks 
of CrossAmerica Partners LP and/or 
its affiliates. Other names and marks 
used herein may be trademarks of their 
respective owners.

John B. Reilly, III 1, 2 
President, City Center Investment 
Corporation

1 Audit Committee 
2 Conflicts Committee

Senior Executives

Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
President & Chief Executive Officer

David F. Hrinak 
Executive Vice President &  
Chief Operating Officer

Mark L. Miller 
Chief Financial Officer & Treasurer

David A. Sheaffer 
Chief Accounting Officer

John K. Hooven 
Senior Vice President, Operations

Stéphane Trudel 
Senior Vice President,  
Mergers and Acquisitions

C R O S S A M E R I C A   P A R T N E R S   
2 0 1 4   A N N U A L   R E P O R T

UNITED STATES  
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION  
Washington, D.C. 20549  

FORM 10-K  

(Mark One)  
x 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT 
OF 1934  

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014  
OR  
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE 
ACT OF 1934  

¨ 

For the transition period from                      to                       
Commission File Number: 001-35711  
CrossAmerica Partners LP  
(formerly Lehigh Gas Partners LP)  
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)  

Delaware 
(State or other jurisdiction of 
incorporation or organization) 

45-4165414 
(I.R.S. Employer 
Identification No.) 

645 Hamilton Street, Suite 500  
Allentown, PA 18101  
(610) 625-8000  
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of the registrant’s principal executive offices)  
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:  

Title of each class 
Common Units representing limited partner interests 

Name of each exchange on which registered 
New York Stock Exchange 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined by Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x.  
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨    No  x.  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 
1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such 
filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  x    No  ¨  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File 
required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the 
registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  x    No  ¨.  
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to 
the best of the registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any 
amendment to this Form 10-K.  ¨  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. 
See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):  
Large accelerated filer  ¨ 
Non-accelerated filer 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).    Yes  ¨    No  x.  
The aggregate market value as of June 30, 2014, of the registrant’s common units held by non-affiliates of the registrant based on the reported closing 
price of $26.87 of such common units on the New York Stock Exchange on such date was $284.0 million. Common units held by affiliates of the 
registrant have been excluded from the calculation. The determination of the affiliate status is not necessarily a conclusive determination for other 
purposes.  
As of February 20, 2015, the registrant had outstanding 16,935,650 common units and 7,525,000 subordinated units outstanding.  
In connection with the acquisition of the membership interests of the General Partner of Lehigh Gas Partners LP, Lehigh Gas Partners LP changed its 
name to CrossAmerica Partners LP effective October 1, 2014 and began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the ticker symbol “CAPL” 
effective October 6, 2014.  

Accelerated filer 
x 
Smaller reporting company  ¨ 

¨  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company) 

Documents Incorporated by Reference: None.  

  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
INDEX  

PART I  

Business  

Item 1. 
Item 1A.  Risk Factors 
Item 1B.  Unresolved Staff Comments 
Item 2. 
Item 3. 
Item 4.  Mine Safety Disclosures 

Properties 
Legal Proceedings 

PART II  

Item 5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity 

Securities 

Selected Financial Data 

Item 6. 
Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations  
Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk 
Item 8. 
Item 9. 
Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures 
Item 9B.  Other Information 

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data 
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure  

PART III  

Item 10.  Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance 
Item 11.  Executive Compensation 
Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters 
Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions, and Director Independence 
Item 14.  Principal Accountant Fees and Services 

PART IV  

Item 15.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules   

Page 
Number  

3   
18   
39   
39   
39   
39   

40   
42   
44   
71   
72   
72   
72   
73   

73   
79   
93   
95   
102   

102   

  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
CAUTIONARY STATEMENT REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS  

This Annual Report on Form 10-K and oral statements made regarding the subjects of this Annual Report may contain forward-
looking statements, which may include, but are not limited to, statements regarding our plans, objectives, expectations and intentions 
and other statements that are not historical facts, including statements identified by words such as “outlook,” “intends,” “plans,” 
“estimates,” “believes,” “expects,” “potential,” “continues,” “may,” “will,” “should,” “seeks,” “approximately,” “predicts,” 
“anticipates,” “foresees,” or the negative version of these words or other comparable expressions. All statements addressing operating 
performance, events, or developments that the Partnership expects or anticipates will occur in the future, including statements relating 
to revenue growth and earnings or earnings per unit growth, as well as statements expressing optimism or pessimism about future 
operating results, are forward-looking statements. The forward-looking statements are based upon our current views and assumptions 
regarding future events and operating performance and are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive 
uncertainties and contingencies and changes in circumstances, many of which are beyond our control. The statements in this Annual 
Report are made as of the date of this report, even if subsequently made available by us on our website or otherwise. We do not 
undertake any obligation to update or revise these statements to reflect events or circumstances occurring after the date of this Annual 
Report.  

Although we do not make forward-looking statements unless we believe we have a reasonable basis for doing so, we cannot guarantee 
their accuracy. Achieving the results described in these statements involves a number of risks, uncertainties and other factors that 
could cause actual results to differ materially, including the following factors:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

Availability of cash flow to pay minimum quarterly distribution on our common units;  
The availability and cost of competing motor fuels;  
Fuel price volatility or a reduction in demand for motor fuels;  
Competition in the industries and geographical areas in which we operate;  
The consummation of financing, acquisition or disposition transactions and the effect thereof on our business;  
Our existing or future indebtedness;  
Our liquidity, results of operations and financial condition;  
Failure to comply with applicable regulations or governmental policies;  
Future legislation and changes in regulations or governmental policies or changes in enforcement or interpretations 
thereof;  
Future income tax legislation;  
Changes in energy policy;  
Increases in energy conservation efforts;  
Technological advances;  
Volatility in the capital and credit markets;  
The impact of worldwide economic and political conditions;  
The impact of wars and acts of terrorism;  

• 
•  Weather conditions or catastrophic weather-related damage;  
• 

Earthquakes and other natural disasters;  
Hazards and risks associated with transporting and storing motor fuel;  
Unexpected environmental liabilities;  
The outcome of pending or future litigation;  

• 

• 

• 

1 

 
 
 
• 

• 

• 

CST’s business strategy and operations and CST’s conflicts of interest with us;  
The ability of CST to successfully integrate our operations and employees; and  
Other factors, including those discussed in “Item 1A. Risk Factors.”  

See “Item 1A. Risk Factors.” All written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to us, or persons acting on our behalf, are 
expressly qualified in their entirety by these cautionary statements. You should evaluate all forward-looking statements made in this 
Annual Report on Form 10-K in the context of these risks and uncertainties. We caution you that the important factors referenced 
above may not contain all of the factors that are important to you. We cannot assure you that projected results or events reflected in 
the forward-looking statements will be achieved or will occur. The forward-looking statements included in this annual report are made 
as of the date of this report. We undertake no obligation to publicly release any revisions to any forward-looking statements, to report 
events or to report the occurrence of unanticipated events.  

ITEM 1. BUSINESS  

PART I  

ABOUT THIS ANNUAL REPORT  

We use the following terms to refer to the items indicated:  

•  

•  

•  

• 

•  

• 

•  

• 

• 

• 

“We,” “us,” “our,” the “Partnership,” “CrossAmerica” or like terms refer to CrossAmerica Partners LP, a Delaware limited 
partnership, (formerly Lehigh Gas Partners LP ) and, where appropriate in context, to one or more of its subsidiaries, or all 
of them taken as a whole.  
“General Partner” refers to CrossAmerica GP, LLC (formerly Lehigh Gas GP).  
“CST” refers to CST Brands, Inc. who acquired 100% of the membership interest in our General Partner on October 1, 
2014 (the “GP Purchase”). Since the General Partner controls the Partnership, CST controls the Partnership.  
“DMI” refers to Dunne Manning, Inc. (formerly Lehigh Gas Corporation).  
“IPO” refers to our initial public offering that occurred on October 30, 2012. In connection with the IPO, a portion of the 
business of Dunne Manning Inc. “DMI”) and its subsidiaries and affiliates was contributed to the Partnership.  
“Predecessor” or “Predecessor Entity” refer to the wholesale distribution business of Lehigh Gas—Ohio, LLC, and real 
property and leasehold interests contributed to us in connection with the IPO by Joseph V. Topper, Jr., the Chief Executive 
Officer and President of our General Partner and/or his affiliates. This was the portion of the business of DMI and its 
subsidiaries and affiliates contributed to the Partnership in connection with the IPO.  
References in this annual report to “LGO” refer to Lehigh Gas—Ohio, LLC, a related party. All of LGO’s wholesale 
distribution business was contributed to us in connection with the IPO.  
References to the “Topper Group” refer to Joseph V. Topper, Jr., collectively with those of his affiliates and family trusts 
that have ownership interests in our Predecessor, including DMI. A trust of which Joseph V. Topper, Jr. is a trustee owns 
all of the outstanding stock of DMI. The Topper Group, including DMI, holds a significant portion of our limited partner 
interests.  
As a result of the IPO and the concurrent contribution of certain assets and liabilities from DMI and its affiliates to the 
Partnership, we applied a successor / predecessor presentation in which balances pertaining to the period from October 31, 
2012 through December 31, 2012, the successor period, are presented separately from balances pertaining to the period 
from January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, the predecessor period.  
“PMI acquisition” refers to our purchase of Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated which operates in two primary lines of 
business: convenience stores and petroleum products distribution.  

2 

 
 
  
• 

• 

• 

CST  

We distribute motor fuel through our wholesale and retail fuel distribution channels to the classes of trade described below:  

Wholesale Fuel Distribution  
Lessee Dealers  

•  We either own or lease the property and then lease or sublease the site to a dealer.  
• 

The dealer owns all fuel and convenience store inventory.  

•  We collect wholesale fuel margins via two types of contracts: a fixed cent per gallon margin (“rack plus”) or a 

variable cent per gallon margin (“dealer tank wagon” or “DTW”) through the exclusive distribution contract with the 
dealer.  
Exclusive distribution contracts with dealer run concurrent in length to the site lease period (generally three years 
after an initial one-year trial term).  
Dealer sets the retail price at the pump and owns retail fuel margins and convenience store profits.  
Leases are generally triple net leases.  

• 

• 

• 

Independent Dealers and Sub-Wholesalers  

• 

Independent dealer owns or leases the property and owns all fuel and convenience store inventory.  

•  We contract to exclusively distribute fuel to the independent dealer at a fixed cent per gallon margin and, in some 

cases, DTW.  
Distribution contracts with independent dealers are typically 7-10 years in length.  
Contracts with sub-wholesalers are generally 10 years in length.  

In conjunction with the joint acquisitions we have done with CST, we own the property and then lease the site to 
CST.  

•  We entered into a 10-year fuel distribution agreement with CST, pursuant to which we distribute to CST motor fuels 

at a fixed mark-up per gallon.  

•  We enter into 10-year lease agreements with CST pursuant to which CST leases sites from us.  
• 

CST owns all fuel and convenience store inventory.  
CST sets the retail price at the pump and owns retail fuel margins and convenience store profits.  
Leases are triple net leases.  

• 

• 

LGO  

•  We own or lease the property and then lease or sublease the site to LGO.  
•  We entered into a 15-year master wholesale supply agreement with LGO at the time of the IPO, pursuant to which we 

distributed to LGO motor fuels at a variable rate mark-up per gallon consistent with market mark-ups through 
September 30, 2014 and at a fixed mark-up per gallon since October 1, 2014.  

•  We enter into 15-year lease agreements with LGO pursuant to which LGO leases sites from us.  
• 

LGO owns all fuel and convenience store inventory.  
LGO sets the retail price at the pump and owns retail fuel margins and convenience store profits.  
Leases are triple net leases.  

• 

• 

Retail Fuel Distribution  
Commission Sites  

•  We own or lease the property and then lease or sublease the site to the commission agent, who pays rent to us and 

operates all the non-fuel related operations at the sites for their own account.  

3 

 
 
  
•  We own the motor fuel inventory at the sites, set the fuel pricing at the sites, and generate revenue from the retail 

sale of motor fuels to the end customer.  

•  We pay the commission agent a commission for each gallon of fuel sold at the site.  
•  We maintain inventory from the time of the purchase of motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to 
the end customer at the commission sites. The inventory amount at the sites averages about 3-days’ worth of motor 
fuels sales.  
Lehigh Gas Wholesale LLC (“LGW”) distributes fuel on a wholesale basis to Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc. 
(“LGWS”), which owns the motor fuel inventory and distributes fuel to retail customers. LGW records qualifying 
wholesale fuel distribution gross income and LGWS records the non-qualifying retail distribution gross income.  

• 

Company Operated  

•  We own or lease the property, operate the convenience store and retain all profits from fuel and non-fuel operations 

at 87 sites operated by PMI.  

•  We own the motor fuel inventory at the sites, set the fuel pricing at the sites, and generate revenue from the retail 

sale of motor fuels to the end customer.  

•  We maintain inventory from the time of the purchase of motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to 

the end customer. The inventory amount at the sites averages about 3-days’ worth of motor fuels sales.  
LGW distributes on a wholesale basis a significant portion of the fuel required by PMI, which owns the motor fuel 
inventory and distributes fuel to retail customers. LGW records qualifying wholesale fuel distribution gross income 
and PMI records the non-qualifying retail distribution gross income.  

• 

Overview  
We are a Delaware limited partnership formed to engage in the distribution of motor fuels, consisting of gasoline and diesel fuel, and 
to own and lease real estate used in the retail distribution of motor fuels. Our primary business objective is to make quarterly cash 
distributions to our unitholders and, over time, to increase our quarterly cash distributions. The amount of any distribution is subject to 
the discretion of the board of directors of our General Partner which may modify or revoke our cash distribution policy at any time. 
Our partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions.  

We own and lease sites primarily located in prime locations with strong motor fuel demand. Our sites are located in Pennsylvania, 
New Jersey, Ohio, New York, Massachusetts, Kentucky, New Hampshire, Maine, Florida, Maryland, Delaware, Tennessee, Virginia, 
Illinois, Indiana and West Virginia. We also distribute motor fuel in Georgia and North Carolina. As a result of the Erickson and 
Landmark acquisitions in 2015, we also own and lease sites in Minnesota, Michigan, Wisconsin, South Dakota and Texas. Based on 
the most recent data available from the Energy Information Agency, of the 23 states in which we distribute motor fuel, nine were 
among the top ten consumers of gasoline in the United States and eight were among the top ten consumers of on-highway diesel fuel 
in the United States for 2013.  

We operate in two segments, wholesale and retail. Since our Predecessor was founded in 1992, we have generated revenues from the 
wholesale distribution of motor fuels to retail sites and from real estate leases. In the third quarter of 2013, we also began generating 
revenues, on a select basis, through the retail distribution of motor fuels at sites operated by commission agents. In the second quarter 
of 2014, as a result of the PMI acquisition, we began generating revenues from the operation of 87 convenience stores and nine 
branded, co-located quick-service restaurants.  

We believe consistent demand for motor fuels in the areas where we operate and the contractual nature of our rent income provides a 
stable source of cash flow. Cash flows from the wholesale distribution of motor fuels are generated primarily by a per gallon margin 
that is either a fixed or variable mark-up per gallon, depending on our contract terms. By delivering most motor fuels through 
independent carriers on the same day we purchase the motor fuels from suppliers, we seek to minimize the commodity price risks 
typically associated with the purchase and sale of motor fuels.  

For the year ended December 31, 2014, we were one of the ten largest independent distributors by volume in the United States for 
ExxonMobil, BP and Motiva. Approximately 95% of the motor fuels we distributed in the year ended December 31, 2014 were 
branded, including Chevron, Sunoco, Valero, Gulf and Citgo brands.  

4 

 
 
  
We also generate revenues from rent income primarily by collecting rent from lessee dealers, commission agents, CST and LGO 
pursuant to lease agreements. Our lease agreements with lessee dealers, commission agents, CST and LGO had average remaining 
lease terms of approximately 2.7, 3.3, 9.8 and 13.1 years as of December 31, 2014, respectively. The terms of our lease agreements 
with the operators generally run concurrently with the terms of the wholesale supply agreements at the sites, and the lease agreements 
generally require the operators to purchase their motor fuel from us.  

As of December 31, 2014, approximately 60% of the sites to which we distribute motor fuels were owned or leased by us. In addition, 
we have agreements requiring the operators of these sites to purchase motor fuels from us.  

As noted above, in the third quarter of 2013, we also began generating revenues from the retail distribution of motor fuels. As of 
December 31, 2014, we sold retail fuels at approximately 163 sites. At 76 of these sites, we operate the retail fuel operations through a 
third-party commission agent and lease the non-fuel site operations to the commission agent. Our lease agreements with the 
commission agents had an average remaining lease term of approximately 3.3 years as of December 31, 2014. The commission agent 
pays rent to us for the use of the non-fuel related real and personal property at the site. The commission agent operates the non-fuel 
related operations at the site for its own account and receives from us a fixed rate per gallon of motor fuel distributed to the retail 
consumer. Following our PMI acquisition in the second quarter of 2014, we also began directly distributing retail fuel at 87 
convenience stores. In addition to retail fuel distribution at these sites, we also operate and generate revenues from the convenience 
stores and nine branded, co-located quick-service restaurants. For 2014, we distributed an aggregate of approximately 906.2 million 
gallons of motor fuels. As of December 31, 2014, we distributed motor fuels to 1,074 sites, comprised of the following classes of 
trade:  
• 

416 sites operated by independent dealers;  
21 sites owned by us and operated by CST;  
200 sites owned or leased by us and operated by LGO;  
274 sites owned or leased by us and operated by lessee dealers;  
76 sites owned or leased by us and operated by commission agents;  
87 sites owned or leased and operated by us; and  
17 sub-wholesalers and sold various other products to commercial and residential customers.  

•  

• 

•  

•  

•  

• 

Business Strategies  
Our primary business objective is to make quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders and, over time, to increase our quarterly cash 
distributions by executing the following strategies:  

•  

•  

•  

•  

Utilize our relationship with CST to maintain and grow our cash flow. We intend to acquire real estate, wholesale fuel 
distribution and related assets from CST that are expected to generate additional income. We also plan to pursue strategic 
business acquisition opportunities jointly with CST.  
Expand within and beyond our core markets through acquisitions. Since our IPO in October 2012 and through 
February 20, 2015, we completed eleven acquisitions, acquiring a total of 337 fee and leasehold sites for total 
consideration of $488.3 million. We intend to continue to grow our business through strategic and accretive acquisitions 
of sites and wholesale distribution businesses both within our existing area of operations and in new geographic areas. We 
expect our relationship with CST will enhance our ability to execute acquisitions.  
Own or lease sites in prime locations and seek to enhance the cash flow potential of these sites. As of December 31, 2014, 
we owned or leased 658 sites that are primarily located in prime locations with strong motor fuel demand. These sites 
serve customers seeking convenient fueling locations on roads and intersections with heavy traffic. We constantly 
evaluate opportunities to enhance the cash flow potential of our sites. For example, at our sites we may install car washes, 
convert service bays into convenience stores or upgrade convenience stores to quick service restaurants. These 
enhancements improve our ability to charge increased rents and increase the wholesale distribution potential of these sites.  
Increase our wholesale motor fuel distribution business by expanding market share. As we seek to increase the number of 
sites we own and lease, we expect to have a commensurate increase in our wholesale distribution business due to the 
addition of these new sites. Furthermore, we believe that our standing in 2014 as a top ten independent distributor by 
volume in the United States for ExxonMobil, BP and Motiva enables us to capitalize on  

5 

 
 
  
• 

• 

the reduction by major integrated oil companies of the number of wholesalers with which they do business. As smaller 
wholesale distributors experience difficulties purchasing motor fuels from major integrated oil companies and refiners, we 
have been able, and believe that we will continue to be able, to successfully target and sell motor fuels to these 
wholesalers on a sub-wholesaling basis.  
Maintain strong relationships with major integrated oil companies and refiners. Our relationships with suppliers of 
branded motor fuels are crucial to the operation and growth of our business. These relationships have allowed us to 
consistently negotiate supply agreements with competitive terms.  
Manage risk by mitigating exposure to environmental liabilities. In acquiring properties, we use environmental 
consultants to perform due diligence regarding the property to assess the exposure to risk of environmental contamination, 
if any. Typically, when an acquired site requires remediation, either the seller funds an escrow account for the cost to 
remediate the property, or the seller retains the obligation to remediate the property. We also seek to purchase 
environmental insurance policies to contain costs in the event that the escrowed amounts are inadequate or if there are 
unknown pre-existing conditions at a location discovered in the future. In addition, we participate in state programs, where 
available, that may also assist in funding the costs of environmental liabilities.  

Competitive Strengths  
We believe the following competitive strengths will enable us to achieve our primary business objective:  

• 

•  

•  

• 

•  

Our relationship with CST. CST, the owner of our general partner, is one of the largest independent retailers of motor fuel 
and convenience merchandise items in the United States and eastern Canada with approximately 1,900 locations as of 
December 31, 2014. In 2014, CST distributed 1.9 billion gallons of motor fuel at its approximately 1,000 sites within the 
United States.  
Stable cash flows from real estate rent income and wholesale motor fuel distribution. We generate revenue from rent at 
our sites and earn a per gallon margin on the wholesale distribution of motor fuels. We collect rent from the lessee dealers, 
commission agents, CST and LGO pursuant to lease agreements. Our lease agreements with lessee dealers, commission 
agents, CST and LGO had average remaining lease terms of approximately 2.7 years, 3.3 years, 9.8 years and 13.1 years, 
respectively, as of December 31, 2014. We sell motor fuel on a wholesale basis to lessee dealers, independent dealers, 
commission agents, CST, LGO and sub-wholesalers. We receive a per gallon margin that is either a fixed mark-up per 
gallon or a variable rate mark-up per gallon. At sites we own or lease, the term of the supply agreement is generally 
concurrent with the term of our lease with the lessee dealer, CST or LGO. In addition, our wholesale contracts prohibit 
customers from purchasing motor fuels from other distributors. We believe that the contractual nature of our rent income 
and the consistent demand for motor fuel in the areas where we operate provide a stable source of cash flow.  
Established history of acquiring sites and successfully integrating these sites and operations into our existing business. 
We have grown our business from 11 owned sites in 2004 to 314 owned sites as of December 31, 2014. Since our IPO in 
October 2012 and through February 20, 2015, we have completed eleven acquisitions for a total of 337 fee and leasehold 
properties for total consideration of $488.3 million. Our strong industry relationships, access to capital, ability to complete 
acquisitions and environmental risk management expertise have allowed us to find multiple sites and negotiate 
transactions that are on attractive terms. Furthermore, we have successfully integrated our acquisitions into our existing 
business by reducing overhead costs and realizing economies of scale associated with our wholesale distribution business.  
Long-term relationships with major integrated oil companies and refiners. We have established long-term relationships 
and supply agreements with companies that are among the largest suppliers of branded motor fuel in the United States. 
During 2014, our wholesale business purchased approximately 37%, 28% and 22% of its motor fuel from ExxonMobil (a 
supplier of ours since 2002), BP (a supplier of ours since 2009) and Motiva (a supplier of ours since 2004), respectively. 
Our prompt payment history and good credit standing with our suppliers allow us to receive certain term discounts on our 
fuel purchases, which increases the profitability of our wholesale distribution business. We believe that these relationships 
and payment terms are not easily replicated by competitors in the markets we serve.  
Prime real estate locations in areas with high traffic and considerable motor fuel consumption. We derive our rent 
income from sites we own or lease that provide convenient fueling locations in areas that are densely populated. Based on 
the most recent data available from Energy Information Agency, of the 23 states in which we distribute fuel, nine were 
among the top ten consumers of gasoline and eight were among the top ten consumers of on-highway diesel fuel in the 
United States for 2013. Over 85% of our sites were located in high-traffic metropolitan and urban areas as of 
December 31, 2014. We believe that the limited availability of undeveloped real estate, particularly in the northeastern 
U.S., presents a high barrier to entry for the development of competing sites.  

6 

 
 
• 

•  

Financial flexibility to pursue acquisitions and other expansion opportunities. We amended and restated our credit facility 
in September 2014 to provide additional liquidity, and as of December 31, 2014, we had approximately $333.2 million in 
nominal availability under our credit facility for future acquisitions or working capital purposes, depending on our needs. 
We also raised $135.0 million of net proceeds in an equity offering in September 2014. We believe that our borrowing 
capabilities available under our credit agreement and our ability to access the public capital markets provide us with the 
financial flexibility to pursue acquisition and expansion opportunities.  
Extensive industry experience of our senior management team. Our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and 
President have, on average, over 24 years of experience in the ownership and operation of businesses that distribute motor 
fuel. Furthermore, our senior management team has extensive relationships with suppliers, customers, brokers and other 
industry contacts that are crucial to the successful operation and growth of our business.  

Recent Acquisitions  
Since our IPO in October 2012 and through February 20, 2015, we have completed eleven acquisitions for a total of 337 fee and 
leasehold sites for total consideration of $488.3 million. Summarized below are our acquisitions in the past two years.  

Rogers Acquisition  
In September and October 2013, we purchased 14 motor fuel stations, three leasehold motor fuel stations, assumed certain third-party 
supply contracts and purchased certain other assets located primarily in the Tri-Cities region of Tennessee area for $21.1 million. This 
acquisition provided entry into a new geographic territory for us. Aggregate incremental revenues for the Rogers acquisition included 
in our statements of operations were $17.6 million for 2013.  

Rocky Top Acquisition  
In September 2013, we purchased one fee property site, three leasehold motor fuel stations, seven third-party supply contracts and 
certain other assets and equipment for total consideration of $10.7 million. Concurrent with the closing, we entered into a master lease 
for 29 motor fuel stations, which we will purchase on or after August 1, 2015, for $26.2 million. The purchased and leasehold sites are 
located in and around the Knoxville, Tennessee region and along Interstate Highways 40 and 75. This acquisition is geographically 
adjacent to the Rogers acquisition and expanded our presence in Tennessee. Aggregate incremental revenues for the Rocky Top 
acquisition included in our statements of operations were $23.1 million for 2013.  

Manchester Acquisition  
In December 2013, we purchased 44 independent dealer supply contracts, five sub-wholesale supply contracts, two leasehold motor 
fuel stations and certain other assets and equipment in Virginia for total consideration of $10.7 million. This acquisition provided 
entry into a new geographic territory for us.  

PMI Acquisition  
On April 28, 2014, we exercised an option (“the Option”) to purchase 100% of the membership interests of Pinehurst Petroleum, LLC 
(“Pinehurst”) from Joseph L. Smith III and John A. Kopfer, Jr. (collectively “Smith/Kopfer”) for $4.0 million. Pinehurst’s sole asset 
was an Agreement and Plan of Merger among Pinehurst, PMI Merger Sub, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Pinehurst(“Sub”), 
Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated (“PMI”), Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated Employee Stock Ownership Trust and Ronald R. 
Hare, in his capacity as representative (the “Merger Agreement”), pursuant to which Pinehurst agreed to acquire all of the shares of 
PMI for $73.5 million inclusive of an adjustment for working capital, through the merger(“the Merger”) of Sub and PMI. Under the 
terms of the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of PMI agreed to escrow $5.0 million for 25 months after the closing date of the 
Merger to secure the indemnity provisions contained in the Merger Agreement for the benefit of Pinehurst. The transaction was 
funded with borrowings under our credit facility. On April 30, 2014, pursuant to the Option, the Partnership purchased all of the 
equity interests of Pinehurst ($1.0 million of the consideration is included in accrued expenses and other current and noncurrent 
liabilities at December 31, 2014). Subsequent to such purchase, the Merger became effective and, as a result, the Partnership became 
the owner of PMI.  

7 

 
 
  
PMI operates two primary lines of business: convenience stores and petroleum products distribution. In its convenience store business, 
PMI operates 87 convenience stores and nine co-located branded quick service restaurants located in Virginia and West Virginia. The 
convenience stores distribute primarily branded fuel and operate under PMI’s own proprietary convenience store brand, “Stop in Food 
Stores.” The petroleum products business distributes motor fuels and other petroleum products to customers throughout Virginia, West 
Virginia, Tennessee and North Carolina. The acquisition augmented the Partnership’s presence in Virginia and complements the 
existing Tennessee operations.  

On May 1, 2014, immediately subsequent to the effectiveness of the Merger, we caused PMI to divest its lubricants business (the 
“Lubricants Business”) to Zimri Holdings, LLC (“Zimri”), an entity owned by Smith/Kopfer, for the sum of $14.0 million pursuant to 
an Asset Purchase Agreement (the “APA”) between PMI and Zimri. The APA contains customary representations, warranties, 
agreements and obligations of the parties, as well as indemnity provisions. A trust controlled by Joseph V. Topper, Jr., Chairman and 
CEO of the General Partner, financed the purchase of the Lubricants Business by Zimri pursuant to a loan to Zimri. The financing by 
Mr. Topper’s trust was approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. In 2014, the trust 
that financed the purchase acquired the Lubricants Business.  

Atlas Acquisition  
On May 19, 2014, we completed our acquisition of 52 wholesale supply contracts, one sub-wholesaler contract, five fee sites, six 
leasehold sites and certain other assets from affiliates of Atlas Oil Company (“Atlas”) for $34.0 million. In addition, we acquired 
certain short-term notes receivable associated with the wholesale supply and commission marketing contracts for $5.2 million, 
bringing total consideration to $39.2 million, subject to closing adjustments. The transaction was funded by borrowings under our 
credit facility and $4.0 million of proceeds from the sale of the Lubricants Business that were directed to an escrow agent as part of an 
Internal Revenue Code Section 1031 like-kind exchange.  

These assets are located in the Chicago, Illinois area and are branded BP. The wholesale supply contracts have a remaining average 
term of 15 years and the fee or leasehold sites are currently leased to third party commission agents. The short-term notes receivable 
relate to previously negotiated purchase agreements of certain sites by the dealers occupying the locations. All of the notes receivable 
relate to sites supplied under contracts acquired in this transaction.  

In connection with the acquisition of PMI and assets from certain affiliates of Atlas, we amended our Omnibus Agreement, dated 
October 30, 2012, with our General Partner, DMI, LGO, and Joseph V. Topper, Jr. (as so amended, the “Original Omnibus 
Agreement”) with regards to the management fee payable by us to DMI effective July 1, 2014 (and to CST since October 1, 2014). 
The revised management fee consists of a base monthly fee of $670,000 per month and a variable fee of between zero and $0.003 per 
gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. The General Partner and 
CST may waive all or any portion of the management fee to the extent that all or a portion of the management services are either 
purchased from another party or not required.  

Nice N Easy Acquisition  
Effective November 1, 2014 (the “Closing Date”), CST and the Partnership jointly entered into an agreement to purchase the 
convenience store assets, franchisor rights, and associated trademarks of Nice N Easy Grocery Shoppes, located in central New York 
with a concentration in the Syracuse, NY region. Effective on the Closing Date, CST assigned the rights to acquire real property, 
including underground storage tanks and canopies, at 23 sites to LGWS and the related fuel distribution agreements to LGW, for 
aggregate cash consideration of $53.8 million (the “Purchase Price”). In addition, LGWS entered into a lease with a subsidiary of CST 
for the acquired real estate and LGW entered into a wholesale fuel distribution agreement with a subsidiary of CST. CST operates the 
sites and purchased the working capital of the acquired assets. The Partnership funded the Purchase Price with borrowings under its 
credit facility.  

Drop Down of Fuel Supply Interests  
Pursuant to a Contribution Agreement (the “Contribution Agreement”), dated December 16, 2014, by and among the Partnership, CST 
and CST Services LLC (“CST Services”), an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of CST, on January 2, 2015, we completed the 
acquisition, effective January 1, 2015, of a 5% limited partner interest in CST Fuel Supply LP (“CST Fuel”) from CST Services in 
exchange for 1,497,946 newly issued common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership.  

CST Fuel owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in CST Marketing and Supply LLC (“CSTMS”), which is a 
party to a fuel supply agreement with a subsidiary of Valero Energy Corporation. The general partner of CST Fuel is CST USA, Inc., 
a wholly owned subsidiary of CST. CST continues to indirectly own a 95% limited partner interest in CST Fuel.  

8 

 
 
  
Immediately prior to closing and effective January 1, 2015, CST Services, CSTMS and certain subsidiaries of CST Services 
(“Purchasers”) entered into a fuel distribution agreement (the “Fuel Distribution Agreement”), pursuant to which CSTMS, on an 
annual basis, sells and delivers to the Purchasers, and the Purchasers will purchase, for at least 10 years no less than 1.57 billion 
gallons of branded and unbranded motor fuels at a fixed net margin of $0.05 per gallon for resale at retail sites operated by such 
Purchasers.  

The terms of the Contribution Agreement and Fuel Distribution Agreement were approved by the independent conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner. The conflicts committee retained independent legal and financial advisors to assist in 
evaluating and negotiating the transaction. In approving the transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an 
opinion from its independent financial advisor that the consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common 
unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of view.  

Landmark Acquisition  
On January 8, 2015, CST and the Partnership jointly purchased 22 convenience stores from Landmark Industries. The stores operate 
under the Timewise brand name and provide Shell branded fuel. The sites are all owned fee simple and are located primarily in the 
San Antonio area. We purchased all of the real property and underground storage tanks as well as certain wholesale fuel distribution 
assets for $43.5 million, funded by borrowings under our Credit Facility. CST purchased the remaining personal property, working 
capital and the convenience store operations. The allocation of the purchase price between the Partnership and CST is subject to 
adjustment following completion of real property appraisals. 

LGWS leases the acquired real estate to CST under triple net leases and LGW distributes wholesale fuel to CST under long term 
agreements with a fuel gross profit margin of approximately $0.05 per gallon.  

Erickson Acquisition  
On February 17, 2015, we completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Erickson Oil Products, Inc. (“Erickson”) 
and certain related assets from GST Non-Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 
2010 and GST Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 2010 (collectively, the 
“Stock Sellers”), and certain real estate from Team Investments, LLC (together with the Stock Sellers, the “Sellers”). The purchase 
price was $85 million, subject to certain post-closing adjustments and indemnification and environmental remediation escrows, and 
was funded by borrowings under the Credit Facility.  

Erickson operates 64 convenience store sites located in Minnesota, Michigan, Wisconsin and South Dakota, with a concentration in 
the Minneapolis / St. Paul region, of which 59 are owned in fee simple and five are leased under long term leases.  

In connection with the purchase, the Sellers and certain principals of the Sellers have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not to 
engage directly or indirectly in the retail petroleum or convenience store business in a designated geographic area surrounding the 
purchased convenience store sites for a period of four years following the closing.  

9 

 
 
  
Wholesale Segment  
General  

The following table highlights the aggregate volume of motor fuel distributed by the wholesale distribution operations to each of the 
principal customer groups by gallons sold for the periods (in millions):  

Gallons of motor fuel distributed to: 
Lessee dealers 
Independent dealers 
CST 
LGO 
Commission agents 
Sub-wholesalers   
Company Operated 
Total 

Lehigh Gas 
Group (a)  
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

CrossAmerica 
Partners LP  
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined  

CrossAmerica 
Partners LP  

CrossAmerica 
Partners LP  

Year Ended 
December 31, 
2012  

Year Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Year Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

91.6      
139.9      
—        
201.1      
—        
70.1      

502.7      

18.0   
26.9   
—     
44.7   
—     
14.0   

109.6   
166.8   
—     
245.8   
—     
84.1   

126.5   
189.3   
—     
253.5   
20.3   
48.2   

103.6   

606.3   

637.8   

143.8   
348.4   
4.9   
224.0   
73.2   
48   
63.9   
906.2   

(a) 

Includes motor fuel distributed to customers of the Lehigh Gas Group.  

We purchase branded and unbranded motor fuel from major integrated oil companies, refiners and unbranded fuel suppliers. We 
distribute motor fuel to lessee dealers, independent dealers, CST, LGO and sub-wholesalers. We are a distributor of various brands of 
motor fuel as well as unbranded motor fuel. We are one of the top ten largest independent distributors by volume of ExxonMobil, BP 
and Shell-branded motor fuel in the United States, and we also distribute Chevron, Sunoco, Valero, Gulf and Citgo-branded motor 
fuels. We receive a fixed mark-up per gallon on approximately 84% of our gallons sold (based on fourth quarter volumes), which 
reduces the overall variability of our financial results. We receive a variable rate mark-up per gallon on the remaining gallons sold. A 
significant component of our fuel margin is the discount for prompt payment and other rebates and incentives offered by our suppliers. 
Prompt payment discounts from suppliers is based on a percentage of the purchase price of fuel and the dollar value of these discounts 
varies with fuel prices.  

Arrangements with Lessee Dealers and Independent Dealers  
We distribute motor fuel to lessee dealers and independent dealers under supply agreements. Under our supply agreements, we agree 
to supply a particular branded motor fuel or unbranded motor fuel to a site or group of sites and arrange for all transportation. We 
receive a per gallon margin that is either a fixed mark-up per gallon or a variable rate mark-up per gallon. The initial term of most 
independent dealer supply agreements is ten years. After a trial period, the initial term of most lessee dealer supply agreements is 
generally three years. These supply agreements require, among other things, dealers to maintain standards established by the 
applicable brand. We may provide credit terms to our lessee dealers and independent dealers, which are generally no longer than three 
days. As of December 31, 2014, the average remaining contract term for our independent dealers and lessee dealers was 5.1 years and 
2.7 years, respectively.  

Arrangements with Sub-Wholesalers  
We distribute motor fuel to sub-wholesalers under supply agreements. Under our supply agreements, we agree to supply a particular 
branded motor fuel or unbranded motor fuel to the sub-wholesaler. Motor fuels are sold to the sub-wholesalers at rack plus. The rack 
price is the price at which a wholesale distributor generally purchases motor fuel from an integrated oil company or refiner at the 
terminal. The sub-wholesaler is responsible for arranging and paying for all transportation, insurance and all other costs and services 
for the distribution of motor fuels. The initial term of most sub-wholesaler supply agreements is three to ten years. We may provide 
credit terms to our sub-wholesalers, which are generally within ten days. As of December 31, 2014, the average remaining contract 
term for our contracts with sub-wholesalers was 1.3 years.  

Arrangement with CST  
In conjunction with our joint purchases of Nice N Easy and Landmark with CST, we entered into a 10-year fuel distribution agreement 
with CST pursuant to which we distribute to CST motor fuels at a fixed mark-up per gallon. CST retains the retail income it earns 
from the sites and is responsible for operating the sites and for paying expenses incurred in connection with  

10 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
the operation of the sites including, but not limited to, utilities, insurance, licenses and employee costs. We enter into 10-year lease 
agreements with CST pursuant to which CST leases real property and the underground storage tanks from us. As of December 31, 
2014, the remaining term on our fuel distribution and real estate leases agreement with CST was 9.8 years.  

Arrangement with LGO  
Prior to the IPO, our Predecessor’s retail operations were transferred to LGO, a non-contributed entity managed by Joseph V. Topper, 
Jr. We entered into a 15-year wholesale supply agreement with LGO pursuant to which we distributed to LGO motor fuels at a 
variable rate mark-up per gallon consistent with market mark-ups through September 30, 2014. Since October 1, 2014, we distribute 
to LGO at a fixed mark-up per gallon. LGO retains the retail income it earns from the sites and is responsible for operating the sites 
and for paying expenses incurred in connection with the operation of the sites including, but not limited to, utilities, insurance, licenses 
and employee costs. We enter into 15-year lease agreements with LGO pursuant to which LGO leases sites from us. As of 
December 31, 2014, the remaining term on our wholesale supply agreement with LGO was 12.8 years.  

11 

 
 
Supplier Arrangements  
We distribute branded motor fuel under the ExxonMobil, BP, Shell, Chevron, Sunoco, Valero, Gulf and Citgo brands to our 
customers. Branded motor fuels are purchased from major integrated oil companies and refiners under supply agreements. For the year 
ended December 31, 2014, our wholesale business purchased approximately 37%, 28% and 22% of its motor fuel from ExxonMobil (a 
supplier of ours since 2002), BP (a supplier of ours since 2009) and Motiva (a supplier of ours since 2004), respectively. We purchase 
the motor fuel at the supplier’s applicable terminal rack price, which typically changes daily. In addition, each supply agreement 
typically contains provisions relating to, among other things, payment terms, use of the supplier’s brand names, provisions relating to 
credit card processing, insurance coverage and compliance with legal and environmental requirements. As is typical in the industry, a 
supplier generally can terminate the supply contract if we do not comply with any material condition of the contract, including if we 
were to fail to make payments when due, or if we are involved in fraud, criminal misconduct, bankruptcy or insolvency. Each supply 
agreement has provisions that obligates the supplier, subject to certain limitations, to sell up to an agreed upon number of gallons. Any 
amount in excess is subject to availability. Certain suppliers offer volume rebates or incentive payments to drive volumes and provide 
an incentive for branding new locations. Certain suppliers require that all or a portion of any such incentive payments be repaid to the 
supplier in the event that the sites are rebranded within a stated number of years. We also purchase unbranded motor fuel for 
distribution at the rack price. A significant component of our fuel margin is the discount for prompt payment and other rebates and 
incentives offered by our suppliers. As of December 31, 2014, our supply agreements had a weighted-average remaining term of 
approximately 8.7 years.  

Selection and Recruitment of Site Operators  
We constantly evaluate existing and potential site operators based on their creditworthiness and the quality of their site and operation 
as determined by size and location of the site, monthly volumes of motor fuel sold, overall financial performance and previous 
operating experience. At times, we convert our sites from one class of trade to another to optimize profitability.  

Retail Segment  
Arrangement with Commission Agents  
Prior to September 1, 2013, we leased certain sites to LGO, which, in turn, subleased certain of these sites (the “Subleases”) to third 
party commission agents and entered into commission agreements with the agents to sell motor fuel on behalf of LGO to retail 
customers (the “Commission Agreements”). In connection with the Commission Agreements, LGO also purchased motor fuel from a 
subsidiary of the Partnership at wholesale prices. Effective September 1, 2013, we assumed the Commission Agreements and 
Subleases from LGO and terminated our leases with LGO for the Commission Sites. As a result, we now record the retail sale of 
motor fuels to the end customer and accrue a commission payable to the commission agent at the Commission Sites. We paid LGO 
$3.5 million (the “Purchase Price”) for the Subleases and Commission Agreements and $2.1 million for the motor fuel inventory.  

The commission agent at each site operates all the non-fuel operations at the site for its own account, pays rent to us for the use of the 
site and receives a commission for each gallon of motor fuel sold at the site. At the Commission Sites, we own the motor fuel 
inventory, determine the retail pricing of motor fuel and generate revenue from the sale of motor fuel to the retail consumer. We 
maintain inventory from the time of the purchase of motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to the end customer at 
these sites. The retail fuel margin at the Commission Sites is non-qualifying income for federal income tax purposes and is recorded in 
LGWS, our taxable C-Corp subsidiary. LGW sells fuel on a wholesale basis to LGWS for the Commission Sites and this income is 
qualifying income for federal income tax purposes and included in the results of the Wholesale segment in our consolidated financial 
statements.  

Company Operated Sites  
Commencing with our PMI acquisition in April 2014, we operate 87 convenience stores in Virginia and West Virginia and retain all 
profits from the fuel and non-fuel operations. We own the motor fuel inventory at the sites, set the fuel pricing at the sites, and 
generate revenue from the retail sale of motor fuels to the end customer. We maintain inventory from the time of the purchase of 
motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to the end customer. The inventory amount at the sites averages about 3-
days’ worth of motor fuels sales. LGW distributes on a wholesale basis a significant portion of the fuel required by PMI, which owns 
the motor fuel inventory and distributes fuel to retail customers. LGW records qualifying wholesale fuel distribution gross income and 
PMI records the non-qualifying retail distribution gross income.  

12 

 
 
  
Real Estate  
Site Locations  
As of December 31, 2014, we owned or leased 658 sites located in Pennsylvania, New Jersey, Massachusetts, Ohio, Tennessee, 
Florida, New Hampshire, New York, Maine, Kentucky, Virginia, West Virginia, Maryland, Illinois, Indiana and Delaware. Of those, 
314 are owned fee simple and 344 sites we leased from third-party landlords. Over 85% of our sites are located in high-traffic 
metropolitan and urban areas. Our emphasis on acquiring, by purchase or lease, sites primarily in prime locations with strong motor 
fuel demand allows us to benefit from high traffic counts and customers seeking convenient fueling locations. We believe that sites in 
high traffic areas are highly desirable to other gas station operators as well as attractive locations for other entities that may use the 
land for alternative purposes. As a result of the limited availability of undeveloped real estate in these areas, particularly in the 
northeastern U.S., we believe the locations of our sites present high barriers of entry for new retail gas station operators to compete 
with the operators of our sites.  

The following table shows the geographic distribution by state of the aggregate number of sites we owned or leased at  
December 31, 2014:  

Pennsylvania 
New Jersey 
Virginia (a) 
Ohio 
Massachusetts 
Tennessee 
Florida   
New York 
New Hampshire   
West Virginia 
Illinois 
Maine 
Kentucky 
Indiana   
Delaware 
Maryland 

Total 

Owned 
Sites  

75  
58  
33  
58  
3  
43  
9  
27  
  —    
  —    
4  
  —    
3  
1  
  —    
  —    

  314  

Leased 
Sites  

56  
49  
50  
18  
67  
7  
37  
5  
21  
14  
4  
8  
4  
2  
1  
1  

  344  

Total 
Sites  
  131  
  107  
  83  
  76  
  70  
  50  
  46  
  32  
  21  
  14  
8  
8  
7  
3  
1  
1  

  658  

Percentage of 
Total Sites  

20% 
16% 
13% 
12% 
11% 
8% 
7% 
5% 
3% 
2% 
1% 
1% 
1% 
    * 
    * 
    * 

100% 

(a) Includes company operated retail sites acquired in April 2014.  
*  Less than 1%  

In aggregate for fee and lease sites, the average remaining term as of December 31, 2014 for our leases with lessee dealers, 
commission agents, CST and LGO was 2.7 years, 3.3 years, 9.8 years and 13.1 years, respectively.  

Sites Owned  
We owned 314 sites as of December 31, 2014. We generally have focused on selectively acquiring sites within or contiguous to our 
existing market areas. In evaluating potential acquisition candidates, we consider a number of factors, including strategic fit, 
desirability of location, cost efficiency of serving the site with our wholesale business, price and our ability to improve the 
productivity and cash flow potential of a site. We consider acquiring ownership of sites that are not within or contiguous to our current 
markets if the opportunity meets certain criteria including, among others, the availability of other sites in the area, motor traffic, 
potential sales volumes and cash flow potential.  

We derive our rent income from sites we own that provide convenient fueling locations primarily in areas that are densely populated. 
We collect rent from the lessee dealers, commission agents, CST and LGO pursuant to lease agreements. The average remaining lease 
term for our lessee dealers, commission agents, CST and LGO at our owned sites as of December 31, 2014 was 2.1 years, 3.5 years, 
9.8 years and 13.3 years, respectively.  

13 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
Sites Leased  
As of December 31, 2014, we also leased 344 sites from third parties and then sub-leased these sites to lessee dealers, commission 
agents and LGO. The average remaining lease term for sites we lease from third parties, excluding the sale-leasebacks further 
discussed below, is 8.6 years as of December 31, 2014. Our sub-leases with the lessee dealers typically have three-year terms. The 
average remaining sub-lease term for sites we sub-lease to lessee dealers, commission agents and LGO was 3.2 years, 2.8 years and 
13.0 years as of December 31, 2014, respectively.  

Personal Property Rent Income  
The rent income we earn from sites we own or lease includes rent income associated with the personal property located on these sites, 
such as underground storage tanks and motor fuel pumps. The rent income we earn from leasing the personal property we own or 
lease may not be a qualified source of income. As a result, our wholly-owned subsidiary, Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc., a 
taxable C corporation, owns and leases (or leases and then sub-leases) certain of our personal property. Accordingly, rent income 
earned by Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc. on the personal property is taxed at the applicable corporate income tax rate.  

Site Dispositions  
We continually evaluate the performance of each of our sites to determine whether any particular site should be closed or sold based 
on profitability, trends and our competition in the surrounding area, as well as whether the site may be attractive to a buyer that may 
use it for an alternative purpose. The majority of the sites we have acquired were purchased from major integrated oil companies and 
other industry participants undertaking a process to divest large numbers of sites in single-sale transactions where potential buyers 
typically are not permitted to make offers on single or selected sites. Accordingly, we historically have purchased a number of sites 
that may not fit our strategic and geographic plans. We have, however, been successful at selling sites, which may not fit our strategic 
and geographic plans, at prices that we deem attractive under the circumstances. As part of the sale process for these sites, we attempt 
to enter into supply agreements with the purchasers of these sites so that we can distribute motor fuel to them after we sell them. 
Typically, we seek to use the proceeds from the sale of these sites to buy additional sites that better fit our strategic and geographic 
model.  

Seasonality  
Due to the nature of our business and our customer’s reliance, in part, on consumer travel and spending patterns, we experience more 
demand for motor fuel during the late spring and summer months than during the fall and winter. Travel and recreational activities are 
typically higher in these months in the geographic areas in which we operate, particularly in the northeastern U.S., increasing the 
demand for motor fuel that we distribute as well as the fuel we sell at our retail locations. Therefore, our distribution volumes are 
typically higher in the second and third quarters of the year and our results from operations may vary from quarter to quarter. 
However, the impact of seasonality has lessened with the recent acquisitions in new markets.  

Competition  
Our wholesale distribution operation primarily competes with other motor fuel distributors. We do not generally compete with major 
integrated oil companies as they have exited the wholesale distribution business in the markets in which we operate. We may 
encounter more significant competition if major integrated oil companies alter their current business strategy and decide to re-enter the 
wholesale distribution business, thereby reducing and/or eliminating their need to rely on wholesale distributors. In addition, 
independent dealers or sub-wholesalers may choose to purchase their motor fuel supplies directly from the major integrated oil 
companies. Major competitive factors for our wholesale operations include, among others, customer service, price and quality of 
service.  

The retail industry is highly competitive and marked by ease of entry and constant change in the number and type of retailers offering 
products and services of the type we sell in our convenience stores. We compete with other convenience store chains, independently 
owned convenience stores, motor fuel stations, supermarkets, drugstores, discount stores, dollar stores, club stores and hypermarkets. 
Over the past ten years, several non-traditional retailers, such as supermarkets, club stores and hypermarkets, have impacted the 
convenience store industry, particularly in the geographic areas in which we operate, by entering the motor fuel retail business. These 
non-traditional motor fuel retailers have captured a significant share of the retail motor fuel market, and we expect their market share 
will continue to grow. In addition, some large retailers and supermarkets are adjusting their store layouts and product prices in an 
attempt to appeal to convenience store customers. Major competitive factors include, among others, location, ease of access, product 
and service selection, motor fuel brands, pricing, customer service, store appearance, cleanliness and safety.  

14 

 
 
  
Environmental  
Environmental Laws and Regulations  
We are subject to various federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, including those relating to underground storage 
tanks, the release or discharge of hazardous materials into the air, water and soil, the generation, storage, handling, use, transportation 
and disposal of hazardous materials, the exposure of persons to hazardous materials, and the health and safety of employees.  

Environmental laws and regulations can restrict or impact our business activities in many ways, such as:  

• 

• 

• 

requiring remedial action to mitigate releases of hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or wastes caused by our 
operations or attributable to former operators;  
requiring capital expenditures to comply with environmental control requirements; and  
enjoining the operations of facilities deemed to be in noncompliance with environmental laws and regulations.  

Failure to comply with environmental laws and regulations may trigger a variety of administrative, civil and criminal enforcement 
measures, including the assessment of monetary penalties, the imposition of remedial requirements and the issuance of orders 
enjoining future operations. Certain environmental statutes impose strict, joint and several liability for costs required to clean up and 
restore sites where hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or wastes have been released or disposed of. Moreover, neighboring 
landowners and other third parties may file claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by the release of 
hydrocarbons, hazardous substances or other wastes into the environment.  

The trend in environmental regulation is to place more restrictions and limitations on activities that may affect the environment. As a 
result, there can be no assurance as to the amount or timing of future expenditures for environmental compliance or remediation, and 
actual future expenditures may be different from the amounts we currently anticipate. We try to anticipate future regulatory 
requirements that might be imposed and plan accordingly to remain in compliance with changing environmental laws and regulations 
and minimize the costs of such compliance.  

We do not believe that compliance with federal, state or local environmental laws and regulations will have a material adverse effect 
on our financial position, results of operations or cash available for distribution to our unitholders. We can provide no assurance, 
however, that future events, such as changes in existing laws (including changes in the interpretation of existing laws), the 
promulgation of new laws, or the development or discovery of new facts or conditions will not cause us to incur significant costs.  

Hazardous Substances and Releases  
In most instances, the environmental laws and regulations affecting our business relate to the release of hazardous wastes into the 
water or soils and include measures to control pollution of the environment. For instance, the Comprehensive Environmental 
Response, Compensation, and Liability Act, as amended, also known as CERCLA or the Superfund law, and comparable state laws 
impose liability, without regard to fault or the legality of the original conduct, on certain classes of persons who are considered to be 
responsible for the release of a hazardous substance into the environment. These persons include the owner or operator of the site 
where the release occurred and companies that disposed or arranged for the disposal of the hazardous substances. Under the Superfund 
law, these persons may be subject to joint and several liability for the costs of cleaning up the hazardous substances that have been 
released into the environment, for damages to natural resources and for the costs of certain health studies. The Superfund law also 
authorizes the EPA, and in some instances third parties, to act in response to threats to the public health or the environment and to seek 
to recover from the responsible persons the costs they incur. It is possible for neighboring landowners and other third parties to file 
claims for personal injury and property damage allegedly caused by hazardous substances or other pollutants released into the 
environment. In the course of our ordinary operations, we may generate waste that falls within the Superfund law’s definition of a 
hazardous substance, and as a result, we may be jointly and severally liable under the Superfund law for all or part of the costs 
required to clean up sites at which those hazardous substances have been released into the environment.  

15 

 
 
  
We currently own or lease sites where motor fuels are or have been handled for many years. Although we and our consultants have 
utilized operating and disposal practices in accordance with industry standards, wastes produced from remediation efforts require 
disposal at sites owned/operated by third parties whose treatment and disposal practices are not under our control. These sites and 
wastes disposed thereon may be subject to the Superfund law or other federal and state laws. Under these laws, we could be required 
to remove or remediate previously disposed wastes, including wastes disposed of or released by prior owners or operators, to clean up 
contaminated property.  

DMI is in the process of investigating and remediating contamination at a number of our sites as a result of recent or historic releases 
of petroleum products. At many sites, DMI is entitled to reimbursement from third parties for certain of these costs under third-party 
contractual indemnities, state trust funds and insurances policies, in each case, subject to specified deductibles, per incident, annual 
and aggregate caps and specific eligibility requirements. Although DMI will be required to indemnify us for these costs to the extent 
third parties (including insurers) fail to pay for remediation as DMI anticipates, insurance and indemnification are unavailable, and/or 
the state trust funds cease to exist or become insolvent, we may be obligated to pay these additional costs.  

Water Discharges  
The federal Clean Water Act imposes restrictions regarding the discharge of pollutants into navigable waters. This law and 
comparable state laws require permits for discharging pollutants into state and federal waters and impose substantial liabilities for 
noncompliance. EPA regulations also require us to obtain permits to discharge certain storm water runoff. Storm water discharge 
permits also may be required by certain states in which we operate. We believe that we hold the required permits and operate in 
material compliance with those permits. While we have experienced permit discharge exceedences, we do not expect any non-
compliance with existing permits and foreseeable new permit requirements to have a material adverse effect on our financial position 
or results of operations.  

Air Emissions  
Under the federal Clean Air Act and comparable state and local laws, permits are typically required to emit regulated air pollutants 
into the atmosphere. We believe that we currently hold or have applied for all necessary air permits and that we are in substantial 
compliance with applicable air laws and regulations. Although we can give no assurances, we are aware of no changes to air quality 
regulations that will have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash available for distribution to 
our unitholders.  

Various federal, state and local agencies have the authority to prescribe product quality specifications for the motor fuels that we sell, 
largely in an effort to reduce air pollution. Failure to comply with these regulations can result in substantial penalties. Although we 
can give no assurances, we believe we are currently in substantial compliance with these regulations.  

Efforts at the federal and state level are currently underway to reduce the levels of greenhouse gas (“GHG”) emissions from various 
sources in the United States. Even in the absence of new federal legislation, GHG emissions have begun to be regulated by the EPA 
pursuant to the Clean Air Act. For example, in April 2010, the EPA set a new emissions standard for motor vehicles to reduce GHG 
emissions. New federal or state restrictions on emissions of GHGs that may be imposed in areas of the United States in which we 
conduct business and that apply to our operations could adversely affect the demand for our products.  

Environmental Insurance and Escrow Accounts  
We are protected as an additional named insured by insurance which may cover in whole or in part certain expenditures to investigate, 
monitor and otherwise respond to releases of hazardous materials including petroleum products. We maintain insurance policies with 
insurers in amounts and with coverage and deductibles as our General Partner believes are reasonable and prudent. Before acquiring 
the property underlying a site, we use an environmental consultant to perform due diligence regarding the site to assess the exposure to 
risk of contamination, if any, at each site. Generally, when acquired sites require remediation, either the seller funds an escrow 
account for the cost to remediate the property, or the seller retains the obligation to remediate the property. In the circumstances where 
monies are placed in escrow to cover the estimated cost of remediation for known contamination, the accounts are used to pay for the 
appropriate remediation tasks, which are contracted out to remediation firms. In certain circumstances, insurance policies have also 
been procured to protect against remediation cost overruns.  

16 

 
 
  
With each acquisition, pollution insurance was procured to cover risks associated with unknown historic contamination that might not 
be identified during due diligence. In addition, we also participate in state insurance programs or obtain insurance policies in states 
that do not have programs to cover new contamination that arises post-acquisition. As of December 31, 2014, DMI had an aggregate 
of $5.1 million in escrow funds available to cover known contaminations at our existing sites. In addition to the escrow accounts, DMI 
maintains pollution insurance policies with total aggregate limits in excess of $85 million.  

In addition to the foregoing, on October 29, 2012, a “master” pollution policy was procured covering new conditions at all properties, 
including remediation and third-party liabilities. This policy treats any pollution condition that arose subsequent to the acquisition of 
the property by the predecessor entities as “new.” This policy also affords excess coverage to our underground storage tank policies 
and state programs and has $10.0 million in aggregate limits. Furthermore, in keeping with our practice of maintaining insurance for 
all of our acquisitions, upon completion of each acquisition, new “transactional” pollution policies are procured with limits of at least 
$5.0 million (for significant acquisitions). These policies typically are written as “no-retroactive date” coverage, meaning they provide 
coverage (for remediation costs and third party claims) arising from unknown, historic pollution conditions, as well as from new 
conditions arising post acquisition, without limitations on when the pollution condition first arose . For any smaller or single-site 
acquisitions, coverage for such sites is typically endorsed on the “master” policy identified above. Furthermore, the Partnership has 
coverage for new releases from its underground storage tanks through state run underground storage tank funds. In states where 
underground storage tank funds do not exist, the Partnership procures insurance specifically covering losses from its underground 
storage tanks. Thus, in addition to the insurance protection afforded under the DMI pollution policies identified above, as well as state 
funds, as of December 31, 2014, the Partnership maintains pollution insurance policies with total aggregate limits in excess of 
$50 million and continues to grow its pollution insurance portfolio with each acquisition.  

While the Partnership generally views its pollution insurance portfolio as an excellent balance against the inherent risk associated with 
acquiring and maintaining a portfolio of gas stations, these policies and escrow amounts may not cover all environmental risks and 
costs, and may not provide sufficient coverage in the event an environmental claim is made against us.  

Security Regulation  
Since the September 11, 2001 terrorist attacks on the United States, the U.S. government has issued warnings that energy 
infrastructure assets may be future targets of terrorist organizations. These developments have subjected our operations to increased 
risks. Increased security measures taken by us as a precaution against possible terrorist attacks have resulted in increased costs to our 
business. Any global and domestic economic repercussions from terrorist activities could adversely affect our financial condition, 
results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders. For instance, terrorist activity could lead to increased 
volatility in prices for motor fuels and other products we sell.  

Insurance carriers are currently required to offer coverage for terrorist activities as a result of the Terrorism Risk Insurance Act 
(TRIA). We purchased this coverage under our property and casualty insurance programs, which resulted in additional insurance 
premiums. Pursuant to the Terrorism Risk Insurance Program Reauthorization Act of 2007, TRIA has been extended through 
December 31, 2016. Although we cannot determine the future availability and cost of insurance coverage for terrorist acts, we do not 
expect the availability and cost of such insurance to have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations or 
cash available for distribution to our unitholders.  

Employee Safety  
Neither we, our subsidiaries, nor our General Partner have any employees. Substantially all of our executive management personnel 
were employees of DMI through December 31, 2014 and are employees of CST since January 1, 2015. CST will provide us with the 
management and labor sufficient to carry on our business. DMI and CST are subject to the requirements of the Occupational Safety 
and Health Act, or “OSHA,” and comparable state statutes that regulate the protection of the health and safety of workers. In addition, 
OSHA’s hazard communication standards require that information be maintained about hazardous materials used or produced in 
operations and that this information be provided to employees, state and local government authorities and citizens. We believe that 
DMI and CST are in substantial compliance with the applicable OSHA requirements.  

17 

 
 
  
Title to Properties, Permits and Licenses  
We believe we have all of the assets needed, including leases, permits and licenses, to operate our business in all material respects. 
With respect to any consents, permits or authorizations that have not been obtained, we believe that the failure to obtain these 
consents, permits or authorizations will have no material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash 
available for distribution to our unitholders.  

We believe we have satisfactory title to all of our assets. Title to property may be subject to encumbrances, including repurchase rights 
and use, operating and environmental covenants and restrictions, including restrictions on branded motor fuels that may be sold at 
such sites. We believe that none of these encumbrances will materially detract from the value of our sites or from our interest in these 
sites, nor will they materially interfere with the use of these sites in the operation of our business. These encumbrances may, however, 
impact our ability to sell the site to an entity seeking to use the land for alternative purposes.  

Facilities  
Our principal executive offices are in Allentown, Pennsylvania in an office space leased by DMI. The management fee charged by 
CST to the Partnership incorporates a rental charge. The lease expires on June 30, 2029.  

Employees  
Our General Partner manages our operations and activities on our behalf. Substantially all of our executive management personnel 
were employees of DMI through December 31, 2014 and are employees of CST since January 1, 2015. We and our General Partner 
have entered into an Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement with CST pursuant to which CST provides to us and our General 
Partner management services and manages our business and affairs. Similar to the Partnership, PMI has no employees. The 
management and store personnel are generally employees of a related party, Pinehurst Services LLC, to which PMI pays a 
management fee.  

As of December 31, 2014 there are 89 employees of CST providing the Partnership services under the Amended and Restated 
Omnibus Agreement that support the Partnership. No employees are represented by a collective bargaining agreement.  

As of December 31, 2014, Pinehurst Services LLC had 949 employees.  

Available Information  
We make available, free of charge on our Internet website (http://www.crossamericapartners.com), our annual report on Form 10-K, 
quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to 
Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file the material with, or furnish it 
to, the Securities and Exchange Commission.  

ITEM 1A. RISK FACTORS  
If any of the following risks were to occur, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be materially and adversely 
affected. In that case, we might not be able to pay distributions on our common units, the trading price of our common units could 
decline and you could lose all or part of your investment. Also, please read “Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking 
Statements.”  

Limited partner interests are inherently different from the capital stock of a corporation although many of the business risks to which 
we are subject are similar to those that would be faced by a corporation engaged in a similar business.  

18 

 
 
  
Risks Inherent in Our Business  
We may not have sufficient cash from operations to enable us to pay the minimum quarterly distribution following establishment 
of cash reserves and payment of fees and expenses.  

We may not have sufficient cash each quarter to pay the minimum quarterly distribution of at least $0.4375 per unit, or $1.75 per unit 
per year. The minimum quarterly distribution is an amount that must be paid to holders of our common units, including any 
arrearages, before any distributions may be made to holders of our subordinated units, to the extent that any distributions are made.  

The amount of cash we can distribute on our units principally depends upon the amount of cash we generate from our operations, 
which will fluctuate from quarter to quarter based on, among other things:  

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

• 

• 

demand for motor fuel products in the markets we serve, including seasonal fluctuations, and the margin per gallon we 
earn selling and distributing motor fuel;  
the industries in which we operate are subject to seasonal trends, which may cause our operating costs to fluctuate, 
affecting our earnings;  
severe storms could adversely affect our business by damaging our suppliers’ operations or lowering our sales volumes;  
competition from other companies that sell motor fuel products or operate convenience stores in our targeted market areas;  
the inability to identify and acquire suitable sites or to negotiate acceptable leases for such sites;  
the potential inability to obtain adequate financing to fund our expansion;  
the level of our operating costs, including payments to CST;  
prevailing economic conditions  
regulatory actions affecting the supply of or demand for motor fuel, our operations, our existing contracts or our operating 
costs; and  
volatility of prices for motor fuel.  

In addition, the actual amount of cash we will have available for distribution will depend on other factors such as:  

• 

•  

• 

•  

• 

•  

•  

the level of capital expenditures we make;  
the restrictions contained in our credit agreements;  
our debt service requirements;  
the cost of acquisitions;  
fluctuations in our working capital needs;  
our ability to borrow under our credit agreements to make distributions to our unitholders; and  
the amount, if any, of cash reserves established by our General Partner in its discretion.  

We do not have a legal obligation to pay quarterly distributions at our minimum quarterly distribution rate or at any other rate. There 
is no guarantee that we will distribute quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders in any quarter. See “Item 5. Market for 
Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities—Cash Distribution Policy”.  

The amount of cash we have available for distribution to unitholders depends primarily on our cash flow rather than on our 
 profitability, which may prevent us from making cash distributions, even during periods when we record net income.  

The amount of cash we have available for distribution depends primarily on our cash flow, and not solely on profitability, which will 
be affected by non-cash items. As a result, we may make cash distributions during periods when we record losses for financial 
accounting purposes and may not make cash distributions during periods when we record net income for financial accounting 
purposes.  

19 

 
 
  
If we are unable to make acquisitions on economically acceptable terms from CST or third parties, our future growth and ability to 
increase distributions to unitholders will be limited.  

Our strategy to grow our business and increase distributions to unitholders is dependent on our ability to make acquisitions that result 
in an increase in cash flow. Our growth strategy is based, in large part, on our expectation of ongoing divestitures of retail and 
wholesale fuel distribution assets by industry participants, including CST. CST has no contractual obligation to contribute any assets 
to us or accept any offer for its assets that we may choose to make. We may be unable to make accretive acquisitions for any of the 
following reasons:  

• 

•  

•  

• 

we are unable to identify attractive acquisition candidates or negotiate acceptable purchase contracts for them;  
we are unable to raise financing for such acquisitions on economically acceptable terms;  
we are outbid by competitors; or  
we or the seller are unable to obtain any necessary consents.  

If we are unable to make acquisitions from CST or third parties, our future growth and ability to increase distributions to unitholders 
will be limited. In addition, if we consummate any future acquisitions, our capitalization and results of operations may change 
significantly. We may also consummate acquisitions, which at the time of consummation we believe will be accretive, but ultimately 
may not be accretive. If any of these events occurred, our future growth would be limited.  

Any acquisitions, including future sales to us of assets by CST, are subject to substantial risks that could adversely affect our 
business, financial condition and results of operations and reduce our ability to make distributions to unitholders.  

Any acquisitions, including any future sales of assets to us by CST, involve potential risks, including, among other things:  

• 

•  

•  

• 

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

•  

• 

•  

the validity of our assumptions about revenues, capital expenditures and operating costs of the acquired business or assets, 
as well as assumptions about achieving synergies with our existing business;  
the incurrence of substantial unforeseen environmental and other liabilities arising out of the acquired businesses or assets, 
including liabilities arising from the operation of the acquired businesses or assets prior to our acquisition, for which we 
are not indemnified or for which the indemnity is inadequate;  
the costs associated with additional debt or equity capital, which may result in a significant increase in our interest 
expense and financial leverage resulting from any additional debt incurred to finance the acquisition, or the issuance of 
additional common units on which we will make distributions, either of which could offset the expected accretion to our 
unitholders from any such acquisition and could be exacerbated by volatility in the equity or debt capital markets;  
a failure to realize anticipated benefits, such as increased available cash per unit, enhanced competitive position or new 
customer relationships;  
the inability to timely and effectively integrate the operations of recently acquired businesses or assets, particularly those 
in new geographic areas or in new lines of business;  
a decrease in our liquidity by using a significant portion of our available cash or borrowing capacity to finance the 
acquisition;  
the incurrence of other significant charges, such as impairment of goodwill or other intangible assets, asset devaluation or 
restructuring charges;  
performance from the acquired assets and businesses that is below the forecasts we used in evaluating the acquisition;  
a significant increase in our working capital requirements;  
competition in our targeted market areas;  
customer or key employee loss from the acquired businesses; and  
diversion of our management’s attention from other business concerns.  

20 

 
 
  
In addition, our ability to purchase or lease additional sites involves certain potential risks, including the inability to identify and 
acquire suitable sites or to negotiate acceptable leases or subleases for such sites and difficulties in adapting our distribution and other 
operational and management systems to an expanded network of sites.  

Our reviews of businesses or assets proposed to be acquired are inherently imperfect because it generally is not feasible to perform an 
in-depth review of businesses and assets involved in each acquisition. Even a detailed review of assets and businesses may not 
necessarily reveal existing or potential problems, nor will it permit a buyer to become sufficiently familiar with the assets or 
businesses to fully assess their deficiencies and potential. For example, inspections may not always be performed on every asset, and 
environmental problems, such as groundwater contamination, are not necessarily observable even when an inspection is undertaken. 
Unitholders will not have the opportunity to evaluate the economic, financial and other relevant information that we will consider in 
determining the application of our funds and other resources toward the acquisition of certain businesses or assets.  

The industries in which we operate are subject to seasonal trends, which may affect our earnings and ability to make distributions.  

We experience more demand for our motor fuel and food and merchandise inventory at our convenience stores and quick-service 
restaurants during the late spring and summer months than during the fall and winter. Travel, recreational activities and construction 
are typically higher in these months in certain of the geographic areas in which we operate, increasing the demand for motor fuel that 
we distribute and, therefore, increasing the demand for our convenience store inventory. Therefore, our revenues are typically higher 
in the second and third quarters of our fiscal year. As a result, our results from operations may vary widely from period to period, 
affecting our earnings and ability to make cash distributions.  

Decreases in consumer spending, travel and tourism in the areas we serve could adversely impact our wholesale distribution and 
retail business.  

In the retail motor fuel industry, customer traffic is generally driven by consumer preferences and spending trends, growth rates for 
automobile and commercial truck traffic and trends in travel, tourism and weather. Changes in economic conditions generally or in our 
targeted markets specifically could adversely impact consumer spending patterns and travel and tourism in our markets, which could 
have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and our ability to make distributions.  

Our business, financial condition, results of operations and ability to make quarterly distributions to our unitholders are 
influenced by changes in demand for, and changes in the prices of, motor fuels, which could adversely affect our margins and our 
customers’ financial condition, contract performance and trade credit.  

Financial and operating results from our wholesale distribution and retail operations are influenced by price volatility and demand for 
motor fuels. When prices for motor fuels rise, some of our wholesale customers may have insufficient credit to purchase supply from 
us at their historical purchase volumes, and their retail customers or our retail customers, in turn, may reduce consumption, thereby 
reducing demand for our product.  

Furthermore, when prices are increasing, we may be unable to fully pass our additional costs to our wholesale or retail customers, 
resulting in lower margins for us which could adversely affect our results of operations.  

Both the wholesale motor fuel distribution and the retail motor fuel industries are characterized by intense competition and 
 fragmentation, and our failure to effectively compete could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations 
and ability to make distributions.  

The market for distribution of wholesale motor fuel and the sale of retail motor fuel are highly competitive and fragmented, which 
results in narrow margins. We have numerous competitors, some of which may have significantly greater resources and name 
recognition than we do. We rely on our ability to provide value added reliable services and to control our operating costs to maintain 
our margins and competitive position. If we were to fail to maintain the quality of our services, wholesale customers could choose 
alternative distribution sources and retail customers could purchase from other retailers, each decreasing our margins. Furthermore, 
there can be no assurance that major integrated oil companies will not decide to distribute their own products in direct competition 
with us or that large wholesale customers will not attempt to buy directly from the major integrated oil companies. The occurrence of 
any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and our ability to make distributions.  

21 

 
 
  
We are exposed to risks of loss in the event of nonperformance by our wholesale customers and suppliers.  

A tightening of credit in the financial markets or an increase in interest rates may make it more difficult for wholesale customers and 
suppliers to obtain financing and, depending on the degree to which it occurs, there may be a material increase in the nonpayment or 
other nonperformance by our customers and suppliers. Even if our credit review and analysis mechanisms work properly, we may 
experience financial losses in our dealings with these third parties. A material increase in the nonpayment or other nonperformance by 
our wholesale customers and/or suppliers could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and ability to 
make distributions to our unitholders.  

Historical and current prices for motor fuel have been volatile and significant changes in such prices in the future may adversely 
affect our business, results of operations and ability to make distributions.  

Crude oil and domestic wholesale motor fuel markets are volatile. General political conditions, acts of war or terrorism and instability 
in oil producing regions, particularly in the Middle East, Russia, Africa and South America, could significantly impact crude oil 
supplies and wholesale motor fuel costs. Significant increases and volatility in wholesale motor fuel costs could result in significant 
increases in the retail price of motor fuel products and in lower margin per gallon. Increases in the retail price of motor fuel products 
could impact consumer demand for motor fuel. This volatility makes it extremely difficult to predict the impact future wholesale cost 
fluctuations will have on our operating results and financial condition. Dramatic increases in crude oil prices squeeze fuel margins 
because fuel costs typically increase faster than we are able to pass along the increases to customers. Higher fuel prices trigger higher 
credit card expenses, because credit card fees are calculated as a percentage of the transaction amount, not as a percentage of gallons 
sold. A significant change in any of these factors could materially impact our customer’s motor fuel gallon volumes, gross profit and 
overall customer traffic, which in turn could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and ability to make 
distributions.  

Energy efficiency and new technology may reduce the demand for our motor fuel and adversely affect our operating results.  

Increased conservation and technological advances, including the development of improved gas mileage vehicles and the increased 
usage of electrically powered cars, have adversely affected the demand for motor fuel. Future conservation measures or technological 
advances in fuel efficiency might reduce demand and adversely affect our operating results.  

We depend on three principal suppliers for the majority of our motor fuel. A disruption in supply or a change in our relationship 
with any one of them could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and cash available for 
distribution.  

ExxonMobil, BP and Motiva collectively supplied over 85% of our motor fuel purchases in 2014. Our wholesale business purchased 
approximately 37%, 28% and 22% of its motor fuel from ExxonMobil (a supplier of ours since 2002), BP (a supplier of ours since 
2009) and Motiva (a supplier of ours since 2004), respectively. A change of motor fuel suppliers, a disruption in supply or a 
significant change in our pricing with any of these suppliers could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations 
and cash available for distribution.  

We rely on our suppliers to provide trade credit terms to adequately fund our on-going operations.  

Our business is impacted by the availability of trade credit to fund motor fuel purchases and inventory purchases of our convenience 
stores. An actual or perceived downgrade in our liquidity or operations could cause our suppliers to seek credit support in the form of 
additional collateral, limit the extension of trade credit or otherwise materially modify their payment terms. Any material changes in 
the payments terms, including payment discounts, or availability of trade credit provided by our principal suppliers could impact our 
liquidity, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.  

22 

 
 
  
The convenience store industry is highly competitive and failure to effectively compete could result in lower sales and lower 
margins.  

The geographic areas in which we operate convenience stores are highly competitive. We compete with other convenience store 
chains, independently owned convenience stores, motor fuel stations, supermarkets, drugstores, discount stores, dollar stores, club 
stores, mass merchants and local restaurants. In addition, several non-traditional retailers, such as supermarkets, hypermarkets, club 
stores and mass merchants, have impacted the convenience store industry, particularly in the geographic areas in which we operate, by 
entering the motor fuel retail business. These non-traditional motor fuel retailers have captured a significant share of the motor fuels 
market, and it is anticipated that their market share will continue to grow. Many of our competitors have been in existence longer and 
have greater financial, marketing and other resources than we do. As a result, our competitors may be able to better respond to 
changes in the economy and new opportunities within the industry. We may not be able to compete successfully against current and 
future competitors, and competitive pressures faced by us could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of 
operations.  

We may incur costs or liabilities as a result of litigation or adverse publicity resulting from concerns over food quality, product 
safety, health or other issues that could cause consumers to avoid our restaurants.  

We operate convenience stores that sell food products. As a result, we may be the subject of complaints or litigation arising from food-
related illness or product safety which could have a negative impact on our business. Additionally, negative publicity, regardless of 
whether the allegations are valid, concerning food quality, food safety or other health concerns, restaurant facilities, employee 
relations or other matters related to our operations may materially adversely affect demand for our food and other products and could 
result in a decrease in customer traffic to our retail stores.  

The dangers inherent in the storage and transport of motor fuel could cause disruptions and could expose us to potentially 
significant losses, costs or liabilities.  

We store motor fuel in underground and above ground storage tanks. Additionally, we transport a portion of our motor fuel in our own 
trucks, instead of by third-party carriers. Our operations are subject to significant hazards and risks inherent in transporting and storing 
motor fuel. These hazards and risks include, but are not limited to, fires, explosions, traffic accidents, spills, discharges and other 
releases, any of which could result in distribution difficulties and disruptions, environmental pollution, governmentally-imposed fines 
or clean-up obligations, personal injury or wrongful death claims and other damage to our properties and the properties of others. As a 
result, any such event not covered by our insurance could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and 
results of operations.  

Pending or future consumer or other litigation could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.  

Our retail operations are characterized by a high volume of customer traffic and by transactions involving a wide array of product 
selections. These operations carry a higher exposure to consumer litigation risk when compared to the operations of companies 
operating in many other industries. Consequently, we may be party to individual personal injury, bad fuel, products liability and other 
legal actions in the ordinary course of our business. While we believe these actions are generally routine in nature, incidental to the 
operation of our business and immaterial in scope, if our assessment of any action or actions should prove inaccurate our financial 
condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.  

Additionally, we may be exposed to industry-wide or class-action claims arising from the products we carry, the equipment or 
processes we use or employ or industry-specific business practices. In recent years, several retailers have also experienced data 
breaches resulting in exposure of sensitive customer data, including payment card information. Any such breach of our systems, or 
any failure to secure our systems against such a breach, could expose us to customer litigation, as well as sanctions from the payment 
card industry. Retailers have also increasingly become targets of certain types of patent litigation by “non practicing entities” who 
acquire intellectual property rights solely for purposes of instituting mass litigation. While industry-specific or class action litigation of 
this type is less frequent in occurrence than individual consumer claims, the cost of defense and ultimate disposition may be material 
to our financial condition and results of operation.  

23 

 
 
  
Failure to comply with state laws regulating the sale of alcohol and cigarettes may result in the loss of necessary licenses and the 
imposition of fines and penalties on us, which could have a material adverse effect on our business.  

State laws regulate the sale of alcohol and cigarettes. A violation or change of these laws could adversely affect our business, financial 
condition and results of operations because state and local regulatory agencies have the power to approve, revoke, suspend or deny 
applications for, and renewals of, permits and licenses relating to the sale of these products or to seek other remedies. Such a loss or 
imposition could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.  

Our debt levels may limit our flexibility in obtaining additional financing and in pursuing other business opportunities.  

We have a significant amount of debt. As of December 31, 2014, we had $200.4 million outstanding on our existing revolving credit 
facility, with the ability to increase our borrowing capacity by an additional $100 million. See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and 
Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Liquidity – Long-term Debt” for a discussion of our amended and 
restated credit facility entered into in March 2014. Our level of indebtedness could have important consequences to us, including the 
following:  
•  

our ability to obtain additional financing, if necessary, for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or other 
purposes may be impaired or such financing may not be available on favorable terms;  
covenants contained in our credit agreement will require us to meet financial tests that may affect our flexibility in 
planning for and reacting to changes in our business, including possible acquisition opportunities;  
we will need a substantial portion of our cash flow to make interest payments on our indebtedness, reducing the funds that 
would otherwise be available for operations, future business opportunities and distributions to unitholders;  
our debt level will make us more vulnerable than our competitors with less debt to competitive pressures or a downturn in 
our business or the economy generally; and  
our debt level may limit our flexibility in responding to changing business and economic conditions.  

• 

• 

•  

•  

Our ability to service our indebtedness will depend upon, among other things, our future financial and operating performance, which 
will be affected by prevailing economic conditions and financial, business, regulatory and other factors, some of which are beyond our 
control. If our operating results are not sufficient to service our current or future indebtedness, we will be forced to take actions, such 
as reducing distributions, reducing or delaying our business activities, acquisitions, investments and/or capital expenditures, selling 
assets, restructuring or refinancing our indebtedness, or seeking additional equity capital or bankruptcy protection. We may not be 
able to effect any of these actions on satisfactory terms, or at all.  

Our credit facility contains operating and financial restrictions that may limit our business and financing activities.  

The operating and financial restrictions and covenants in our credit agreement and any future financing agreements could adversely 
affect our ability to finance future operations or capital needs or to engage, expand or pursue our business activities. For example, our 
credit agreement may restrict our ability to:  

•  

•  

•  

• 

•  

•  

• 

•  

make distributions if any potential default or event of default occurs;  
incur additional indebtedness or guarantee other indebtedness;  
grant liens or make certain negative pledges;  
make certain loans or investments;  
make any material change to the nature of our business, including mergers, consolidations, liquidations and dissolutions;  
make capital expenditures in excess of specified levels;  
acquire another company; or  
enter into a sale-leaseback transaction or sale of assets.  

24 

 
 
  
Our ability to comply with the covenants and restrictions contained in our credit agreement may be affected by events beyond our 
control, including prevailing economic, financial and industry conditions. If market or other economic conditions deteriorate, our 
ability to comply with these covenants may be impaired. If we violate any of the restrictions, covenants, ratios or tests in our credit 
agreement, the debt issued under the credit agreement may become immediately due and payable, and our lenders’ commitment to 
make further loans to us may terminate. We might not have, or be able to obtain, sufficient funds to make these accelerated payments. 
In addition, our obligations under our credit agreement will be secured by substantially all of our assets, and if we are unable to repay 
our indebtedness under our credit agreement, the lenders could seek to foreclose on such assets.  

We may not be able to lease sites we own or sub-lease sites we lease on favorable terms and any such failure could adversely affect 
our results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.  

We may lease and/or sub-lease certain sites to lessee dealers, commission agents, CST or to LGO where the rent expense is more than 
the lease payments. If we are unable to obtain tenants on favorable terms for sites we own or lease, the lease payments we receive may 
not be adequate to cover our rent expense for leased sites and may not be adequate to ensure that we meet our debt service 
requirements. We cannot provide any assurance that the margins on our wholesale distribution of motor fuels to these sites will be 
adequate to off-set unfavorable lease terms. The occurrence of these events could adversely affect our results of operations and cash 
available for distribution to our unitholders.  

The operations at sites we own or lease are subject to inherent risk, operational hazards and unforeseen interruptions and 
insurance may not adequately cover any such exposure. The occurrence of a significant event or release that is not fully insured 
could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and cash available for distribution.  

The presence of flammable and combustible products at our sites provides the potential for fires and explosions that could destroy 
both property and human life. Furthermore, our operations are subject to unforeseen interruptions such as natural disasters, adverse 
weather and other events beyond our control. Motor fuels also have the potential to cause environmental damage if improperly 
handled or released. If any of these events were to occur, we could incur substantial losses and/or curtailment of related operations 
because of personal injury or loss of life, severe damage to and destruction of property and equipment, and pollution or other 
environmental damage.  

We are not fully insured against all risks incident to our business. We may be unable to maintain or obtain insurance of the type and 
amount we desire at reasonable rates. As a result of market conditions, premiums and deductibles for certain of our insurance policies 
have increased and could escalate further. In some instances, certain insurance could become unavailable or available only for reduced 
amounts of coverage. If we were to incur a significant liability for which we were not fully insured, it could have a material adverse 
effect on our financial position and ability to make distributions to unitholders.  

We are relying on DMI to indemnify us for any costs or expenses that we incur for environmental liabilities and third-party claims, 
regardless of when a claim is made, that are based on environmental conditions in existence prior to the closing of the IPO at our 
Predecessor’s sites. To the extent escrow accounts, insurance and/or payments from DMI are not sufficient to cover any such costs 
or expenses, our business, liquidity and results of operations could be adversely affected.  

The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that DMI must indemnify us for any costs or expenses that we incur for environmental 
liabilities and third-party claims, regardless of when a claim is made, that are based on environmental conditions in existence prior to 
the closing of the IPO at our Predecessor’s sites. DMI is the beneficiary of escrow accounts created to cover the cost to remediate 
certain environmental liabilities. In addition, DMI maintains insurance policies to cover environmental liabilities and/or, where 
available, participates in state programs that may also assist in funding the costs of environmental liabilities. There are certain sites 
that were acquired by us in connection with the IPO with existing environmental liabilities that are not covered by escrow accounts, 
state funds or insurance policies. As of December 31, 2014, DMI had an aggregate of approximately $2.2 million of environmental 
liabilities on sites acquired by us that are not covered by escrow accounts, state funds or insurance policies. To the extent escrow 
accounts, insurance and/or payments from DMI are not sufficient to cover any such costs or expenses, our business, liquidity and 
results of operations could be adversely affected.  

25 

 
 
  
Our wholesale motor fuel sales are generated under contracts that must be renegotiated or replaced periodically. If we are unable 
to successfully renegotiate or replace these contracts, then our results of operations and financial condition could be adversely 
affected.  

Our wholesale motor fuel sales are generated under contracts that must be periodically renegotiated or replaced. As these contracts 
expire, they must be renegotiated or replaced. We may be unable to renegotiate or replace these contracts when they expire, and the 
terms of any renegotiated contracts may not be as favorable as the contracts they replace. Whether these contracts are successfully 
renegotiated or replaced is often times subject to factors beyond our control. Such factors include fluctuations in motor fuel prices, 
counterparty ability to pay for or accept the contracted volumes and a competitive marketplace for the services offered by us. If we 
cannot successfully renegotiate or replace our contracts or must renegotiate or replace them on less favorable terms, sales from these 
arrangements could decline and our ability to make distributions to our unitholders could be adversely affected.  

We are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations that govern the product quality specifications of the motor fuel that 
we distribute and sell.  

Various federal, state and local agencies have the authority to prescribe specific product quality specifications to the sale of 
commodities. Our business includes such commodities. Changes in product quality specifications, such as reduced sulfur content in 
refined petroleum products, or other more stringent requirements for fuels, could reduce our ability to procure product and our sales 
volume, require us to incur additional handling costs, and/or require the expenditure of capital. If we are unable to procure product or 
to recover these costs through increased sales, our ability to meet our financial obligations could be adversely affected. Failure to 
comply with these regulations could result in substantial penalties.  

Our operations are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations pertaining to environmental protection or operational 
safety that may require significant expenditures or result in liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on our business.  

Our business is subject to various federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, including those relating to underground 
storage tanks, the release or discharge of regulated materials into the air, water and soil, the generation, storage, handling, use, 
transportation and disposal of hazardous materials, the exposure of persons to regulated materials, and the health and safety of our 
employees. We believe we are in material compliance with applicable environmental requirements; however, we cannot assure you 
that violations of these requirements will not occur in the future. We also cannot assure you that we will not be subject to legal actions 
brought by third parties for actual or alleged violations of or responsibility under environmental laws associated with releases of or 
exposure to motor fuel products. A violation of, liability under or compliance with these laws or regulations or any future 
environmental laws or regulations, could have a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations.  

Where releases of refined petroleum products, renewable fuels and crude oil have occurred, federal and state laws and regulations 
require that such releases be assessed and remediated to meet applicable standards. The costs associated with the investigation and 
remediation of any such releases, as well as any associated third-party claims, could be substantial, and could have a material adverse 
effect on our business, results of operations and ability to make distributions to our unitholders.  

New, stricter environmental laws and regulations could significantly increase our costs, which could adversely affect our results of 
operations and financial condition.  

Our operations are subject to federal, state and local laws and regulations regulating environmental matters. The trend in 
environmental regulation is towards more restrictions and limitations on activities that may affect the environment. Our business may 
be adversely affected by increased costs and liabilities resulting from such stricter laws and regulations. We try to anticipate future 
regulatory requirements that might be imposed and plan accordingly to remain in compliance with changing environmental laws and 
regulations and to minimize the costs of such compliance. However, there can be no assurances as to the timing and type of such 
changes in existing laws or the promulgation of new laws or the amount of any required expenditures associated therewith.  

26 

 
 
  
We depend on transportation providers for the transportation of substantially all of our motor fuel. Thus, a change of providers or 
a significant change in our relationship could have a material adverse effect on our business.  

Substantially all of the motor fuel we distribute is transported from refineries to gas stations by third party carriers. A change of 
transportation providers, a disruption in service or a significant change in our relationship with these transportation carriers could have 
a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and ability to make distributions to our unitholders.  

We rely heavily on our information technology systems to manage our business, and a disruption of these systems or an act of 
cyber-terrorism could adversely affect our business.  

We depend on our information technology systems to manage numerous aspects of our business transactions, in particular with respect 
to our cash management and disbursements, and provide analytical information to management. Our information systems are an 
essential component of our business, and a serious disruption to our information systems could significantly limit our ability to 
manage and operate our business efficiently. These systems are vulnerable to, among other things, damage and interruption from 
power loss or natural disasters, computer system and network failures, loss of telecommunications services, physical and electronic 
loss of data, cyber-security breaches or cyber-terrorism, and computer viruses. Any disruption could adversely affect our business.  

Any terrorist attacks aimed at our facilities and any global and domestic economic repercussions from terrorist activities and the 
government’s response could adversely affect our business.  

Since the September 11, 2001 terrorist attacks on the United States, the U.S. government has issued warnings that energy 
infrastructure assets may be future targets of terrorist organizations. These developments have subjected our operations to increased 
risks. Terrorist attacks aimed at our facilities and any global and domestic economic repercussions from terrorist activities could 
adversely affect our financial condition, results of operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders. For instance, 
terrorist activity could lead to increased volatility in prices for motor fuels and other products we sell.  

Insurance carriers are currently required to offer coverage for terrorist activities as a result of the federal Terrorism Risk Insurance Act 
of 2002, which we refer to as “TRIA.” We purchased this coverage with respect to our property and casualty insurance programs, 
which resulted in additional insurance premiums. Pursuant to the Terrorism Risk Insurance Program Reauthorization Act of 2007, 
TRIA has been extended through December 31, 2016. Although we cannot determine the future availability and cost of insurance 
coverage for terrorist acts, we do not expect the availability and cost of such insurance to have a material adverse effect on our 
financial condition, results of operations and ability to make distributions to our unitholders.  

Risks Inherent in an Investment in Us  
CST controls us and may have conflicts of interest with us in the future.  

Through its GP Purchase, effective October 1, 2014, CST controls the GP, including the election of directors; decisions regarding 
mergers, consolidations or acquisitions, the sale of all or substantially all of our assets and other matters affecting our capital structure; 
and other significant decisions that could impact our financial results and the amount of cash available for distribution. In addition, 
CST may compete directly with us for future acquisitions, which may conflict with our core strategy to grow our business and increase 
distributions to unitholders. As long as CST continues to own our General Partner, it will continue to be able to effectively control our 
decisions.  

CST controls our General Partner, which has sole responsibility for conducting our business and managing our operations. Our 
General Partner and its affiliates, including CST, have conflicts of interest with us and limited fiduciary duties and they may favor 
their own interests to the detriment of us and our unitholders.  

CST owns and controls our General Partner and has the ability to appoint all of the directors of our General Partner. Although our 
General Partner has a legal duty to manage in good faith, the executive officers and directors of our General Partner have a fiduciary 
duty to manage our General Partner in a manner beneficial to its owner, CST. Furthermore, certain officers of our General Partner are 
directors or officers of affiliates of our General Partner. Therefore, conflicts of interest may arise in the future between us and our 
unitholders, on the one hand, and our General Partner and CST, on the other hand. In resolving these conflicts of interest, our General 
Partner may favor its own interests and the interests of CST over our interests and the interests of our common unitholders. These 
conflicts include the following situations, among others:  

•  

our General Partner is allowed to take into account the interests of parties other than us, such as CST, in resolving 
conflicts of interest, which has the effect of limiting its fiduciary duty to our unitholders;  

27 

 
 
  
• 

•  

•  

• 

• 

• 

•  

• 

• 

• 

• 

•  

•  

•  

•  

neither our partnership agreement nor any other agreement requires CST to pursue a business strategy that favors us;  
some officers of our General Partner who will provide services to us will devote time to affiliates of our General Partner 
and may be compensated for services rendered to such affiliate;  
our partnership agreement limits the liability of and reduces fiduciary duties owed by our General Partner and also 
restricts the remedies available to unitholders for actions that, without the limitations, might constitute breaches of 
fiduciary duty;  
except in limited circumstances, our General Partner has the power and authority to conduct our business without 
unitholder approval;  
our General Partner determines the amount and timing of asset purchases and sales, borrowings, issuances of additional 
partnership securities and the creation, reductions or increases of cash reserves, each of which can affect the amount of 
cash that is available for distribution to our unitholders, including distributions on our subordinated units, and to the 
holders of the incentive distribution rights, as well as the ability of the subordinated units to convert to common units;  
our General Partner determines the amount and timing of any capital expenditures and whether a capital expenditure is 
classified as a maintenance capital expenditure, which reduces operating surplus. Such determination can affect the 
amount of cash available for distribution to our unitholders, including distributions on our subordinated units, and to the 
holders of the incentive distribution rights, as well as the ability of the subordinated units to convert to common units;  
our General Partner may cause us to borrow funds in order to permit the payment of cash distributions, even if the purpose 
or effect of the borrowing is to make a distribution on the subordinated units, to make incentive distributions or to 
accelerate the expiration of the subordination period;  
our partnership agreement permits us to distribute up to $15 million as operating surplus, even if it is generated from asset 
sales, non-working capital borrowings or other sources that would otherwise constitute capital surplus. This cash may be 
used to fund distributions on our subordinated units or the incentive distribution rights;  
our partnership agreement does not restrict our General Partner from causing us to pay it or its affiliates for any services 
rendered to us or entering into additional contractual arrangements with its affiliates on our behalf;  
our General Partner intends to limit its liability regarding our contractual and other obligations;  
our General Partner may exercise its right to call and purchase common units if it and its affiliates own more than 80% of 
the common units;  
our General Partner controls the enforcement of obligations that it and its affiliates owe to us;  
our General Partner decides whether to retain separate counsel, accountants or others to perform services for us;  
the holders of our incentive distribution rights may transfer their incentive distribution rights without unitholder approval; 
and  
our General Partner may elect to cause us to issue common units to the holders of our incentive distribution rights in 
connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to the incentive distribution rights without the approval 
of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our General Partner or the unitholders. This election may result in 
lower distributions to the common unitholders in certain situations.  

The board of directors of our General Partner may modify or revoke our cash distribution policy at any time at its discretion. Our 
 partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions at all.  

The board of directors of our General Partner has adopted a cash distribution policy pursuant to which we intend to distribute quarterly 
an amount at least equal to the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.4375 per unit on all of our units to the extent we have sufficient 
cash from our operations after the establishment of reserves and the payment of our expenses. However, the board may change such 
policy at any time at its discretion and could elect not to pay distributions for one or more quarters. In addition, our credit Facility 
includes certain restrictions on our ability to make distributions.  

28 

 
 
  
In addition, our partnership agreement does not require us to pay any distributions at all. Accordingly, investors are cautioned not to 
place undue reliance on the permanence of such a policy in making an investment decision. Any modification or revocation of our 
cash distribution policy could substantially reduce or eliminate the amounts of distributions to our unitholders. The amount of 
distributions we make, if any, and the decision to make any distribution at all will be determined by the board of directors of our 
General Partner, whose interests may differ from those of our common unitholders. Our General Partner has limited duties to our 
unitholders, which may permit it to favor its own interests or the interests of CST, to the detriment of our common unitholders.  

Neither we nor our General Partner have any employees and we rely solely on the employees of CST to manage our business. If 
our Amended Omnibus Agreement is terminated, we may not find suitable replacements to perform management services for us.  

Neither we nor our General Partner have any employees and we rely solely on CST to operate our assets. We and our General Partner 
have entered into an Amended Omnibus Agreement pursuant to which CST performs services for us and our General Partner, 
including the operation of our wholesale distribution and retail business and our properties. We are subject to the risk that our 
Amended Omnibus Agreement will be terminated and no suitable replacement will be found.  

The liability of DMI and CST is limited under our Amended Omnibus Agreement and we have agreed to indemnify DMI and CST 
against certain liabilities, which may expose us to significant expenses.  

The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that we must indemnify DMI and CST for certain liabilities, including any liabilities 
incurred by CST attributable to the operating and administrative services provided to us under the agreement, other than liabilities 
resulting from DMI’s or CST’s bad faith, fraud, or willful misconduct, as applicable.  

Our General Partner intends to limit its liability regarding our obligations.  

Our General Partner intends to limit its liability under contractual arrangements between us and third parties so that the counterparties 
to such arrangements have recourse only against our assets, and not against our General Partner or its assets. Our General Partner may 
therefore cause us to incur indebtedness or other obligations that are nonrecourse to our General Partner. Our partnership agreement 
provides that any action taken by our General Partner to limit its liability is not a breach of our General Partner’s fiduciary duties, even 
if we could have obtained more favorable terms without the limitation on liability. In addition, we are obligated to reimburse or 
indemnify our General Partner to the extent that it incurs obligations on our behalf. Any such reimbursement or indemnification 
payments would reduce the amount of cash otherwise available for distribution to our unitholders.  

If we distribute a significant portion of our cash available for distribution to our partners, our ability to grow and make 
acquisitions could be limited.  

We may determine to distribute a significant portion of our cash available for distribution to our unitholders. In addition, we expect to 
rely primarily upon external financing sources, including commercial bank borrowings and the issuance of debt and equity securities, 
to fund our acquisitions and expansion capital expenditures. To the extent we are unable to finance growth externally, distributing a 
significant portion of our cash available for distribution may impair our ability to grow.  

In addition, if we distribute a significant portion of our cash available for distribution, our growth may not be as fast as that of 
businesses that reinvest their cash available for distribution to expand ongoing operations. To the extent we issue additional units in 
connection with any acquisitions or expansion capital expenditures, the payment of distributions on those additional units may 
increase the risk that we will be unable to maintain or increase our per unit distribution level. There are no limitations in our 
partnership agreement or our new credit agreement on our ability to issue additional units, provided there is no default under the credit 
agreement, including units ranking senior to the common units. The incurrence of additional commercial borrowings or other debt to 
finance our growth strategy would result in increased interest expense, which, in turn, may impact the cash available for distribution to 
our unitholders.  

29 

 
 
  
There are no limitations in our partnership agreement on our ability to issue units ranking senior to the common units.  

In accordance with Delaware law and the provisions of our partnership agreement, we may issue additional partnership interests that 
are senior to the common units in right of distribution, liquidation and voting. The issuance by us of units of senior rank may 
(i) reduce or eliminate the amount of cash available for distribution to our common unitholders; (ii) diminish the relative voting 
strength of the total common units outstanding as a class; or (iii) subordinate the claims of the common unitholders to our assets in the 
event of our liquidation.  

Our partnership agreement replaces our General Partner’s fiduciary duties to holders of our units.  

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that eliminate and replace the fiduciary standards to which our General Partner would 
otherwise be held by state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership agreement permits our General Partner to make a number 
of decisions in its individual capacity, as opposed to in its capacity as our General Partner, or otherwise free of fiduciary duties to us 
and our unitholders. This entitles our General Partner to consider only the interests and factors that it desires and relieves it of any duty 
or obligation to give any consideration to any interest of, or factors affecting, us, our affiliates or our limited partners. Examples of 
decisions that our General Partner may make in its individual capacity include:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

how to allocate business opportunities among us and its affiliates;  
whether to exercise its call right;  
whether to elect to reset target distribution levels; and  
whether or not to consent to any merger or consolidation of the partnership or amendment to the partnership 
agreement.  

By purchasing a common unit, a unitholder is treated as having consented to the provisions in the partnership agreement, including the 
provisions discussed above.  

Our partnership agreement restricts the remedies available to holders of our units for actions taken by our General Partner that 
might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty.  

Our partnership agreement contains provisions that restrict the remedies available to unitholders for actions taken by our General 
Partner that might otherwise constitute breaches of fiduciary duty under state fiduciary duty law. For example, our partnership 
agreement:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

provides that whenever our General Partner makes a determination or takes, or declines to take, any other 
action in its capacity as our General Partner, our General Partner is required to make such determination, or 
take or decline to take such other action, in good faith, and will not be subject to any other or different 
standard imposed by our partnership agreement, Delaware law, or any other law, rule or regulation, or at 
equity;  
provides that our General Partner will not have any liability to us or our unitholders for decisions made in its 
capacity as a General Partner so long as it acted in good faith, meaning that it believed that the decision was in 
the best interest of our partnership;  
provides that our General Partner and its officers and directors will not be liable for monetary damages to us or 
our limited partners resulting from any act or omission unless there has been a final and non-appealable 
judgment entered by a court of competent jurisdiction determining that our General Partner or its officers and 
directors, as the case may be, acted in bad faith or, in the case of a criminal matter, acted with knowledge that 
the conduct was criminal; and  
provides that our General Partner will not be in breach of its obligations under the partnership agreement or its 
fiduciary duties to us or our limited partners if a transaction with an affiliate or the resolution of a conflict of 
interest is:  

(1) 

(2) 

approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of our General Partner, although our 
General Partner is not obligated to seek such approval; or  
approved by the vote of a majority of the outstanding common units, excluding any common units 
owned by our General Partner and its affiliates.  

30 

 
 
  
In connection with a situation involving a transaction with an affiliate or a conflict of interest, any determination by our General 
Partner must be made in good faith. If an affiliate transaction or the resolution of a conflict of interest is not approved by our common 
unitholders or the conflicts committee, then it will be presumed that, in making its decision, taking any action or failing to act, the 
board of directors acted in good faith, and in any proceeding brought by or on behalf of any limited partner or the partnership, the 
person bringing or prosecuting such proceeding will have the burden of overcoming such presumption.  

Our General Partner’s affiliates may compete with us.  

Our partnership agreement provides that our General Partner will be restricted from engaging in any business activities other than 
acting as our General Partner and those activities incidental to its ownership interest in us. Except as provided in the Amended 
Omnibus Agreement, affiliates of our General Partner are not prohibited from engaging in other businesses or activities, including 
those that might be in direct competition with us.  

Pursuant to the terms of our partnership agreement, the doctrine of corporate opportunity, or any analogous doctrine, does not apply to 
our General Partner, CST or any of their affiliates, including their executive officers and directors. Any such person or entity that 
becomes aware of a potential transaction, agreement, arrangement or other matter that may be an opportunity for us will not have any 
duty to communicate or offer such opportunity to us. Any such person or entity will not be liable to us or to any limited partner for 
breach of any fiduciary duty or other duty by reason of the fact that such person or entity pursues or acquires such opportunity for 
itself, directs such opportunity to another person or entity or does not communicate such opportunity or information to us. This may 
create actual and potential conflicts of interest between us and affiliates of our General Partner and result in less than favorable 
treatment of us and our unitholders. Conflicts of interest may arise in the future between us and our unitholders, on the one hand, and 
the affiliates of our General Partner and CST, on the other hand. In resolving these conflicts, CST may favor their own interests over 
the interests of our unitholders.  

CST, as the holder of our incentive distribution rights, may elect to cause us to issue common units to the holders of our incentive 
distribution rights in connection with a resetting of the target distribution levels related to the incentive distribution rights, without 
the approval of the conflicts committee of its board of directors or the holders of our common units. This could result in lower 
distributions to holders of our common units.  

CST, as the holder of our incentive distribution rights, has the right, at any time when there are no subordinated units outstanding and 
the holders of our incentive distribution rights have received incentive distributions at the highest level to which they are entitled 
(50%) for each of the prior four consecutive fiscal quarters, to reset the initial target distribution levels at higher levels based on our 
distributions at the time of the exercise of the reset election. Following such a reset election, the minimum quarterly distribution will 
be adjusted to equal the reset minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels will be reset to correspondingly higher 
levels based on percentage increases above the reset minimum quarterly distribution.  

If CST elects to reset the target distribution levels, it will be entitled to receive a number of common units. The number of common 
units to be issued to CST will equal the number of common units which would have entitled CST to an aggregate quarterly cash 
distribution in the prior quarter equal to the distributions to CST on the incentive distribution rights in the prior quarter. It is possible 
that, CST could exercise this reset election at a time when it is experiencing, or expects to experience, declines in the cash 
distributions that CST receives related to the incentive distribution rights and may, therefore, desire to be issued common units rather 
than retain the right to receive incentive distributions based on the initial target distribution levels. This risk could be elevated if our 
incentive distribution rights are transferred to another party. As a result, a reset election may cause our common unitholders to 
experience a reduction in the amount of cash distributions that our common unitholders would have otherwise received had we not 
issued new common units to the holder of our incentive distribution rights in connection with resetting the target distribution levels.  

Holders of our common units have limited voting rights and are not entitled to elect our General Partner or its directors, which 
could reduce the price at which the common units will trade.  

Unlike the holders of common stock in a corporation, unitholders have only limited voting rights on matters affecting our business 
and, therefore, limited ability to influence management’s decisions regarding our business. Unitholders will have no right on an annual 
or ongoing basis to elect our General Partner or its board of directors. The board of directors of our General Partner, including the 
independent directors, is chosen entirely by CST, as a result of its ownership of our General Partner, and not by our unitholders. 
Unlike publicly traded corporations, we will not conduct annual meetings of our unitholders to elect directors or conduct other matters 
routinely conducted at annual meetings of stockholders of corporations. As a result of these limitations, the price at which the common 
units will trade could be diminished because of the absence or reduction of a takeover premium in the trading price.  

31 

 
 
  
Even if holders of our common units are dissatisfied, they may not be able to remove our General Partner without the Topper 
Group’s consent.  

If our unitholders are dissatisfied with the performance of our General Partner, they will have limited ability to remove our General 
Partner. The vote of the holders of at least 66 2⁄3% of all outstanding common and subordinated units voting together as a single class is 
required to remove our General Partner. The Topper Group, including DMI, owns approximately 3.32% of our outstanding common 
units and 90.19% of our subordinated units, representing 30.04% of all currently outstanding units. Pursuant to a voting agreement, 
dated October 1, 2014, the Topper Group has agreed to vote such units in accordance with the recommendation of the Board of 
Directors of CST or the Board of Directors of the General Partner, respectively. Also, if our General Partner is removed without cause 
during the subordination period and no units held by the holders of the subordinated units or their affiliates are voted in favor of that 
removal, all remaining subordinated units will automatically be converted into common units and any existing arrearages on the 
common units will be extinguished. Cause is narrowly defined in our partnership agreement to mean that a court of competent 
jurisdiction has entered a final, non-appealable judgment finding our General Partner liable for acting in bad faith, or in the case of a 
criminal matter, acting with knowledge that the conduct was criminal, in each case in its capacity as our General Partner. Cause does 
not include most cases of charges of poor management of the business.  

Our General Partner interest or the control of our General Partner may be transferred to a third party without unitholder consent.  

Our General Partner may transfer its General Partner interest to a third party in a merger or in a sale of all or substantially all of its 
assets without the consent of our unitholders. Furthermore, our partnership agreement does not restrict the ability of the members of 
our General Partner to transfer its membership interests in our General Partner to a third party. The new members of our General 
Partner would then be in a position to replace the board of directors and executive officers of our General Partner with their own 
designees and thereby exert significant control over the decisions taken by the board of directors and executive officers of our General 
Partner. This effectively permits a “change of control” without the vote or consent of the unitholders.  

Our General Partner has a call right that may require unitholders to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price.  

If at any time our General Partner and its affiliates own more than 80% of the common units, our General Partner will have the right, 
but not the obligation, which it may assign to any of its affiliates or to us, to acquire all, but not less than all, of the common units held 
by unaffiliated persons at a price equal to the greater of (1) the average of the daily closing price of the common units over the 
20 trading days preceding the date three days before notice of exercise of the call right is first mailed and (2) the highest per-unit price 
paid by our General Partner or any of its affiliates for common units during the 90-day period preceding the date such notice is first 
mailed. As a result, unitholders may be required to sell their common units at an undesirable time or price and may not receive any 
return or a negative return on their investment. Unitholders may also incur a tax liability upon a sale of their units. Our General 
Partner is not obligated to obtain a fairness opinion regarding the value of the common units to be repurchased by it upon exercise of 
the call right. There is no restriction in our partnership agreement that prevents our General Partner from issuing additional common 
units and exercising its call right. If our General Partner exercised its call right, the effect would be to take us private and, if the units 
were subsequently deregistered, we would no longer be subject to the reporting requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, 
or the Exchange Act. As of December 31, 2014, the Topper Group, including DMI, owns approximately 3.32% of our outstanding 
common units and 90.19% of our subordinated units. At the end of the subordination period, assuming no additional issuances of units 
(other than upon the conversion of the subordinated units), the Topper Group, including DMI, will own 30.04% of our common units.  

The market price of our common units could be adversely affected by sales of substantial amounts of our common units in the 
public or private markets, including sales by the Topper Group, DMI or other large holders.  

As of February 20, 2015, we had 16,935,650 common units and 7,525,000 subordinated units outstanding. At the end of the 
subordination period, all of the subordinated units will convert into an equal number of common units. Sales by the Topper Group, 
DMI or other large holders of a substantial number of our common units in the public markets, or the perception that such sales might 
occur, could have a material adverse effect on the price of our common units or could impair our ability to obtain capital through an 
offering of equity securities. In addition, we have agreed to provide registration rights to the Topper Group, including DMI. Under our 
partnership agreement and pursuant to a registration rights agreement that we have entered into, the Topper Group and DMI have 
registration rights relating to the offer and sale of any units that they hold, subject to certain limitations.  

32 

 
 
  
We may issue unlimited additional units without unitholder approval, which would dilute existing unitholder ownership interests.  

Our partnership agreement does not limit the number of additional limited partner interests, including limited partner interests that 
rank senior to the common units that we may issue at any time without the approval of our unitholders. The issuance of additional 
common units or other equity interests of equal or senior rank could have the following effects:  

• 

•  

•  

• 

•  

•  

•  

our existing unitholders’ proportionate ownership interest in us will decrease;  
the amount of cash available for distribution on each unit may decrease;  
because a lower percentage of total outstanding units will be subordinated units, the risk that a shortfall in the payment of 
the minimum quarterly distribution will be borne by our common unitholders will increase;  
the ratio of taxable income to distributions may increase;  
the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding unit may be diminished;  
the claims of the common unitholders to our assets in the event of our liquidation may be subordinated; and  
the market price of the common units may decline.  

Our General Partner’s discretion in establishing cash reserves may reduce the amount of cash available for distribution to 
unitholders.  

The partnership agreement requires our General Partner to deduct from operating surplus cash reserves that it determines are necessary 
to fund our future operating expenditures. The General Partner may reduce cash available for distribution by establishing cash reserves 
for the proper conduct of our business, to comply with applicable law or agreements to which we are a party or to provide funds for 
future distributions to partners. These cash reserves will affect the amount of cash available for distribution to unitholders.  

Our partnership agreement restricts the voting rights of unitholders owning 20% or more of our common units.  

Our partnership agreement restricts unitholders’ voting rights by providing that any units held by a person or group that owns 20% or 
more of any class of units then outstanding, other than our General Partner and its affiliates, their transferees and persons who 
acquired such units with the prior approval of the board of directors of our General Partner, cannot vote on any matter.  

Restrictions in our credit agreement could limit our ability to pay distributions upon the occurrence of certain events.  

Our payment of principal and interest on our debt will reduce cash available for distribution on our units. Our credit agreement will 
limit our ability to pay distributions upon the occurrence of the following events, among others:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

failure to pay any principal when due or any interest, fees or other amounts when due;  
failure of any representation or warranty to be true and correct in any material respect;  
failure to perform or otherwise comply with the covenants in our credit agreement or in other loan documents 
beyond the applicable notice and grace period;  
any default in the performance of any obligation or condition beyond the applicable grace period relating to 
any other indebtedness of more than $7.5 million;  
failure of the lenders to have a perfected first priority security interest in the collateral pledged by any loan 
party;  
the entry of a judgment in excess of $20.0 million, to the extent any payments pursuant to the judgment are not 
covered by insurance;  
a change in management or ownership control;  
a violation of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, or “ERISA”; and  
a bankruptcy or insolvency event involving us or any of our subsidiaries.  

Any subsequent refinancing of our debt or any new debt could have similar restrictions.  

33 

 
 
  
Management fees and cost reimbursements due to our General Partner and CST for services provided to us or on our behalf will 
reduce cash available for distribution to our unitholders. The amount and timing of such reimbursements will be determined by 
our General Partner.  

Prior to making any distribution on the common units, we will pay CST the management fee and reimburse our General Partner and 
CST for all out-of-pocket third-party expenses they incur and payments they make on our behalf. Our partnership agreement provides 
that our General Partner will determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. In addition, pursuant to the Amended 
Omnibus Agreement, CST will be entitled to reimbursement for certain expenses that they incur on our behalf. Our partnership 
agreement does not limit the amount of expenses for which our General Partner and CST may be reimbursed. The reimbursement of 
expenses and payment of fees, if any, to our General Partner and CST will reduce the amount of cash available to pay distributions to 
our unitholders.  

Unitholders may have liability to repay distributions and in certain circumstances may be personally liable for the obligations of 
the partnership.  

Under certain circumstances, unitholders may have to repay amounts wrongfully returned or distributed to them. Under Section 17-
607 of the Delaware Revised Uniform Limited Partnership Act, or the Delaware Act, we may not make a distribution to our 
unitholders if the distribution would cause our liabilities to exceed the fair value of our assets. Delaware law provides that for a period 
of three years from the date of the impermissible distribution, limited partners who received the distribution and who knew at the time 
of the distribution that it violated Delaware law will be liable to the limited partnership for the distribution amount. Liabilities to 
partners on account of their partnership interests and liabilities that are non-recourse to the partnership are not counted for purposes of 
determining whether a distribution is permitted.  

It may be determined that the right, or the exercise of the right by the limited partners as a group, to (i) remove or replace our General 
Partner, (ii) approve some amendments to our partnership agreement or (iii) take other action under our partnership agreement 
constitutes “participation in the control” of our business. A limited partner that participates in the control of our business within the 
meaning of the Delaware Act may be held personally liable for our obligations under the laws of Delaware, to the same extent as our 
General Partner. This liability would extend to persons who transact business with us under the reasonable belief that the limited 
partner is a General Partner. Neither our partnership agreement nor the Delaware Act specifically provides for legal recourse against 
our General Partner if a limited partner were to lose limited liability through any fault of our General Partner.  

The New York Stock Exchange, or “NYSE,” does not require a publicly traded partnership like us to comply with certain of its 
corporate governance requirements.  

Our common units are listed on the NYSE. Because we are a publicly traded partnership, the NYSE does not require us to have a 
majority of independent directors on our General Partner’s board of directors. Additionally, the NYSE does not require us as a 
publicly traded partnership to maintain a compensation committee or a nominating and corporate governance committee. Accordingly, 
unitholders will not have the same protections afforded to certain corporations that are subject to all of the NYSE corporate 
governance requirements. Please read “Management—Management of CrossAmerica Partners LP.”  

An increase in interest rates may cause the market price of our common units to decline and a significant increase in interest rates 
could adversely affect our ability to service our indebtedness.  

Like all equity investments, an investment in our common units is subject to certain risks. Borrowings under the credit facility will 
bear interest at variable rates. If market interest rates increase, such variable-rate debt will create higher debt service requirements, 
which could adversely affect our cash flow and ability to make cash distributions. In exchange for accepting these risks, investors may 
expect to receive a higher rate of return than would otherwise be obtainable from lower-risk investments. Accordingly, as interest rates 
rise, the ability of investors to obtain higher risk-adjusted rates of return by purchasing government-backed debt securities may cause a 
corresponding decline in demand for riskier investments generally, including yield-based equity investments such as publicly traded 
limited partnership interests. Reduced demand for our common units resulting from investors seeking other more favorable investment 
opportunities may cause the trading price of our common units to decline.  

The interest rate on our credit agreement is variable; therefore, we have exposure to movements in interest rates. A significant increase 
in interest rates could adversely affect our ability to service our indebtedness. The increased cost could make the financing of our 
business activities more expensive. These added expenses could have an adverse effect on our financial condition, results of 
operations and cash available for distribution to our unitholders.  

34 

 
 
  
Tax Risks  
Our tax treatment depends in large part on our status as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes and our otherwise not 
being subject to a material amount of U.S. federal, state and local income or franchise tax. If the Internal Revenue Services, or 
IRS, were to treat us as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes or if we were to otherwise be subject to a material 
amount of additional entity level income, franchise or other taxation for U.S. federal, state or local tax purposes, then our cash 
available for distribution to our unitholders would be substantially reduced.  

The anticipated after-tax benefit of an investment in our common units depends largely on our being treated as a partnership for U.S. 
federal income tax purposes. A publicly traded partnership, such as us, may be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax 
purposes unless 90% or more of its gross income for every taxable year it is publicly traded consists of qualifying income. Based on 
our current operations we believe that we will be able to satisfy this requirement and, thus, be able to be treated as a partnership, rather 
than a corporation, for U.S. federal income tax purposes. However, a change in our business, or a change in current law, could also 
cause us to be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes or otherwise subject us to entity-level taxation.  

If we were required to be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes or otherwise subject to entity-level taxation, 
then we would pay U.S. federal income tax on our taxable income at the corporate tax rate which, under current law, is a maximum of 
35%. We would also likely pay state and local income tax at varying rates. Distributions to our unitholders would generally be taxed 
again as either a dividend (to the extent of our current and accumulated earnings and profits) and/or as taxable gain after recovery of a 
unitholder’s U.S. federal income tax basis in their units, and no income, gains, losses, deductions or credits would flow through to our 
unitholders. Because a U.S. federal income tax would be imposed upon us as a corporation, our cash available for distribution to our 
unitholders would be substantially reduced. Thus, treatment of us as a corporation would result in a material reduction in the 
anticipated cash flow and after-tax return to our unitholders, likely causing a substantial reduction in the value of our common units.  

At the state level, were we to be subject to federal income tax, we would also be subject to the income tax provisions of many states. 
Moreover, because of widespread state budget deficits and other reasons, several states are evaluating ways to independently subject 
partnerships to entity-level taxation through the imposition of state income taxes, franchise taxes and other forms of taxation. For 
example, we are required to pay Texas margin tax on our gross income apportioned to Texas. Imposition of any additional such taxes 
on us or an increase in the existing tax rates would reduce the cash available for distribution to our unitholders.  

Our partnership agreement provides that if a law is enacted or existing law is modified or interpreted in a manner that results in us 
becoming subject to either: (a) entity-level taxation for U.S. federal, state, local and/or foreign income and/or withholding tax 
purposes to which we were not subject prior to such enactment, modification or interpretation, and/or (b) an increased amount of any 
such one or more of such taxes (including as a result of an increase in tax rates), then the minimum quarterly distribution amounts and 
the target distribution amounts may be adjusted (i.e., reduced) to reflect the impact of that law on us.  

We have a subsidiary that is treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes and is subject to entity-level U.S. federal, 
state and local income and franchise tax.  

We conduct a portion of our operations and business through one or more direct and indirect subsidiaries that are treated as 
corporations for federal income tax purposes (including LGWS). We may elect to conduct additional operations through these 
corporate subsidiaries in the future. These corporate subsidiaries are subject to corporate-level taxes, which reduce the cash available 
for distribution to us and, in turn, to unitholders. If the IRS were to successfully assert that these corporations have more tax liability 
than we anticipate or legislation were enacted that increased the corporate tax rate, our cash available for distribution to unit holders 
would be further reduced.  

35 

 
 
  
A significant amount of our income is attributable to our leasing of real property to LGO. If Lehigh Gas-Ohio Holdings LLC, or 
“LGO Holdings,” a Delaware limited liability company and the sole member of LGO, were to become related to us for U.S. federal 
income tax purposes, the real property rents that we receive from LGO would no longer constitute qualifying income and we would 
likely be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  

A significant amount of our qualifying income is comprised of real property rents from LGO attributable to the sites that LGO leases 
from us. In general, any real property rents that we receive from a tenant or sub-tenant of ours in which we, directly or indirectly, own 
or are treated as owning by reason of the application of certain constructive ownership rules: (a) at least 10% of such tenant’s or sub-
tenant’s stock (voting power or value) in the case where such tenant or sub-tenant is a corporation for U.S. federal income tax 
purposes, or (b) an interest of at least 10% of such tenant’s or sub-tenant’s assets or net profits in the case where such tenant or sub-
tenant is not a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes (as would be the case with respect to LGO), would not constitute 
qualifying income. After applying certain constructive ownership rules, we will be treated as owning the 5% interest in the assets and 
net profits of LGO Holdings that Joseph V. Topper, Jr. actually and constructively owns. If we were considered to directly or 
indirectly own an interest of 10% or more of the assets or net profits of LGO Holdings, then the real property rents that we receive 
from LGO would no longer constitute qualifying income in which case, based on our current operations, we would likely no longer 
qualify to be treated as a “partnership” (and instead would be treated as a corporation) for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  

Our and LGO Holdings’ governing documents contain transfer restrictions designed to prevent us from being treated as directly or 
indirectly owning by reason of the application of constructive ownership rules an interest of 10% or more of LGO Holdings’ assets or 
net profits. We received an opinion of counsel at the closing of the IPO that transfer restrictions are generally enforceable under 
Delaware law, but a court could determine that these restrictions are inapplicable or unenforceable.  

The tax treatment of publicly traded partnerships or an investment in our common units could be subject to potential legislative, 
judicial or administrative changes and differing interpretations, possibly on a retroactive basis.  

The present U.S. federal income tax treatment of publicly traded partnerships, including us, or an investment in our common units 
may be modified by administrative, legislative or judicial changes or differing interpretations at any time. For example, the Obama 
administration’s budget proposal for fiscal year 2016 recommends that certain publicly traded partnerships earning income from 
activities related to fossil fuels be taxed as corporations beginning in 2021. From time to time, members of Congress propose and 
consider such substantive changes to the existing federal income tax laws that affect publicly traded partnerships. If successful, the 
Obama administration’s proposal or other similar proposals could eliminate the qualifying income exception to the treatment of all 
publicly-traded partnerships as corporations upon which we rely for our treatment as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax 
purposes.  

Any modification to the U.S. federal income tax laws may be applied retroactively and could make it more difficult or impossible for 
us to meet the exception for certain publicly traded partnerships to be treated as partnerships for U.S. federal income tax purposes. We 
are unable to predict whether any of these changes or other proposals will ultimately be enacted. Any such changes could negatively 
impact the value of an investment in our common units.  

If the IRS contests the U.S. federal income tax positions we take, the market for our common units may be adversely impacted and the 
costs of any contest will reduce our cash available for distribution to our unitholders. We have not requested any ruling from the IRS 
with respect to our treatment as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes or any other U.S. federal income tax matter 
affecting us. The IRS may adopt positions that differ from the positions we take. It may be necessary to resort to administrative or 
court proceedings to sustain some or all of the positions we take. A court may not agree with some or all of the positions we take. Any 
contest with the IRS may materially and adversely impact the market for our common units and the price at which they trade. In 
addition, the costs of any contest with the IRS, which will be borne indirectly by our unitholders and our General Partner, will result in 
a reduction in cash available for distribution.  

Our unitholders are required to pay taxes on their share of income from us even if they do not receive any cash distributions from 
us.  

Our unitholders are required to pay U.S. federal income taxes and, in some cases, state and local taxes, on their allocable share of our 
taxable income and gain even if they do not receive any cash distributions from us. Our unitholders may not receive cash distributions 
from us equal to their share of our taxable income or even equal to the actual tax due with respect to that income.  

36 

 
 
  
Tax gain or loss on the disposition of our common units could be more or less than expected.  

If a unitholder sells common units, the unitholder will recognize a gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized and 
that unitholder’s tax basis in those common units. Because distributions in excess of a unitholder’s allocable share of our net taxable 
income result in a decrease in that unitholder’s tax basis in its common units, the amount, if any, of such prior excess distributions 
with respect to the units sold will, in effect, become taxable income to that unitholder, if that unitholder sells such units at a price 
greater than that unitholder’s tax basis in those units, even if the price received is less than the original cost. Furthermore, a substantial 
portion of the amount realized, whether or not representing gain, may be taxed as ordinary income due to potential recapture of 
depreciation and amortization deductions and certain other items. In addition, because the amount realized includes a unitholder’s 
share of our non-recourse liabilities, if a unitholder sells units, that unitholder may incur a tax liability in excess of the amount of cash 
received from the sale.  

Tax-exempt organizations and non-U.S. persons face unique tax issues from owning common units that may result in adverse tax 
consequences to them.  

Investment in our common units by an organization that is exempt from U.S. federal income tax, such as employee benefit plans, 
individual retirement accounts (or “IRAs”), and non-U.S. persons raises issues unique to them. For example, a substantial amount of 
our U.S. federal taxable income and gain constitute gross income from an unrelated trade or business and the amount thereof allocable 
to a tax-exempt organization would be taxable to such organization as unrelated business taxable income. Distributions to a non-U.S. 
person that holds our common units will be reduced by U.S. federal withholding taxes imposed at the highest applicable U.S. federal 
income tax rate and such non-U.S. person will be required to file U.S. federal income tax returns and pay U.S. federal income tax, to 
the extent not previously withheld, on his, her or its allocable share of our taxable income and gain. Any tax-exempt organization or a 
non-U.S. person should consult its tax advisor before investing in our common units.  

Our unitholders are subject to state and local income taxes and return filing requirements in states and localities where they do not 
live as a result of investing in our common units  

In addition to U.S. federal income taxes, our unitholders will likely be subject to other taxes, such as foreign, state and local income 
taxes, unincorporated business taxes and estate, inheritance or intangible taxes that are imposed by the various jurisdictions in which 
we do business or own property, even if they do not live in any of those jurisdictions. Our unitholders will likely be required to file 
state and local income tax returns and pay state and local income taxes in some or all of these various jurisdictions. Further, our 
unitholders may be subject to penalties for failure to comply with those requirements. We currently conduct business in Pennsylvania, 
New Jersey, Tennessee, Georgia, Ohio, New York, Massachusetts, Kentucky, New Hampshire, Maine, Florida, Maryland, Minnesota, 
Michigan, Wisconsin, South Dakota, Texas, Delaware and Virginia. Each of these states (other than Florida and Texas) currently 
imposes a personal income tax on individuals (except that Tennessee only imposes a personal income tax on interest and dividends 
and New Hampshire only imposes a personal income tax on interest, dividends and gambling winnings) as well as an income, business 
profits and/or a franchise tax on corporations and other entities. We may own property or conduct business in other states, localities or 
foreign countries in the future. It is the responsibility of each unitholder to file all U.S. federal, state, local and foreign tax returns. Our 
counsel has not rendered an opinion on the state, local or non U.S. tax consequences of an investment in our common units.  

We will treat each purchaser of our common units as having the same tax benefits without regard to the actual common units 
purchased. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could adversely affect the value of the common units.  

Because we cannot match transferors and transferees of common units, we will adopt depreciation and amortization positions that may 
not conform to all aspects of existing Treasury Regulations. A successful IRS challenge to those positions could adversely affect the 
amount of U.S. federal income tax benefits available to our unitholders. It also could affect the timing of these tax benefits or the 
amount of gain for U.S. federal income tax purposes from any sale of common units and could have a negative impact on the value of 
our common units or result in audit adjustments to a unitholder’s U.S. federal income tax returns.  

37 

 
 
  
We prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction for U.S. federal income tax purposes, and allocate them, between 
transferors and transferees of our common units each month based upon the ownership of our common units on the first business 
day of each month and as of the opening of the applicable exchange on which our common units are listed, instead of on the basis 
of the date a particular common unit is transferred. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could change the allocation of 
items of income, gain, loss and deduction among our unitholders.  

We generally prorate our items of income, gain, loss and deduction between transferors and transferees of our common units each 
month based upon the ownership of our common units on the first day of each month, instead of on the basis of the date a particular 
common unit is transferred. The use of this proration method may not be permitted under existing Treasury Regulations and although 
the U.S. Treasury Department issued proposed Treasury Regulations allowing a similar monthly simplifying convention, such 
regulations are not final and do not specifically authorize the use of the proration method we have adopted. If the IRS were to 
successfully challenge our proration method or new Treasury Regulations were to be issued, we may be required to change the 
allocation of items of income, gain, loss and deduction among our unitholders.  

If a unitholder loans their common units to a short seller to cover a short sale of common units, they may be considered to have 
disposed of those common units for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If so, the unitholder would no longer be treated for U.S. 
federal income tax purposes as a partner with respect to those common units during the period of the loan and they may recognize 
gain or loss from such deemed disposition.  

During the period of the loan of common units to the short seller, any of our income, gain, loss or deduction with respect to such 
common units may not be reportable by the respective unitholder and any cash distributions received by the unitholder as to those 
common units could be fully taxable to them as ordinary income. Our counsel has not rendered an opinion regarding the treatment of a 
unitholder where common units are loaned to a short seller to cover a short sale of common units. Thus, unitholders should consult 
their tax advisors regarding the U.S. federal income tax effect of loaning their common units to a short seller.  

We have adopted certain valuation methodologies that may result in a shift of income, gain, loss and deduction between our 
General Partner and the unitholders. The IRS may challenge this treatment, which could adversely affect the value of the common 
units.  

When we issue additional units or engage in certain other transactions, our General Partner will determine the fair market value of our 
assets and allocate any unrealized gain or loss attributable to our assets to the capital accounts of our unitholders and our General 
Partner. Although we may from time to time consult with professional appraisers regarding valuation matters, including the valuation 
of our assets, our General Partner will make many of the fair market value determinations of our assets using a methodology based on 
the market value of our common units as a means to measure the fair market value of our assets. Our methodology may be viewed as 
understating or overstating the value of our assets. In that case, there may be a shift of income, gain, loss and deduction between 
certain unitholders and our General Partner, which may be unfavorable to such unitholders. The IRS may challenge our valuation 
methods and allocations of income, gain, loss and deduction between our General Partner and certain of our unitholders.  

A successful IRS challenge to these methods or allocations could adversely affect the amount of taxable income, gain or loss being 
allocated to our unitholders for U.S. federal income tax purposes. It also could affect the amount of taxable gain from our unitholders’ 
sale of common units and could have a negative impact on the value of the common units or result in audit adjustments to our 
unitholders’ U.S. federal income tax returns without the benefit of additional deductions.  

38 

 
 
  
The sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interest in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period will result in the 
termination of our partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  

We will be considered to have technically terminated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes if there is a sale or 
exchange of 50% or more of the total interest in our capital and profits within a twelve-month period. For purposes of determining 
whether a technical tax termination has occurred, a sale or exchange of 50% or more of the total interests in our capital and profits 
could occur if, for example, the Topper Group, which will own collectively 50% or more of the total interest in our capital and profits 
at the time of the IPO, were to sell or exchange their collective interest in us within a period of twelve months. For purposes of 
determining whether the 50% threshold has been met, multiple sales of the same interest will be counted only once. Our technical 
termination would, among other things, result in the closing of our taxable year for all unitholders, which could result in us filing two 
U.S. federal income tax returns (and unitholders receiving two Schedule K-1s) for one calendar year. However, pursuant to an IRS 
relief procedure the IRS may allow, among other things, a constructively terminated partnership to provide a single Schedule K-1 for 
the calendar year in which a termination occurs. Our technical termination could also result in the re-starting of the recovery period for 
our assets (and, thus, result in a significant deferral of depreciation and amortization deductions allowable in computing our U.S. 
federal taxable income). In the case of a unitholder reporting on a taxable year other than a calendar year, the closing of our taxable 
year may also result in more than twelve months of our taxable income or loss being includable in his taxable income for the year of 
termination. Our technical termination, however, would not affect our classification as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax 
purposes but instead we would be treated as a new partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes. If we were treated as a new 
partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, we would be required to make new tax elections and could be subject to penalties if 
we were unable to determine that a technical termination occurred.  

ITEM 1B. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS  
None.  

ITEM 2. PROPERTIES  
A description of our properties is included in “Item 1. Business.” Our principal executive offices are in Allentown, Pennsylvania in an 
office space subleased from DMI. The lease expires on June 30, 2029.  

ITEM 3. LEGAL PROCEEDINGS  
From time to time, we are involved in litigation incidental to the conduct of our business. We do not expect that any of this litigation, 
individually or in the aggregate, will have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flow. We 
do not believe any legal proceeding involving our Predecessor will have a material adverse impact on our financial condition, results 
of operations or cash flows.  

Additional information regarding legal proceedings is included in Note 14 to the financial statements.  

ITEM 4. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES  
Not applicable.  

39 

 
 
  
  
Part II  

ITEM 5. MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER 
PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES  
As of February 20, 2015, we had 16,935,650 common units, held by approximately five holders of record outstanding. Our common 
units are listed and trade on the NYSE under the symbol “CAPL.” However, the 1,497,946 common units issued to CST associated 
with the drop down of fuel supply interests are not registered with the SEC and therefore cannot be traded on a public exchange. See 
“Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Unitholder Matters.”  

The following table sets forth the range of the daily high and low sales prices for our common units, as reported on the NYSE, and 
cash distributions paid per common unit, beginning on October 25, 2012, the date our units began trading, for the periods indicated. 
The last reported sales price of our common units on the NYSE on February 20, 2015 was $37.14 per common unit.  

Year ended December 31, 2014 
Fourth Quarter 
Third Quarter 
Second Quarter 
First Quarter 
Year ended December 31, 2013 
Fourth Quarter 
Third Quarter 
Second Quarter 
First Quarter 
Year ended December 31, 2012 
Fourth Quarter (from October 25, 2012) 

Price Ranges  

High  

Low  

Cash Distributions 
per unit (a)  

$ 40.82  
  38.65  
  27.85  
  29.17  

$ 29.07  
  29.18  
  26.25  
  23.88  

$ 

$ 

$ 29.51  
  25.55  
  25.86  
  25.50  

$ 26.16  
  24.61  
  21.25  
  18.74  

0.5425  
0.5325  
0.5225  
0.5125  

0.5125  
0.5025  
0.4775  
0.4525  

$ 21.65  

$ 16.66  

$ 

0.2948(b) 

(a)  Represents cash distributions attributable to the quarter. Cash distributions declared in respect of a calendar quarter are paid in 

the following calendar quarter.  

(b)  The distribution of $0.2948 per common unit corresponds to the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.4375 per unit prorated for 

the portion of the quarter after October 30, 2012, the closing date of our IPO.  

As of February 20, 2015, we had 7,525,000 subordinated units outstanding. These subordinated units are owned, directly or indirectly, 
by Joseph V. Topper, Jr. and John B. Reilly, III, and are not listed or traded on a public exchange. See “Item. 12 Security Ownership 
of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Unitholder Matters.”  

Cash Distribution Policy  
General  
The board of directors of our General Partner has adopted a policy that requires us to make cash distributions each quarter, in an 
amount determined by the board of directors of our General Partner following the end of such quarter. In general, we expect that cash 
distributed for each quarter will equal cash generated from operations less cash needed for maintenance capital expenditures, accrued 
but unpaid expenses, including the management fee to CST, reimbursement of expenses incurred by our General Partner, debt service 
and other contractual obligations and reserves for future operating and capital needs or for future distributions to our partners. We 
expect that the board of directors of our General Partner will reserve excess cash, from time to time, in an effort to sustain or permit 
gradual or consistent increases in quarterly distributions. Restrictions in our credit agreement could limit our ability to pay 
distributions upon the occurrence of certain events. See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and 
Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources—Credit Facility.” The board of directors of our General Partner may also 
determine to borrow to fund distributions in quarters when we generate less cash available for distribution than necessary to sustain or 
grow our cash distributions per unit. The factors that we believe will be the primary drivers of our cash generated from operations are 
changes in demand for motor fuels, the number of sites to which we distribute motor fuels, the margin per gallon we are able to 
generate at such sites and the profitability of sites we own and lease.  

40 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
Our cash distribution policy, established by our General Partner, is to distribute each quarter an amount at least equal to the minimum 
quarterly distribution of $0.4375 per unit on all units ($1.75 per unit on an annualized basis). We increased our distribution as 
indicated in Item I. Business and the distribution declared by the board of directors in February 2015 was $0.5425 per unit (or $2.17 
per unit on an annualized basis). Our General Partner may determine at any time that it is in the best interest of our Partnership to 
modify or revoke our cash distribution policy. Modification of our cash distribution policy may result in distributions of amounts less 
than, or greater than, our minimum quarterly distribution, and revocation of our cash distribution policy could result in no distributions 
at all. In addition, our Credit Facility includes certain restrictions on our ability to make cash distributions.  

Incentive Distribution Rights  
IDRs represent the right to receive an increasing percentage (15.0%, 25.0% and 50.0%) of our quarterly distributions from operating 
surplus after the minimum quarterly distribution and the target distribution levels (as described below) have been achieved. CST holds 
our IDRs and has the right to transfer these rights at any time. The distributions declared since March 2014 exceed the threshold and 
IDRs have participated in distributions since then.  

Minimum Quarterly Distribution  
Our partnership agreement provides that, during the subordination period (which we describe below), the common units will have the 
right to receive distributions from operating surplus each quarter in an amount equal to $0.4375 per common unit, which amount is 
defined in our partnership agreement as the minimum quarterly distribution, plus any arrearages in the payment of the minimum 
quarterly distribution on the common units from prior quarters, before any distributions of cash from operating surplus may be made 
on the subordinated units. The practical effect of the subordination period is to increase the likelihood that during such period there 
will be sufficient cash from operating surplus to pay the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.  

We will pay quarterly distributions, if any, each quarter in the following manner:  

• 

• 

• 

first, to the holders of common units, until each common unit has received a minimum quarterly distribution of 
$0.4375 plus any arrearages from prior quarters;  
second, to the holders of subordinated units, until each subordinated unit has received a minimum quarterly 
distribution of $0.4375; and  
third, to all unitholders, pro rata, until each unit has received a distribution of $0.5031.  

If cash distributions to our unitholders exceed $0.5031 per unit in any quarter, our unitholders and the holders of our incentive 
distribution rights, will receive distributions according to the following percentage allocations:  

Total Quarterly Distribution Per Common and Subordinated Unit 

Target Amount 
above $0.5031 up to $0.5469 
above $0.5469 up to $0.6563 
above $0.6563 

Marginal Percentage Interest 
in Distribution  

Unitholders  

Holders of IDRs  

85%   
75%   
50%   

15% 
25% 
50% 

Subordination Period  
Except as described below, the subordination period will expire on the first business day after the distribution to unitholders in respect 
of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending December 31, 2015, if each of the following has occurred:  

• 

• 

• 

distributions of cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units 
equaled or exceeded the minimum quarterly distribution of $0.4375 per unit for each of the three consecutive, 
non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date;  
the “adjusted operating surplus” (as defined in our partnership agreement) generated during each of the three 
consecutive, non-overlapping four-quarter periods immediately preceding that date equaled or exceeded the 
sum of the minimum quarterly distribution on all of the outstanding common and subordinated units during 
those periods on a fully diluted weighted average basis; and  
there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.  

41 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Early Termination of Subordination Period  
Notwithstanding the foregoing, the subordination period will automatically terminate on the first business day after the distribution to 
unitholders in respect of any quarter, beginning with the quarter ending December 31, 2013, if each of the following has occurred:  

• 

• 

• 

distributions of cash from operating surplus on each of the outstanding common and subordinated units 
equaled or exceeded $2.6250 (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) in the four-quarter 
period immediately preceding that date;  
the adjusted operating surplus generated during the four-quarter period immediately preceding that date 
equaled or exceeded the sum of $2.6250 (150.0% of the annualized minimum quarterly distribution) on all of 
the outstanding units on a fully diluted weighted average basis and the related distribution on the IDRs; and  
there are no arrearages in payment of the minimum quarterly distribution on the common units.  

Expiration upon Removal of the General Partner  
In addition, if the unitholders remove our General Partner other than for cause:  

• 

• 

the subordinated units held by any person will immediately and automatically convert into common units on a 
one-for-one basis, provided (1) neither such person nor any of its affiliates voted any of its units in favor of the 
removal and (2) such person is not an affiliate of the successor General Partner; and  
if all of the subordinated units convert pursuant to the foregoing, all cumulative arrearages on the common 
units will be extinguished and the subordination period will end.  

Expiration of the Subordination Period  
When the subordination period ends, each outstanding subordinated unit will convert into one common unit and will then participate 
pro-rata with the other common units in cash distributions.  

Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities  
As noted previously, the 1,497,946 common units issued to CST, in January 2015, associated with the drop down of fuel supply 
interests are not listed or traded on a public exchange. See “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and 
Related Unitholder Matters.”  

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities  
We did not repurchase any of our common units during the quarter ended December 31, 2014.  

ITEM 6. SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA  
The following table presents our summary historical financial and operating data for the periods and as of the dates indicated, which 
has been derived from our or our predecessor’s consolidated and combined financial statements. On October 30, 2012, we completed 
our IPO. At the closing of our IPO, a portion of the business of our predecessor and its subsidiaries and affiliates was contributed to 
CrossAmerica Partners LP. As such, the results of our predecessor are not comparable to our results as certain assets were not 
contributed to us as they did not meet our strategic and geographic plans.  

Please read the following data in connection with Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results 
of Operations and Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data, included in this Annual Report. Our historical results are not 
necessarily indicative of results to be expected in future periods.  

42 

 
 
  
The following table presents the non-GAAP financial measures EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow, which we 
use in our business as they are important supplemental measures of our performance and liquidity. We explain these measures in 
“Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Non-GAAP Financial Measures” 
and reconcile them to their most directly comparable financial measures calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP.  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31, 2012 
to December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2011  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2010  

  2,669,317  
8,640  

  1,936,059  
30,177  

311,774  
881  

1,573,502  
15,148  

  1,623,564  
21,526  

  1,192,078  
14,156  

(6,171) 

18,070  

(1,356) 

2,805  

10,689  

1,569  

$ 

(6,162)  $ 

18,070   $ 

(1,356) 

   $ 

3,114  

$ 

9,910  

$ 

(5,030) 

$ 

(0.32)  $ 

1.18   $ 

(0.09) 

$ 

(0.32)  $ 

1.18   $ 

658  
68,588  

556  
44,484  

906.2  
2.818   $ 

637.8  
2.968   $ 

0.076   $ 

0.070   $ 

$ 

$ 

42,087  
52,392  

51,509  
54,904  

35,031  

39,296  

1.76  

2.57  

(0.09) 

511  
9,936  

103.6  
2.959  

0.096  

3,463  
2,992  

999  

0.07  

2.1100  

1.9450  

0.2948  

0.8x  

1.3x  

0.2x  

477  
32,788  

368  
38,305  

332  
30,994  

501.6  
3.103  

0.065  

$ 

$ 

530.5  
3.019  

0.072  

$ 

$ 

516.3  
2.269  

0.060  

   $ 

   $ 

28,352  
25,804  

34,420  
31,232  

26,909  
25,981  

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

(c) 

Income Statement Data: 
Total revenues 
Operating income  
Income (loss) from 

continuing operations 
after income taxes 

Net income (loss) 

attributable to partners   

Net income (loss) per 

common and 
subordinated  
unit-basic 

Net income (loss) per 

common and 
subordinated unit-
diluted 

Operating Data: 
Sites owned and leased 
Fuel margin 
Gallons of motor fuel 

distributed  
(in millions) (a) 
Selling price per gallon 
Fuel margin per  
gallon (b) 

Other Financial Data 

(unaudited) 

EBITDA 
Adjusted EBITDA 
Distributable Cash Flow 

Distributable Cash Flow 

per unit-diluted 

Distribution 

Distribution coverage-

diluted 

(a)  Excludes gallons of motor fuel distributed to sites classified as discontinued operations with respect to the periods presented for 

our predecessor.  

(2) total gallons of motor fuel distributed.  

(b)  Fuel margin per gallon represents (1) total revenues from fuel sales, less total cost of revenues from fuel sales, divided by 

(c)  Results for these periods were not presented as these non-GAAP financial measures were not used at that time.  

43 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
 
    
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
     
  
  
 
     
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
     
  
  
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
    
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
Balance Sheet Data: 
Cash and cash equivalents  
Total current assets 
Total assets 
Total current liabilities 
Long-term debt, excluding current portion 
Total liabilities 
Total equity 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
as of 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
as of 
December 31, 
2013  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
as of 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
as of 
December 31, 
2011  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
as of 
December 31, 
2010  

$ 

15,170  
76,124  
604,646  
94,033  
201,276  
414,155  
190,491  

$ 

4,115  
35,496  
391,621  
38,857  
173,509  
296,950  
94,671  

$ 

4,768  
22,974  
317,851  
32,153  
183,751  
303,306  
14,545  

$ 

2,082  
27,982  
271,136  
44,515  
177,529  
303,823  
(32,687) 

$ 

2,988  
38,040  
257,415  
56,267  
156,940  
285,593  
(28,178) 

ITEM 7. MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF 
OPERATIONS  
The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with the 
Partnership and Predecessor Entity audited consolidated and combined financial statements and notes thereto included elsewhere in 
this Annual Report.  

Overview  
We are a Delaware limited partnership formed to engage in the distribution of motor fuels, consisting of gasoline and diesel fuel, and 
to own and lease real estate used in the retail distribution of motor fuels. Since our Predecessor was founded in 1992, we have 
generated revenues from the wholesale distribution of motor fuels to retail sites and from real estate leases. In the third quarter of 
2013, we also began generating revenues, on a select basis, through the retail distribution of motor fuels at sites operated by 
commission agents, and in the second quarter of 2014, as a result of the PMI acquisition, we began generating revenues from the 
operation of 87 convenience stores and nine branded, co-located quick-service restaurants.  

Our primary business objective is to make quarterly cash distributions to our unitholders and, over time, to increase our quarterly cash 
distributions. We intend to make minimum quarterly distributions of at least $0.4375 per unit (or $1.75 per unit on an annualized 
basis). Since the closing of our IPO, we have increased our distributions from $0.4375 per unit, per quarter (or $1.75 per unit on an 
annualized basis) to $0.5425 per unit, per quarter (or $2.17 per unit on an annualized basis) effective with the distribution with respect 
to the fourth quarter of 2014, a 24.0% increase. The amount of any distributions is subject to the discretion of the board of directors of 
our General Partner which may modify or revoke our cash distribution policy at any time. Our partnership agreement does not require 
us to pay any distributions.  

We believe consistent demand for motor fuels in the areas where we operate and the contractual nature of our rent income provides a 
stable source of cash flow. Cash flows from the wholesale distribution of motor fuels are generated primarily by a per gallon margin 
that is either a fixed or variable mark-up per gallon, depending on our contract terms. By delivering most motor fuels through 
independent carriers on the same day we purchase the motor fuels from suppliers, we seek to minimize the commodity price risks 
typically associated with the purchase and sale of motor fuels.  

We also generate revenues from rent income primarily by collecting rent from lessee dealers, CST and LGO pursuant to lease 
agreements. Our lease agreements with lessee dealers, CST and LGO had average remaining lease terms of approximately 2.7 years, 
9.8 years and 13.1 years as of December 31, 2014, respectively. The terms of our lease agreements with lessee dealers generally run 
concurrently with the terms of the wholesale supply agreements at the sites, and the lease agreements generally require the lessee 
dealers to purchase their motor fuel from us.  

As of December 31, 2014, approximately 60% of the sites to which we distribute motor fuels were owned or leased by us. In addition, 
we have agreements requiring the operators of these sites to purchase motor fuels from us.  

44 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As noted above, in the third quarter of 2013, we also began generating revenues from the retail distribution of motor fuels. As of 
December 31, 2014, we distributed retail fuels at approximately 163 sites. At 76 of these sites, we operate the retail fuel operations 
through a third-party commission agent and lease the non-fuel site operations to the commission agent. Our lease agreements with the 
commission agents had an average remaining lease term of approximately 3.3 years as of December 31, 2014. The commission agent 
pays rent to us for the use of the non-fuel related real and personal property at the site. The commission agent operates the non-fuel 
related operations at the site for its own account and receives from us a fixed rate per gallon of motor fuel distributed to the retail 
consumer. Following our PMI acquisition, we also began directly distributing retail fuel at 87 convenience stores. In addition to retail 
fuel distribution at these sites, we also operate and generate revenues from the convenience stores and nine branded, co-located quick-
service restaurants.  

For the year ended December 31, 2014, we were one of the ten largest independent distributors by volume in the United States for 
ExxonMobil, BP and Motiva. Approximately 95% of the motor fuels we distributed in the year ended December 31, 2014 were 
branded, including Chevron, Sunoco, Valero, Gulf and Citgo brands.  

For 2014, we distributed an aggregate of approximately 906.2 million gallons of motor fuels. As of December 31, 2014, we distributed 
motor fuels to 1,074 sites, comprised of the following classes of business:  

•  

• 

•  

• 

•  

•  

• 

416 sites operated by independent dealers;  
21 sites owned by us and operated by CST;  
200 sites owned or leased by us and operated by LGO;  
274 sites owned or leased by us and operated by lessee dealers;  
76 sites owned or leased by us and operated by commission agents; and  
87 sites owned or leased and operated by us.  
17 sub-wholesalers and sold various other products to commercial and residential customers.  

We own and lease sites primarily located in prime locations with strong motor fuel demand. We own and lease sites located in 
Pennsylvania, New Jersey, Ohio, New York, Massachusetts, Kentucky, New Hampshire, Maine, Florida, Maryland, Delaware, 
Tennessee, Virginia, Illinois, Indiana and West Virginia. We also distribute motor fuel in Georgia and North Carolina. As a result of 
the Erickson and Landmark acquisitions in 2015, we own and lease sites in Minnesota, Michigan, Wisconsin, South Dakota and 
Texas. Based on the most recent data available from the Energy Information Agency, of the 23 states in which we distribute motor 
fuel, nine were among the top ten consumers of gasoline in the United States and eight were among the top ten consumers of on-
highway diesel fuel in the United States for 2013.  

Recent Developments  
Acquisition of General Partner by CST  
On October 1, 2014, CST consummated the sale to CST of 100% of the membership’s interest in our General Partner from DMI, an 
entity wholly owned by the Topper Trust for which Joseph V. Topper, Jr. is the trustee (the “GP Purchase”), and all of the 
membership interests in limited liability companies formed by trusts for which each of Mr. Topper and John B. Reilly, III serves as 
trustee, which limited liability companies own all of the IDRs. CST is one of the largest independent retailers of motor fuels and 
convenience merchandise in North America.  

The General Partner manages the operations and activities of the Partnership. The Partnership is managed and operated by the board 
of directors and executive officers of the General Partner. As a result of the GP Purchase, CST controls the General Partner and has 
the right to appoint all members of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Immediately following the GP Purchase, we changed the name of the Partnership from Lehigh Gas Partners LP to “CrossAmerica 
Partners LP” and began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CAPL.”  

45 

 
 
  
Voting Agreement  
Mr. Topper entered into a Voting Agreement dated as of October 1, 2014, by and among Mr. Topper, the Topper Trust, DMI, an entity 
wholly owned by the Topper Trust for which Mr. Topper is the trustee (collectively, the “Topper Sellers”) and CST (the “Voting 
Agreement”) pursuant to which each of the Topper Sellers agrees that at any meeting of the holders of shares of CST common stock 
or common units or subordinated units of the Partnership it will vote or cause to be voted such Topper Seller’s shares or units, 
respectively, in accordance with the recommendation of the board of directors of CST or the board of directors of the General Partner, 
respectively. The Voting Agreement will remain in effect with respect to any Topper Seller for so long as any such Topper Seller is 
(a) a director or officer of CST or affiliate thereof, including the Partnership, (b) the beneficial owner of more than 3% of the 
outstanding common stock of CST or (c) the beneficial owner of 10% or more of the outstanding common units or subordinated units 
of the Partnership.  

Board of Directors  
On and effective as of October 1, 2014, Melinda B. German, Warren S. Kimber, Jr., John F. Malloy, Maura E. Topper and Robert L. 
Wiss, each a member of the board of directors of the General Partner, resigned in his or her capacity as such. Mr. Topper and 
Mr. Reilly remain members of the board of directors of the General Partner. CST has agreed to cause the appointment of Mr. Topper 
as a director of the General Partner for a period of at least five years commencing on October 1, 2014 or until a change in control of 
CST including circumstances in which CST no longer controls the General Partner. Further, Mr. Topper may be removed from the 
board of directors of the General Partner in certain circumstances where cause exists.  

On and effective as of October 1, 2014, CST, as the owner of the General Partner, appointed each of the following as members to the 
board of directors of the General Partner: Kimberly S. Lubel, Chief Executive Officer, President and Chairman of the board of 
directors of CST, Clayton E. Killinger, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of CST, and Stephan F. Motz, Senior Vice 
President and Chief Development Officer of CST, as directors of the board of directors of the General Partner, and Gene Edwards and 
Justin A. Gannon as independent directors of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Employment Agreement  
Mr. Topper and CST Services entered into an employment agreement dated as of October 1, 2014 (the “Topper Employment 
Agreement”), pursuant to which Mr. Topper was appointed as the Chief Executive Officer and President of the General Partner. The 
Topper Employment Agreement has a term of one year and will automatically renew for an additional one year term unless the parties 
agree otherwise or either party gives 60-day written notice prior to the end of the initial term. Mr. Topper’s base salary is $525,000 per 
year. He is eligible to receive a short-term incentive award equal to 75% of his base salary and an equity award equal to 200% of his 
base salary. Mr. Topper is entitled to participate in all employee benefit plans and programs generally available to similarly situated 
executives of CST Services LLC. CST Services may terminate Mr. Topper’s employment at any time for any reason.  

Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, Mr. Topper agrees that, during his employment and for a period equal to the 
greater of (i) the balance of his employment term and (ii) one year following termination for cause or his resignation without good 
reason (the “Restricted Period”), (x) he will not solicit or in any way be involved with any prior, current or prospective customer, 
client, consultant, broker or business partner of, or any person who had dealings with, CST Services or the Partnership and (y) he will 
not solicit for employment any person who is or was within the preceding six months an employee or consultant of CST Services or 
the Partnership. Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, during the Restricted Period, Mr. Topper also agrees that he will 
not associate in any way with any business that at any time during the Restricted Period is engaged in the business of CST Services or 
the Partnership other than those activities and businesses that Mr. Topper controls as of October 1, 2014.  

Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement  
We also entered into an Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, dated October 1, 2014, by and among the Partnership, the 
General Partner, DMI, CST Services, LGO and Mr. Topper (the “Amended Omnibus Agreement”), which amends and restates the 
Original Omnibus Agreement. The terms of the Amended Omnibus Agreement were approved by the former conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner, which is comprised solely of independent directors.  

46 

 
 
  
General. Pursuant to the Amended Omnibus Agreement, CST Services agrees, among other things, to provide, or cause to be 
provided, to the Partnership the management services previously provided by DMI on substantially the same terms and conditions as 
were applicable to DMI under the Original Omnibus Agreement. Pursuant to the terms of a transition services agreement by and 
between DMI and CST Services, DMI provided the management services it provided under the Original Omnibus Agreement to the 
Partnership on behalf of CST Services through December 31, 2014.  

The initial term of the Amended Omnibus Agreement is five years and will automatically renew for additional one year terms unless 
any party provides written notice to the other parties 180 days prior to the end of the then current term. The Partnership has the right to 
terminate the agreement at any time upon 180 days’ prior written notice.  

Rights of First Refusal. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, that for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, if 
(a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates have the opportunity to acquire assets used, or a controlling interest in 
any business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, and (b) the assets or 
businesses proposed to be acquired have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate, then Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their 
controlled affiliates will offer such acquisition opportunity to the Partnership and give the Partnership a reasonable opportunity to 
acquire, at the same price plus any related transaction costs and expenses, such assets or business, either before or promptly after the 
consummation of such acquisition by Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates. The decision to acquire or not acquire any 
such assets or businesses requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. Any assets 
or businesses that the Partnership does not acquire pursuant to the right of first refusal may be acquired and operated by Mr. Topper, 
DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates.  

Rights of First Offer. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, to notify the 
Partnership of their desire to sell any of their assets or businesses if (a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates, 
decides to attempt to sell (other than to another controlled affiliate of Mr. Topper, DMI or LGO) any assets used, or any interest in any 
business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, to a third party and 
(b) the assets or businesses proposed to be sold have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate. Prior to selling such assets or 
businesses to a third party, Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO are required to negotiate with the Partnership exclusively and in good faith for 
a reasonable period of time in order to give the Partnership an opportunity to enter into definitive documentation for the purchase and 
sale of such assets or businesses on terms that are mutually acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and the 
Partnership. If the Partnership and Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates have not entered into a letter of intent or a 
definitive purchase and sale agreement with respect to such assets or businesses within such period, Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, and their 
controlled affiliates, have the right to sell such assets or businesses to a third party following the expiration of such period on any 
terms that are acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and such third party. The decision to acquire or not 
to acquire assets or businesses pursuant to this right requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the 
General Partner.  

In accordance with the Amended Omnibus Agreement, the Partnership is required to pay CST a management fee, which is initially 
$670,000 per month plus a variable fee of between zero and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for 
retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. In addition, and subject to certain restrictions on CST’s ability to incur third-party fees, 
costs, taxes and expenses, the Partnership is required to reimburse CST and the General Partner for all reasonable out-of-pocket third-
party fees, costs, taxes and expenses incurred by CST or the General Partner on the Partnership’s behalf in connection with providing 
the services required to be provided by CST under the Amended Omnibus Agreement. The Partnership incurred $2.5 million in 
management fees under the Amended Omnibus Agreement in 2014, classified as selling, general and administrative expenses in the 
statements of operations.  

Accelerated Vesting of Awards to Certain Employees  
In connection with the October 1, 2014 GP Purchase as specified in the Lehigh Gas Partners LP Executive Income Continuity Plan 
(“EICP”), all unvested awards held by covered persons vested on October 1, 2014. As a result, 167,535 phantom units and 9,622 
profits interests granted to certain employees of DMI vested. The incremental charge recorded in 2014 associated with the accelerated 
vesting of these awards was approximately $4.6 million, included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

47 

 
 
  
Termination Payments Payable under the Employee Income Continuity Plan  
In addition to the incremental charge associated with the accelerated vesting of awards discussed above, we accrued $2.4 million of 
severance and benefit costs in 2014 related to certain covered persons under the Executive Income Continuity Plan who have 
terminated their employment. Such costs are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

Fuel Distribution Agreement and Lease Agreement with CST  
On October 1, 2014, we entered into a fuel distribution agreement and a lease agreement with CST that covers sites owned by the 
Partnership and operated by CST. The fuel distribution and lease agreements have initial 10-year terms with 5-year renewal terms 
until the agreements are terminated as permitted in the agreements. The fuel distribution agreement provides the Partnership with a 
fixed mark-up per gallon and the lease agreement is a triple net lease.  

Nice N Easy Acquisition  
CST and the Partnership jointly entered into an agreement to purchase, effective November 1, 2014, the convenience store assets, 
franchisor rights and associated trademarks of Nice N Easy. Nice N Easy operates corporate and franchise stores in central New York 
with a concentration in the Syracuse, New York region. Effective on November 1, 2014, CST assigned the rights to acquire the real 
property and underground storage tanks relating to 23 fee sites of Nice N Easy to LGWS and the fuel distribution agreements with 
respect to 25 Nice N Easy operated sites to LGW (collectively, the “Assignment”), for aggregate cash consideration of $65 million. 
We funded the acquisition with borrowings under our credit facility. CST purchased the working capital, convenience store operations 
and franchise operations.  

The conflicts committee and the executive committee of the board of directors of CST approved the original allocation of the purchase 
price between CST and the Partnership and subsequently approved an adjustment to the allocation of the purchase price so that the 
aggregate purchase price paid by the Partnership was $53.8 million, resulting in a payment in December 2014 of approximately 
$11.4 million from CST to the Partnership. In approving the transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an 
opinion from its independent financial advisor that the consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common 
unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of view.  

LGWS leases the acquired real estate to a subsidiary of CST, which will operate the sites. In addition, LGW distributes fuel to a 
subsidiary of CST that operates the acquired sites pursuant to a wholesale fuel distribution agreement.  

The preliminary purchase price allocation resulted in the recognition of $16.6 million of goodwill. A substantial portion of the 
goodwill represents the value that would have been allocated to wholesale fuel distribution rights. However, because the wholesale 
fuel distribution rights have been acquired as a result of CST assigning them to the Partnership, this intangible is not permitted to be 
recognized and so the residual value has been allocated to goodwill.  

PMI Acquisition  
On April 28, 2014, we exercised an option (the “Option”) to purchase 100% of the membership interests of Pinehurst Petroleum, LLC 
(“Pinehurst”) from Joseph L. Smith III and John A. Kopfer, Jr. (collectively “Smith/Kopfer”) for $4.0 million. Pinehurst’s sole asset 
was an Agreement and Plan of Merger among Pinehurst, PMI Merger Sub, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of Pinehurst (“Sub”), 
Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated (“PMI”), Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated Employee Stock Ownership Trust and Ronald R. 
Hare, in his capacity as representative (the “Merger Agreement”), pursuant to which Pinehurst agreed to acquire all of the shares of 
PMI for $73.5 million inclusive of an adjustment for working capital, through the merger (“the Merger”) of Sub and PMI. Under the 
terms of the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of PMI agreed to escrow $5.0 million for 25 months after the closing date of the 
Merger to secure the indemnity provisions contained in the Merger Agreement for the benefit of Pinehurst. The transaction was 
funded with borrowings under our credit facility. On April 30, 2014, pursuant to the Option, the Partnership purchased all of the 
equity interests of Pinehurst ($1.0 million of the consideration has been included in accrued expenses and other current and noncurrent 
liabilities at December 31, 2014). Subsequent to such purchase, the Merger became effective and, as a result, the Partnership became 
the owner of PMI.  

48 

 
 
  
PMI operates two primary lines of business: convenience stores and petroleum products distribution. In its convenience store business, 
PMI operates 87 convenience stores and nine co-located branded quick service restaurants located in Virginia and West Virginia. The 
convenience stores distribute primarily branded fuel and operate under PMI’s own proprietary convenience store brand, “Stop in Food 
Stores.” The petroleum products business distributes motor fuels and other petroleum products to customers throughout Virginia, West 
Virginia, Tennessee and North Carolina. The acquisition augmented the Partnership’s presence in Virginia and complements the 
existing Tennessee operations.  

On May 1, 2014, immediately subsequent to the effectiveness of the Merger, we caused PMI to divest its lubricants business (the 
“Lubricants Business”) to Zimri Holdings, LLC (“Zimri”), an entity owned by Smith/Kopfer, for the sum of $14.0 million pursuant to 
an Asset Purchase Agreement (the “APA”) between PMI and Zimri. The APA contains customary representations, warranties, 
agreements and obligations of the parties, as well as indemnity provisions. A trust controlled by Joseph V. Topper, Jr., Chairman and 
CEO of the General Partner, financed the purchase of the Lubricants Business by Zimri pursuant to a loan to Zimri. The financing by 
Mr. Topper’s trust was approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. In 2014, the trust 
that financed the purchase acquired the Lubricants Business.  

Atlas Acquisition  
On May 19, 2014, we completed our acquisition of 52 wholesale supply contracts, one sub-wholesaler contract, five fee sites, six 
leasehold sites and certain other assets from affiliates of Atlas Oil Company (“Atlas”) for $34.0 million. In addition, we acquired 
certain short-term notes receivable associated with the wholesale supply and commission marketing contracts for $5.2 million, 
bringing total consideration to $39.2 million, subject to closing adjustments. The transaction was funded by borrowings under our 
credit facility and $4.0 million of proceeds from the sale of the Lubricants Business that were directed to an escrow agent as part of an 
Internal Revenue Code Section 1031 like-kind exchange.  

These assets are located in the Chicago, Illinois area and are branded BP. The wholesale supply contracts have a remaining average 
term of 15 years and the fee or leasehold sites are currently leased to third party commission agents. The short-term notes receivable 
relate to previously negotiated purchase agreements of certain sites by the dealers occupying the locations. All of the notes receivable 
relate to sites supplied under contracts acquired in this transaction.  

In connection with the acquisition of PMI and assets from certain affiliates of Atlas, we amended our Omnibus Agreement, dated 
October 30, 2012, with our General Partner, DMI, LGO, and Joseph V. Topper, Jr. (as so amended , the “Original Omnibus 
Agreement”) with regard to the management fee payable by us to DMI effective July 1, 2014. The revised management fee consists of 
a base monthly fee of $670,000 per month and a variable fee of between zero and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and 
$0.015 per gallon for retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. The General Partner and DMI may waive all or any portion of the 
management fee to the extent that all or a portion of the management services are either purchased from another party or not required.  

Amended and Restated Credit Agreement  
In March 2014, we entered into an amended and restated credit agreement, and such agreement was further amended on 
September 30, 2014 (as so amended, the “Credit Facility”). The Credit Facility is a senior secured revolving credit facility maturing 
March 4, 2019 with a total borrowing capacity of $550.0 million, under which swing-line loans may be drawn up to $10.0 million and 
standby letters of credit may be issued up to an aggregate of $45.0 million. The Credit Facility may be increased, from time to time, 
upon our written request, subject to certain conditions, up to an additional $100.0 million. All obligations under the Credit Facility are 
secured by substantially all of our assets. The notional amount of availability at December 31, 2014, was $333.2 million.  

Equity Offering  
In September 2014, we issued 4,140,000 common units, inclusive of the underwriter’s over-allotment option, for $33.99 per unit, 
resulting in proceeds of $135.0 million, net of underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses. We used the proceeds 
to reduce indebtedness outstanding under our Credit Facility.  

49 

 
 
  
Amended PMPA Franchise Agreement with LGO  
We entered into an Amendment to the PMPA Franchise Agreement, effective as of October 1, 2014, by and between LGW, a 
subsidiary of the Partnership, and LGO (the “Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment”) pursuant to which the pricing terms 
were amended. Prior to the Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment, the agreement provided that we charge LGO dealer tank 
wagon pricing, which provided for a variable cent-per-gallon margin for each grade of product in effect at the time title to the product 
passed to LGO. The Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment amends the pricing terms of the agreement to provide for rack 
plus pricing and was approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. This pricing change 
is not expected to have a material impact on net income over the remaining term of the agreement.  

Sale of Wholesale Fuel Supply Contracts and Assignment of Leases to DMI  
The Partnership, DMI and LGO consummated a series of transactions pursuant to which DMI acquired, for an aggregate purchase 
price of $5.7 million and an earn-out in the amount of $0.8 million if DMI renews a single customer contract that expires in 2015, the 
wholesale fuel supply rights for 78 locations in Pennsylvania and New York previously supplied by the Partnership and the fuel 
supply rights of the Partnership to such sites was terminated. In addition, subleases for 12 of the sites, previously leased to us, were 
assigned to DMI or its affiliates. The terms of the transaction were approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of 
directors of the General Partner, which was comprised solely of independent directors. The volume associated with these sites for 
2013 was approximately 94 million gallons, of which approximately 36 million gallons represents sales to a sub-wholesaler at a de 
minimus margin and approximately 28 million gallons relates to a single contract expiring in 2015. In addition, rent expense for the 
leasehold sites included in the transaction exceeded the rent income on an annual basis by approximately $0.6 million for 2013.  

Because this was a transaction between entities under common control, the Partnership derecognized the assets and liabilities 
associated with the wholesale fuel supply contracts and leases and recognized the approximate $2.3 million excess of the purchase 
price over the net book value of the net assets divested as a contribution to partners’ capital on October 1, 2014.  

Subsequent Events  
Drop Down of Fuel Supply Interests  
Pursuant to a Contribution Agreement (the “Contribution Agreement”), dated December 16, 2014, by and among the Partnership, CST 
and CST Services, an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of CST, on January 2, 2015, we completed the acquisition, effective 
January 1, 2015, of a 5% limited partner interest in CST Fuel Supply LP (“CST Fuel”) from CST Services in exchange for 1,497,946 
newly issued common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership.  

CST Fuel owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in CST Marketing and Supply LLC (“CSTMS”), which is a 
party to a fuel supply agreement with a subsidiary of Valero Energy Corporation. The general partner of CST Fuel is CST USA, Inc., 
a wholly owned subsidiary of CST. CST will continue to indirectly own a 95% limited partner interest in CST Fuel.  

Immediately prior to closing and effective January 1, 2015, CST Services, CSTMS and certain subsidiaries of CST Services 
(“Purchasers”) entered into a fuel distribution agreement (the “Fuel Distribution Agreement”), pursuant to which CSTMS, on an 
annual basis, sells and delivers to the Purchasers, and the Purchasers will purchase, for at least 10 years no less than 1.57 billion 
gallons of branded and unbranded motor fuels at a fixed net margin of $0.05 per gallon for resale at retail sites operated by such 
Purchasers.  

The terms of the Contribution Agreement and Fuel Distribution Agreement were approved by the independent conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner. The conflicts committee retained independent legal and financial advisors to assist in 
evaluating and negotiating the transaction. In approving the transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an 
opinion from its independent financial advisor that the consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common 
unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of view.  

50 

 
 
  
Landmark Acquisition  
On January 8, 2015, CST and the Partnership jointly purchased 22 convenience stores from Landmark Industries. The stores operate 
under the Timewise brand name and provide Shell branded fuel. The sites are all owned fee simple and are located primarily in the 
San Antonio area. We purchased all of the real property and underground storage tanks as well as certain wholesale fuel distribution 
assets for $43.5 million, funded by borrowings under our Credit Facility. CST purchased the remaining personal property, working 
capital and the convenience store operations. The allocation of the purchase price between the Partnership and CST is subject to 
adjustment following completion of real property appraisals. 

LGWS leases the acquired real estate to CST under triple net leases and LGW distributes wholesale fuel to CST under long term 
agreements with a fuel gross profit margin of approximately 5 cents per gallon.  

Erickson Acquisition  
On February 1, 2015, we completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Erickson Oil Products, Inc. (“Erickson”) 
and certain related assets from GST Non-Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 
2010 and GST Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 2010 (collectively, the 
“Stock Sellers”), and certain real estate from Team Investments, LLC (together with the Stock Sellers, the “Sellers”). The purchase 
price was $85 million, subject to certain post-closing adjustments and indemnification and environmental remediation escrows, and 
was funded by borrowings under the Credit Facility.  

Erickson operates 64 convenience store sites located in Minnesota, Michigan, Wisconsin and South Dakota, with a concentration in 
the Minneapolis / St. Paul region, of which 59 are owned in fee simple and five are leased under long term leases. Certain of the 
convenience store sites owned in fee simple are subject to a right of first refusal held by SuperAmerica Franchising LLC, which, if 
exercised, will reduce the purchase price.  

In connection with the purchase, the Sellers and certain principals of the Sellers have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not to 
engage directly or indirectly in the retail petroleum or convenience store business in a designated geographic area surrounding the 
purchased convenience store sites for a period of four years following the closing.  

Outlook  
The Partnership expects its total fuel volume to increase in 2015, driven by the inclusion of a full year’s worth of results from the PMI, 
Atlas, and Nice N Easy acquisitions, as well as the results from the Erickson and Landmark acquisitions, offset by a decrease in 
volume as a result of market conditions. Based on current market conditions, we would expect our motor fuel gross margins to be 
consistent with historical results. We expect rent income to increase in 2015 as a result of recent acquisitions as well. In addition, we 
anticipate additional asset and/or fuel drops from CST.  

Earnings in future periods are subject to various risks and uncertainties. See “Forward-Looking Information,” “Item 1. Business,” 
“Item 1A. Risk Factors,” the rest of this Item 7, and Note 14 to the financial statements for a discussion of the risks, uncertainties and 
factors that may impact future results.  

Results of Operations  
Evaluating Our Results of Operations  
The primary drivers of our operating results are the volume of motor fuel we distribute, the margin per gallon we are able to generate 
on the motor fuel we distribute and the rent income we earn on the sites we own or lease. For owned or leased sites, we seek to 
maximize the overall profitability of our operations, balancing the contributions to profitability of motor fuel distribution and rent 
income. Our Amended Omnibus Agreement, under which CST provides management, administrative and operating services for us, 
enables us to manage a significant component of our operating expenses. Our management relies on financial and operational metrics 
designed to track the key elements that contribute to our operating performance. To evaluate our operating performance, our 
management considers gross profit from fuel sales, motor fuel volumes, margin per gallon, rent income for sites we own or lease, 
EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow.  

Gross Profit, Volume and Margin per Gallon - Gross profit from fuel sales represents the excess of revenues from fuel sales, including 
revenues from fuel sales to related parties, over cost of revenues from fuel sales, including cost of revenues from fuel sales to related 
parties. Volume of motor fuel represents the gallons of motor fuel we distribute to sites. Margin per gallon represents gross profit from 
fuel sales divided by total gallons of motor fuels distributed. We use volumes of motor fuel we distribute to a site and margin per 
gallon to assess the effectiveness of our pricing strategies, the performance of a site as compared to other sites we own or lease, and 
our margins as compared to the margins of sites we seek to acquire or lease.  

51 

 
 
  
Rent Income - We evaluate our sites’ performance based, in part, on the rent income we earn from them. For leased sites, we consider 
the rent income after payment of our lease obligations for the site. We use this information in combination with the fuel-related 
metrics noted previously to assess the effectiveness of pricing strategies for our leases, the performance of a site as compared to other 
sites we own or lease, and compare rent income of sites we seek to acquire or lease.  

EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow - Our management uses EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable 
Cash Flow to analyze our performance as more fully described in “Non-GAAP Financial Measures” later in Item 7.  

Comparison of Years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013  
The following table sets forth our statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands):  

Revenues: 

Revenues from fuel sales 
Revenues from fuel sales to related parties 
Revenue from food and merchandise sales 
Rent income 
Rent income from related parties 
Other revenues 

Total revenues  

Costs and Expenses: 

2014  

2013  

$ 
Variance  

% 
Variance  

$ 1,788,963  
764,509  
71,307  
21,764  
21,494  
1,280  

$  877,685  
  1,015,121  
—    
15,518  
26,059  
1,676  

$  911,278  
  (250,612) 
71,307  
6,246  
(4,565) 
(396) 

  103.8  
(24.7) 
n/a  
40.3  
(17.5) 
(23.6) 

  2,669,317  

  1,936,059  

  733,258  

37.9  

Cost of revenues from fuel sales 
Cost of revenues from fuel sales to related parties 
Cost of revenues from food and merchandise sales 
Rent expense 
Operating expenses   
Depreciation and amortization 
Selling, general and administrative expenses 
Gains on sales of assets, net 

  1,749,682  
735,202  
53,709  
19,051  
31,386  
32,981  
40,319  
(1,653) 

858,996  
989,326  
—    
15,509  
4,577  
20,963  
16,558  
(47) 

  890,686  
  (254,124) 
53,709  
3,542  
26,809  
12,018  
23,761  
(1,606) 

Total costs and operating expenses 

  2,660,677  

  1,905,882  

  754,795  

Operating income  
Interest expense   
Other income, net  

Income (loss) before taxes  
Income tax expense (benefit) 

Net income (loss)  
Net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests 

8,640  
(16,631) 
466  

(7,525) 
(1,354) 

(6,171) 
(9) 

30,177  
(14,182) 
359  

16,354  
(1,716) 

18,070  
—    

(21,537) 
(2,449) 
107  

(23,879) 
(362) 

(24,241) 
(9) 

  103.7  
(25.7) 
n/a  
22.8  
  585.7  
57.3  
  143.5  
n/a  

39.6  

(71.4) 
17.3  
29.8  

  (146.0) 
21.1  

  (134.2) 
n/a  

Net income (loss) attributable to partners 

$ 

(6,162) 

$ 

18,070  

$  (24,232) 

  (134.1) 

52 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
The Partnership began operating in two reportable segments commencing September 1, 2013. Effective with the PMI acquisition, the 
Partnership now also engages in the operation of convenience stores and branded quick-service restaurants. Given these changes, the 
Partnership conducts its business in two segments: 1) the wholesale segment and 2) the retail segment.  

Unallocated costs consist primarily of interest expense associated with the Credit Facility, selling, general and administrative 
expenses, income taxes and the elimination of the retail segment’s intersegment cost of revenues from fuel sales against the wholesale 
segment’s intersegment revenues from fuel sales. The profit in ending inventory generated by the intersegment fuel sale is also 
eliminated.  

The table below presents our results for the year ended December 31, 2014 by segment (in thousands).  

Revenues from fuel sales to external customers 
Intersegment revenues from fuel sales 
Revenues from food and merchandise sales   
Rent income 
Other revenue 

Total revenues 
Cost of revenues from fuel sales 
Cost of revenues from food and merchandise sales 
Rent expense 
Operating expenses 
Depreciation and amortization 
Selling, general and administrative expenses  
Loss (gains) on sales of assets, net   

Total costs and expenses 

Operating income (loss) 
Interest expense   
Other income, net  

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income 

taxes   

Income tax expense (benefit) 

Net income (loss)  

Wholesale 
$2,104,128  
204,276  
—    
38,498  
837  

  2,347,739  
  2,247,798  
—    
13,864  
12,930  
28,955  
—    
(1,653) 

Retail 
$ 449,344  
—    
  71,307  
4,760  
443  

  525,854  
  441,256  
  53,709  
5,187  
  18,456  
4,026  
—    
—    

Unallocated 
$  —    
  (204,276) 
—    
—    
—    

  (204,276) 
  (204,170) 
—    
—    
—    
—    
40,319  
—    

Consolidated 
$2,553,472  
—    
71,307  
43,258  
1,280  

  2,669,317  
  2,484,884  
53,709  
19,051  
31,386  
32,981  
40,319  
(1,653) 

  2,301,894  

  522,634  

  (163,851) 

  2,660,677  

45,845  
(5,678) 
422  

40,589  
—    

3,220  
(503) 
44  

2,761  
—    

(40,425) 
(10,450) 
—    

(50,875) 
(1,354) 

8,640  
(16,631) 
466  

(7,525) 
(1,354) 

$ 

40,589  

$  2,761  

$  (49,521) 

$ 

(6,171) 

53 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
The table below presents our results for the year ended December 31, 2013 by segment (in thousands).  

Revenues from fuel sales to external customers 
Intersegment revenues from fuel sales 
Rent income 
Other revenues 

Total revenues 
Cost of revenues from fuel sales 
Rent expense 
Operating expenses 
Depreciation and amortization 
Selling, general and administrative expenses  
Gains on sales of assets, net 

Total costs and expenses 

Operating income (loss) 
Interest expense   
Other income, net  

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income 

taxes   

Income tax expense (benefit) 

Net income (loss)  

Wholesale 
$1,824,568  
57,988  
40,210  
1,676  

  1,924,442  
  1,838,706  
15,350  
4,174  
20,288  
—    
(47) 

Retail 
$ 68,238  
  —    
  1,367  
  —    

  69,605  
  67,586  
159  
403  
675  
  —    
  —    

Unallocated 
$  —    
  (57,988) 
—    
—    

  (57,988) 
  (57,970) 
—    
—    
—    
  16,558  
—    

Consolidated 
$1,892,806  
—    
41,577  
1,676  

  1,936,059  
  1,848,322  
15,509  
4,577  
20,963  
16,558  
(47) 

  1,878,471  

  68,823  

  (41,412) 

  1,905,882  

45,971  
(4,479) 
349  

41,841  
—    

$ 

41,841  

782  
(169) 
10  

  (16,576) 
(9,534) 
—    

623  
  —    

$ 

623  

  (26,110) 
(1,716) 

$  (24,394) 

$ 

18,070  

30,177  
(14,182) 
359  

16,354  
(1,716) 

Revenues and Costs from Fuel Sales  
Our aggregate revenues from fuel sales, which include revenues from fuel sales to related parties, and aggregate cost of revenues from 
fuel sales, which include the cost of revenues from fuel sales to related parties, are principally derived from the purchase and sale of 
gasoline and diesel fuel with the resulting changes in aggregate revenues from fuel sales and aggregate cost of revenues from fuel 
sales, being attributable to the combination of volume of gallons of fuel distributed and/or fluctuations in market prices for crude oil 
and petroleum products, which are generally passed onto our customers.  

Revenues from fuel sales   
Cost of revenues from fuel sales 

Gross margin from fuel sales 
Volume   
Sales price per gallon 
Gross margin per gallon (a) 

2014  
$2,553,472  
$2,484,884  

$ 

$ 
$ 

68,588  
906,164  
2.818  
0.076  

2013  
$ 1,892,806  
$ 1,848,322  

$ 

$ 
$ 

44,484  
637,845  
2.968  
0.070  

$ 
Variance  
$660,666  
$636,562  

$  24,104  
  268,319  
$  (0.150) 
$  0.006  

% 
Variance  
34.9  
34.4  

54.2  
42.1  
(5.1) 
8.6  

(a)  The wholesale segment gross margin per gallon was $0.068 and $0.069 for 2014 and 2013, respectively. The retail segment 

gross margin per gallon was $0.059 and $0.032 for 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

The increase in aggregate revenues from fuel sales resulted from an increase of $797.3 million related to an increase in volume of 
gallons distributed offset by a $136.6 million impact resulting from a reduction in selling prices. The increase in volume of gallons 
distributed was principally related to our acquisitions, with 195.9 million gallons related to the PMI acquisition, 50.5 million gallons 
related to the Atlas acquisition, 37.4 million gallons related to the Manchester acquisition, 21.9 million gallons related to the Rocky 
Top acquisition, 12.5 million gallons related to the Rogers acquisition, and 1.1 million gallons related to new Getty sites. These 
increases were partially offset by decreases of 21.4 million gallons related to marketplace competition, 24.5 million gallons related to 
the sale of wholesale fuel supply contracts to DMI, 6.6 million gallons related to the closure of sites, and 4.3 million gallons related to 
terminated dealer supply contracts.  

54 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenues and Costs from Food and Merchandise Sales  
Revenues and costs from food and merchandise sales were generated by PMI. Margins of 25% were negatively impacted by the $1.6 
million fair value adjustment to merchandise inventory recorded in purchase accounting that was expensed as a one-time charge in the 
post-acquisition period.  

Rent Income  
Rent income, including rent income from related parties, increased $1.7 million to $43.3 million for 2014, from $41.6 million for 
2013. This increase was driven by $4.3 million of incremental rent income from the 2013 and 2014 acquisitions partially offset by the 
$1.9 million impact of leases with LGO that were terminated in the third quarter of 2013 associated with commission and closed sites 
and the $0.7 million impact of sites that have been sold.  

Other Revenues  
Other revenues decreased $0.4 million from $1.7 million to $1.3 million primarily due to a $0.6 million decrease in fees paid by 
dealers to terminate their supply contracts and a $0.5 million decrease in fees paid by dealers related to point-of-sale charges, partially 
offset by a $0.5 million increase in revenues from non-core services to residential customers within the PMI operations.  

Rent Expense  
Rent expense increased $3.6 million to $19.1 million for 2014, compared with $15.5 million for 2013. PMI drove a $4.0 million 
increase. The remaining increase was primarily due to the other 2013 and 2014 acquisitions, which resulted in an increase of 
$0.5 million, partially offset by a $0.4 million decrease as a result of the assignment of certain leases to DMI in connection with the 
GP Purchase and a $0.2 million decrease associated with terminated leases. The settlement of capital lease obligations at severed 
Getty sites resulted in gains of $0.4 million and $0.2 million for 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

Operating Expenses  
Operating expenses increased $26.8 million to $31.4 million for 2014, compared with $4.6 million for 2013. The PMI operations 
drove $22.1 million of the increase, which is comprised primarily of management fees incurred with a related party, repairs and 
maintenance, real estate taxes, utilities and supplies. Excluding the results of PMI, the remaining increase was primarily due to an 
increase in repairs and maintenance of $2.3 million and insurance expense of $0.4 million due to an increase in owned and leased sites 
as a result of the 2013 and 2014 acquisitions. We also incurred $1.5 million more in real estate taxes associated with certain 
commission sites for which the leases with the commission agents are not triple net leases. In addition, we incurred $0.2 million more 
in rebranding costs, primarily driven by the termination of the Chevron fuel purchase contract in order to rebrand certain sites in 
Florida from Chevron to ExxonMobil. Accretion of asset retirement obligations increased by $0.3 million primarily as a result of the 
change in operating and accounting policies to conform to CST’s policies (see Critical Accounting Policies – Asset Retirement 
Obligations” for more information).  

Depreciation and Amortization  
Depreciation and amortization increased $12.0 million to $33.0 million for 2014 from $21.0 million for 2013. This increase was 
driven by $11.4 million of incremental depreciation and amortization resulting from the 2013 and 2014 acquisitions, a $0.2 million 
write-off of the trademark associated with the Rogers acquisition as a result of rebranding those sites and a $0.2 million increase in 
impairment charges. In addition, there was a $0.3 million increase in depreciation as a result of the adjustment to asset retirement 
obligations related to the change in operating and accounting policies to conform to those of CST, partially offset by a $0.2 million 
decrease in amortization caused by the accelerated amortization method being used to amortize certain wholesale fuel supply 
contracts.  

55 

 
 
  
Selling, General and Administrative Expenses  
Selling, general and administrative expenses increased $23.7 million to $40.3 million for 2014, compared with $16.6 million for 2013. 
PMI drove $9.0 million of the increase, which was comprised primarily of management fees incurred with a related party, $5.6 million 
of acquisition costs as well as professional fees and non-income taxes. Excluding the results of PMI, the remaining increase was 
primarily due to the change in the management fee structure under the Amended and Original Omnibus Agreements and the increase 
in fuel volume, which resulted in an increase of $1.9 million, an increase in equity-based compensation expense of $8.5 million, $4.6 
million of which was related to the accelerated vesting upon the change-in-control, $2.4 million of severance and benefit costs payable 
under the EICP, an increase of $0.7 million in acquisition costs, a $0.5 million increase in employer payroll taxes reimbursed to an 
affiliate associated with the issuance of equity compensation and a $0.3 million increase in non-income taxes as a result of entering 
additional states.  

Acquisition costs incurred during 2014 and 2013 were $7.5 million and $1.2 million, respectively.  

Gains on Sales of Assets, net  
The gain recorded for 2014 related primarily to two site divestitures.  

Interest Expense  
Interest expense increased $2.4 million to $16.6 million compared with $14.2 million in 2013. The increase was primarily driven by 
an increase in average outstanding borrowings under the Credit Facility, which resulted in an increase of $0.7 million, and the seller 
financing issued in connection with the Rocky Top acquisition, which resulted in an increase of $1.5 million. In addition, we incurred 
$0.3 million of costs to amend our Credit Facility in July 2014 and deferred financing costs of $0.7 million were written off in 2014 as 
a result of changes in lenders in the amended credit facility, partially offset by the impact of extending the term of the credit facility in 
March 2014, which resulted in a decrease in amortization of $0.8 million.  

Income Tax Benefit  
We recorded a $1.4 million benefit in 2014, compared to a benefit of $1.7 million in 2013. The benefit recorded in 2014 was driven by 
a partial release of the valuation allowance against deferred tax assets of $1.4 million. The release was driven by the recognition of net 
deferred tax liabilities associated with the preliminary purchase price allocation related primarily to the acquisition of PMI, partially 
offset by the impact of the change in our operating and accounting policy associated with asset retirement obligations, which resulted 
in the recognition of a deferred tax asset. Since the purchase price allocation related to the PMI acquisition is preliminary, such release 
is subject to change and such change could be material. Further, in conjunction with our ongoing review of actual results and 
anticipated future earnings, we continuously reassess the possibility of releasing the remaining $5.7 million valuation allowance on 
deferred tax assets. It is reasonably possible that a significant portion of the valuation allowance will be released within the next 
twelve months.  

The valuation allowance release was partially offset by the impact of certain nondeductible acquisition costs and the taxable gain on 
the sale of the Lubricants Business for which a portion related to nondeductible goodwill.  

The deferred tax benefit recorded in 2013 was primarily related to a partial valuation allowance release in connection with the Express 
Lane acquisition and subsequent assignment of property and equipment by the Partnership to LGWS.  

56 

 
 
  
Comparison of Years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012  
Factors Affecting the Comparability of Our Financial Results  
For purposes of analyzing our 2013 results, we combined the results for the period from the IPO to December 31, 2012 with the 
results of our Predecessor Entity for the period January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012. However, the 2013 results are not directly 
comparable to the 2012 combined results for the following reasons:  

Publicly Traded Partnership Expenses - Our selling, general and administrative expenses include certain third-party costs and 
expenses resulting from becoming a publicly traded limited partnership. These costs and expenses include legal, accounting and costs 
associated with the generation and distribution of Form K-1s to the unitholders, as well as other costs associated with being a public 
company, such as director compensation, director and officer insurance, NYSE listing fees and transfer agent fees. Our financial 
statements reflect the impact of these costs and expenses and will affect the comparability of our financial statements with periods 
prior to the closing of the IPO.  

Original Omnibus Agreement - As a result of the services provided to us by DMI under the Original Omnibus Agreement, we did not 
directly incur a substantial portion of the general and administrative expenses that the Predecessor Entity had historically incurred. 
Instead, we paid DMI a management fee in an amount equal to (1) $420,000 per month plus (2) $0.0025 for each gallon of motor fuel 
we distributed per month for such services  

Impact of the IPO and Related Transactions on Our Revenues - LGO operates certain sites we own and distributes motor fuels, on a 
retail basis, at these sites. LGO is not one of our predecessor entities. Prior to the IPO, LGO did not pay rent on certain sites it leased 
from us. Upon completion of the IPO, LGO began paying us rent on these sites.  

Income Taxes - Our Predecessor Entity consists of pass-through entities for U.S. federal income tax purposes and has not been subject 
to U.S. federal income taxes. In order to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes, we must generate 90% or 
more of our gross income from certain qualifying sources. As a result, LGWS owns and leases (or leases and subleases) certain of our 
personal property, as well as provides maintenance and other services to lessee dealers and other customers. Except to the extent offset 
by deductible expenses, income earned by LGWS on the rental of the personal property and from maintenance and other services is 
taxed at the applicable corporate income tax rate.  

57 

 
 
  
The following table sets forth our statements of operations for the periods indicated (in thousands):  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

Total 
Consolidated 
and 
Combined 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
and 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2012  

$ 
Variance  

% 
Variance  

$ 

877,685  

$ 

143,695  

$  846,735  

$ 

990,430  

$ (112,745) 

(11.4) 

  1,015,121  
15,518  

26,059  
1,676  

162,792  
1,950  

3,228  
109  

709,645  
10,075  

5,969  
1,078  

872,437  
12,025  

  142,684  
3,493  

16.4  
29.0  

9,197  
1,187  

16,862  
489  

50,783  

  183.3  
41.2  

2.7  

Total revenues  

  1,936,059  

311,774  

  1,573,502  

  1,885,276  

Revenues: 

Revenues from fuel sales 
Revenues from fuel sales to 

related parties 

Rent income 
Rent income from related 

parties 

Other revenues 

Costs and Expenses: 

Cost of revenues from fuel 

sales 

Cost of revenues from fuel 
sales to related parties 
Cost of revenues from food 
and merchandise sale 

Rent expense 
Operating expenses   
Depreciation and 
amortization 
Selling, general and 

administrative expenses 

Loss (gains) on sales of 

assets, net 

Total costs and 

operating expenses 

Operating income  
Interest expense   
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
Other income, net  

Income (loss) from continuing 

operations before income taxes 
Income tax expense (benefit) from 

continuing operations 

Income (loss) from continuing 

operations after income taxes 

Income from discontinued 

operations 
Net income (loss)  

858,996  

139,226  

825,724  

964,950  

  (105,954) 

(11.0) 

989,326  

157,325  

697,868  

855,193  

  134,133  

15.7  

—    
15,509  
4,577  

20,963  

16,558  

(47) 

—    
2,045  
541  

2,551  

9,676  

9,563  
4,734  

13,773  

9,811  

11,608  
5,275  

16,324  

3,901  
(698) 

4,639  

33.6  
(13.2) 

28.4  

19,487  

(2,929) 

(15.0) 

(471)    

(3,119) 

(3,590) 

3,543  

(98.7) 

  1,905,882  

310,893  

  1,558,354  

  1,869,247  

15,148  
(11,369) 
(571) 
(403) 

2,805  

—    

2,805  

309  

16,029  
(13,295) 
(571) 
(372) 

36,635  

14,148  
(887) 
571  
731  

2.0  

88.3  
6.7  
  (100.0) 
  (196.5) 

1,791  

14,563  

  813.1  

342  

(2,058) 

  (601.8) 

1,449  

16,621  

 1,147.1  

309  

(309) 

  (100.0) 

$ 

3,114  

$ 

1,758  

$  16,312  

  927.9  

30,177  
(14,182) 
—    
359  

16,354  

(1,716) 

18,070  

—    

$ 

18,070  

$ 

881  
(1,926)    
—    
31  

(1,014)    

342  

(1,356)    

—    
(1,356)    

58 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Revenues and Costs from Fuel Sales  
Our aggregate revenues from fuel sales, which include revenues from fuel sales to related parties, and aggregate cost of revenues from 
fuel sales, which include the cost of revenues from fuel sales to related parties, are principally derived from the purchase and sale of 
gasoline and diesel fuel with the resulting changes in aggregate revenues from fuel sales, and aggregate cost of revenues from fuel 
sales, being attributable to the combination of volume of gallons of fuel distributed and/or fluctuations in market prices for crude oil 
and petroleum products, which are generally passed onto our customers.  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  
$  1,892,806  
$  1,848,322  

$ 

$ 
$ 

44,484  
637,845  
2.968  
0.070  

Revenues from fuel sales   
Cost of revenues from fuel sales 

Gross margin from fuel sales 
Volume   
Sales price per gallon 
Gross margin per gallon 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  
306,487     
296,551     
9,936     
103,591     
2.959     
0.096     

$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 

$ 

Total 
Consolidated 
and 
Combined 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
and 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2012  
$  1,862,867  
$  1,820,143  

$ 

$ 
$ 

42,724  
605,162  
3.078  
0.071  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  
$ 1,556,380  
$ 1,523,592  

$ 

$ 
$ 

32,788  
501,571  
3.103  
0.065  

$ 
Variance  
$ 29,939  
$ 28,179  

$  1,760  
  32,683  
$ (0.111) 
$ (0.001) 

% 
Variance  
1.6  
1.5  

4.1  
5.4  
(3.6) 
(1.2) 

The increase in gross margin was driven by an increase in volume of gallons distributed offset by a lower margin per gallon.  

The increase in aggregate revenues from fuel sales resulted from an increase of $100.6 million related to an increase in volume of 
gallons distributed offset by a decrease of $70.7 million related to lower selling prices per gallon. The increase in the volume of 
gallons distributed was principally related to our Express Lane acquisition, which accounted for 39.6 million gallons, the 
commencement of distributing motor fuels to the newly leased Getty sites, which accounted for 22.5 million gallons, 14.3 million 
gallons related to the Rogers and Rocky Top acquisitions, and 1.3 million gallons related to the Manchester acquisition. These 
increases were partially offset by decreases of 36.3 million gallons related to marketplace competition, 6.4 million gallons related to 
terminated dealer supply agreements and 2.4 million gallons associated with the temporary closure of sites.  

Rent Income  
Aggregate rent income for 2013, including rent income from related parties, was $41.6 million compared to $21.2 million for 2012, 
resulting in an increase of $20.4 million. This increase was a result of incremental rent income primarily attributable to the Express 
Lane and Dunmore acquisitions and 2013 acquisitions, resulting in a total increase of $13.3 million. Also contributing to the increase 
was incremental rent income of $3.1 million related to our lease sites with Getty. In addition, rent income for certain sites was 
recorded by an affiliate not included in the Predecessor Entity through October 30, 2012. These sites were contributed to the 
Partnership, resulting in an increase in rent income of $4.8 million. Offsetting these increases was a $2.5 million decrease related to 
sites not contributed by the Predecessor Entity. In addition, the termination of leases with LGO at the Commission Sites and other 
closed sites resulted in a writeoff of deferred rent income of $0.4 million.  

Other Revenues  
Other revenues increased $0.5 million to $1.7 million for 2013, compared with $1.2 million for 2012. The increase was primarily due 
to a $0.5 million increases in revenues from volume shortfalls under take-or-pay contracts with dealers and a $0.5 million increase in 
fees paid by dealers related to point-of-sale charges, partially offset by a $0.4 million decrease in fees paid by dealers to terminate 
their supply contracts.  

59 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Rent Expense  
Rent expense for 2013 was $15.5 million, an increase of $3.9 million, as compared to $11.6 million for 2012, with the increase 
primarily driven by an increased number of leasehold locations. Specifically, the Express Lane acquisition resulted in an increase of 
$2.7 million and the Getty leases resulted in an increase of $2.1 million. Offsetting these increases was a $1.0 million decrease related 
to sites not contributed by the Predecessor Entity. In addition, the sites terminated from the Getty lease resulted in a $0.2 million gain 
on settlement of the capital lease obligation, which was recorded as a credit to rent expense.  

Operating Expenses  
Operating expenses decreased $0.7 million to $4.6 million for 2013, compared with $5.3 million for 2012. The decrease was primarily 
due to the classification of the management fee charged by the Predecessor Entity to the Partnership. The Partnership classifies the 
management fee as a general and administrative expense whereas the Predecessor classified certain costs incorporated into the 
management fee within operating expenses. In addition, our new or renewed leases with LGO and lessee dealers have generally been 
structured as triple-net leases whereby LGO or the lessee dealer is responsible for real estate taxes, utilities, and certain other costs. 
Prior to the IPO, the Predecessor Entity had more sites for which it was responsible for real estate taxes, utilities, and certain other 
costs.  

Depreciation and Amortization  
Depreciation and amortization for 2013 was $21.0 million compared to $16.3 million for 2012. The increase of $4.7 million, or 28%, 
was principally due to sites acquired in the Dunmore, Express Lane, Rogers and Rocky Top acquisitions as well as the Getty lease 
transactions, which resulted in an increase of $8.6 million. Partially offsetting this increase was the impact of non-contributed sites, 
which resulted in a decrease in depreciation of $2.8 million. In addition, a $0.4 million impairment charge was recorded in 2013, as 
compared to $1.2 million of impairment charges in 2012. Also, there was a decrease in amortization of wholesale fuel supply contracts 
of $0.3 million due to the accelerated amortization for those intangible assets.  

Selling, General and Administrative Expenses  
Selling, general and administrative expenses for 2013 were $16.6 million compared with $19.5 million for 2012, a decrease of 
$2.9 million. The decrease was primarily attributable to $6.3 million of non-recurring expenses incurred in 2012 related to the IPO. As 
noted previously, the Partnership classifies the management fee as a general and administrative expense whereas the Predecessor 
classified certain costs incorporated into the management fee within operating expenses. In addition, there was an increase in public 
company expenses, primarily $3.1 million in equity-based incentive compensation, $0.3 million in transfer taxes associated with the 
contribution of certain sites to the Partnership at the time of the IPO, $0.4 million in director compensation and increased professional 
fees.  

Acquisition costs incurred during 2013 and 2012 were $1.2 million and $1.3 million, respectively, which are included in selling, 
general and administrative expenses.  

Gains on Sales of Assets, net  
Net gains on sales of assets that did not meet the criteria to be classified as discontinued operations for 2012 amounted to $3.6 million. 
Net gains on sales of assets for 2013 were not material.  

Other Income, net  
Other income, net, increased $0.7 million to $0.4 million for 2013, compared with $0.4 million of other expense, net, for 2012. This 
increase is primarily attributable to a $1.0 million charge associated with the 2012 cancellation of the mandatorily redeemable 
preferred equity.  

Interest Expense  
Interest expense, net, increased $0.9 million to $14.2 million for 2013, compared with $13.3 million for 2012. Additional borrowings 
resulted in an increase in interest of $2.2 million, partially offset by the redemption of the mandatorily redeemable preferred equity in 
October 2012, which resulted in a decrease in interest of $1.3 million.  

60 

 
 
  
Income Tax Benefit  
No provision for income taxes was recorded for the period January 1 through October 30, 2012 as the Predecessor Entity was not a 
taxable entity. However, our wholly owned, C-corporation subsidiary, LGWS, is a taxable entity. Accordingly, we have recorded a tax 
provision for LGWS for the period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012. LGP recorded a $0.3 million current tax 
provision. In addition, we recorded a $0.3 million deferred tax benefit with a full valuation allowance against the deferred tax asset.  

For 2013, we recorded a current tax provision of $1.2 million, a deferred tax benefit of $1.4 million, and a valuation allowance release 
of $1.5 million, resulting in a net income tax benefit of $1.7 million.  

During 2013, based on updates to the purchase price allocation for the 2012 and 2013 acquisitions and the assignment of property and 
equipment by the Partnership to LGWS, the Partnership recorded a net deferred tax liability of $7.8 million.  

At December 31, 2012, net deferred tax assets totaling $9.9 million were fully reserved against with a valuation allowance. Concurrent 
with the recognition of the $7.8 million net deferred tax liability noted above, and based on the expected reversal of the cumulative 
temporary differences and anticipated future earnings, the Partnership released $1.5 million of the valuation allowance in 2013.  

Liquidity and Capital Resources  
Liquidity  
Our principal liquidity requirements are to finance current operations, fund acquisitions from time-to-time, and to service our debt. We 
expect our ongoing sources of liquidity to include cash generated by our operations and borrowings under the Credit Facility and, if 
available to us on acceptable terms, issuances of equity and debt securities. We expect that these sources of funds will be adequate to 
provide for our short-term and long-term liquidity needs. Our ability to meet our debt service obligations and other capital 
requirements, including capital expenditures, as well as make acquisitions, will depend on our future operating performance which, in 
turn, will be subject to general economic, financial, business, competitive, legislative, regulatory and other conditions, many of which 
are beyond our control. As a normal part of our business, depending on market conditions, we will, from time-to-time, consider 
opportunities to repay, redeem, repurchase or refinance our indebtedness. Changes in our operating plans, lower than anticipated sales, 
increased expenses, acquisitions or other events may cause us to seek additional debt or equity financing in future periods.  

We intend to pay a minimum quarterly distribution of $0.4375 per unit, which equates to approximately $10.7 million per quarter, or 
$42.8 million per year, based on the current number of common units and subordinated units outstanding. We do not have a legal 
obligation to pay this distribution and our Credit Facility includes certain restrictions on our ability to make distributions.  

We believe that we will have sufficient cash flow from operations, borrowing capacity under the Credit Facility and the ability to issue 
additional common units and/or debt securities to meet our financial commitments, debt service obligations, contingencies and 
anticipated capital expenditures. However, we are subject to business and operational risks that could adversely affect our cash flow. 
A material decrease in our cash flows would likely produce an adverse effect on our borrowing capacity as well as our ability to issue 
additional common units and/or debt securities.  

61 

 
 
  
Comparison of Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

$ 

28,531  

$ 

(156,150) 

$ 

138,674  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

$ 

$ 

$ 

29,622  

(47,019) 

16,744  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

$ 

$ 

$ 

3,249  

(72,069) 

73,588  

Total 
Consolidated and 
Combined 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP and 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2012  

$ 

$ 

$ 

7,407  

(69,596) 

66,351  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

$ 

$ 

$ 

4,158  

2,473  

(7,237) 

Net cash provided by operating activities 
Net cash (used in) provided by investing 

activities 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing 

activities 

Net cash provided by operating activities includes balance sheet changes arising from wholesale motor fuel purchasing patterns, the 
timing of collections on our accounts receivable, the seasonality of our business, fluctuations in wholesale motor fuel prices, our 
working capital requirements and general market conditions.  

The decrease in net cash provided by operating activities from 2013 to 2014 resulted from a decrease in net income of $24.2 million, 
partially offset by an increase in net non-cash charges of $21.2 million.  

Net non-cash charges were higher in 2014 compared to 2013 as a result of higher depreciation and amortization, equity-based 
compensation expense and a lower deferred income tax benefit, partially offset by an increase in the gain on sales of assets.  

The increase in net cash used in investing activities from 2013 to 2014 was driven by the increase in cash paid for acquisitions, 
partially offset by the proceeds on the divestiture of the lubricants business. In addition, higher proceeds from sales of property and 
equipment and the sale of wholesale fuel supply contracts and assignment of leases to DMI and higher payments on notes receivable 
were partially offset by higher capital expenditures.  

The increase in net cash provided by financing activities from 2013 to 2014 resulted from the equity offering in 2014 that resulted in 
$43.7 million more in net proceeds compared to the equity offering in 2013, an increase in net borrowings under the Credit Facility of 
$91.5 million, a $4.7 million decrease in payments on lease financing obligations and the $3.5 million payment to LGO in 2013 for the 
commission sites, partially offset by a $15.5 million increase in total distributions paid and a $3.5 million increase in financing costs 
paid.  

Net cash provided by operating activities was $29.6 million for 2013, compared to $7.4 million for 2012, an increase of $22.2 million. 
The increase resulted from an increase in net income of $16.3 million and an increase in net non-cash charges of $9.3 million, partially 
offset by a decrease in the change in working capital and other assets and liabilities of $3.4 million.  

Net non-cash charges were higher in 2013 compared to 2012 as a result of higher depreciation and amortization, higher non-cash 
interest expense, higher equity-based compensation and lower gains on the sales of assets. Partially offsetting these increases was the 
net deferred tax benefit associated primarily with rent and property and equipment as well as the release of the valuation allowance 
discussed previously.  

Net cash used in investing activities was $47.0 million for 2013, compared to $69.6 million for 2012, a decrease of $22.6 million. The 
decrease resulted from a decrease in cash paid in connection with acquisitions, partially offset by an increase in purchases of property 
and equipment and a decrease in proceeds from sales of property and equipment.  

Net cash provided by financing activities was $16.7 million for 2013, compared to $66.4 million for 2012, a decrease of $49.7 million. 
The decrease resulted from net repayments of debt in 2013 totaling $37.4 million as compared to $16.3 million in 2012. Also, 
proceeds from the issuance of common units were $34.3 million lower in the supplemental offering in 2013 as compared to the IPO in 
2012.  

62 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
  
Capital Expenditures  
We make investments to expand, upgrade and enhance existing assets. We categorize our capital requirements as either maintenance 
capital expenditures or expansion capital expenditures. Maintenance capital expenditures are those capital expenditures required to 
maintain our long-term operating income or operating capacity. We anticipate maintenance capital expenditures will be funded 
primarily with cash generated by operations. We had approximately $3.1 million, $2.9 million and $2.0 million in maintenance capital 
expenditures for 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, which are included in purchases of property and equipment in our statements of 
cash flows.  

Expansion capital expenditures are those capital expenditures that we expect will increase our operating income or operating capacity 
over the long term. We have the ability to fund our expansion capital expenditures by additional borrowings under our credit facility 
or, if available to us on acceptable terms, issuing additional equity, debt securities or other options, such as the sale of assets. We 
cannot assure you that we can complete any offering of securities or other options on terms acceptable to us, if at all. We had 
approximately $174.4 million, $45.7 million and $76.0 million in expansion capital expenditures for 2014, 2013 and 2012, 
respectively.  

Non-GAAP Financial Measures  
We use the non-GAAP financial measures EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow in this Annual Report. EBITDA 
represents net income before deducting interest expense, income taxes and depreciation and amortization. Adjusted EBITDA 
represents EBITDA as further adjusted to exclude gains or losses on sales of assets, gains or losses on the extinguishment of debt, 
equity-based incentive compensation, equity-based director compensation and other items as deemed appropriate by management. 
Distributable Cash Flow represents Adjusted EBITDA less cash interest expense, maintenance capital expenditures net of any 
reimbursements and current income tax expense.  

EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow are used as supplemental financial measures by management and by 
external users of our financial statements, such as investors and lenders. EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA are used to assess our 
financial performance without regard to financing methods, capital structure or income taxes and our ability to incur and service debt 
and to fund capital expenditures. In addition, Adjusted EBITDA is used to assess the operating performance of our business on a 
consistent basis by excluding the impact of sales of our assets which do not result directly from our wholesale distribution of motor 
fuel and our leasing of real property. EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow are used to assess our ability to 
generate cash sufficient to make distributions to our unit-holders.  

We believe the presentation of EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow provides useful information to investors in 
assessing our financial condition and results of operations. EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow should not be 
considered alternatives to net income, net cash provided by operating activities or any other measure of financial performance or 
liquidity presented in accordance with GAAP. EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow have important limitations 
as analytical tools because they exclude some but not all items that affect net income and net cash provided by operating activities. 
Additionally, because EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Distributable Cash Flow may be defined differently by other companies in our 
industry, our definitions may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing their utility.  

63 

 
 
  
The following tables present reconciliations of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to net income and EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to 
net cash provided by operating activities, the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures, on a historical basis, for each of the 
periods indicated (in thousands), as well as a reconciliation of Distributable Cash Flow to Adjusted EBITDA.  
Reconciliation of EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

Total 
Consolidated 
and 
Combined 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
and Lehigh 
Gas Entities 
(Predecessor) 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2012  

$ 

$ 

(6,171) 
—    
(6,171) 

32,981  
(1,354) 
16,631  
42,087  
11,400  
558  
(1,653) 
—    
52,392  

$ 

$ 

18,070  
—    
18,070  

20,963  
(1,716) 
14,192  
51,509  
3,141  
301  
(47) 
—    
54,904  

$ 

(1,356)     $ 

—    
(1,356)    

$ 

2,805  
309  
3,114  

2,551  
342  
1,926  
3,463  
—    
—    
(471)    
—    
2,992  

   $ 

13,823  
—    
11,415  
28,352  
—    
—    
(3,119) 
571  
25,804  

$ 

$ 

1,449  
309  
1,758  

16,374  
342  
13,341  
31,815  
—    
—    
(3,590) 
571  
28,796  

$ 

28,531  

$ 

29,622  

$ 

3,249  

   $ 

4,158  

$ 

7,407  

10,198  
16,631  
(13,273) 
42,087  
11,400  
558  
(1,653) 
—    
52,392  

$ 

11,840  
14,192  
(4,145) 
51,509  
3,141  
301  
(47) 
—    
54,904  

$ 

(1,799)    
1,926  
87  
3,463  
—    
—    
(471)    
—    
2,992  

   $ 

10,956  
11,415  
1,823  
28,352  
—    
—    
(3,119) 
571  
25,804  

$ 

9,157  
13,341  
1,910  
31,815  
—    
—    
(3,590) 
571  
28,796  

52,392  

54,904  

2,992  

(13,851) 
(3,104) 
(406) 
35,031  

$ 

(11,526) 
(2,850) 
(1,232) 
39,296  

$ 

(1,391)       
(260)       
(342)       
999  

Reconciliation of EBITDA and Adjusted 

EBITDA to net income (loss): 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations 

after income taxes 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations   
Net income (loss)  
Plus: 

Depreciation and amortization 
Income tax expense (benefit)   
Interest expense 

EBITDA 
Equity-based incentive compensation expense 
Equity-based director compensation expense  
Gains on sales of assets, net 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
Adjusted EBITDA 
Reconciliation of EBITDA and Adjusted 
EBITDA to net cash provided by 
operating activities: 

Net cash provided by operating activities 

Changes in certain operating assets and 

liabilities 
Interest expense 
Others items, net 

EBITDA 
Equity-based incentive compensation expense 
Equity-based director compensation expense  
Gains on sales of assets, net 
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
Adjusted EBITDA 
Reconciliation of Distributable Cash Flow 
Adjusted EBITDA 
Less: 

Cash interest expense 
Maintenance capital expenditures (a) 
Current income tax (expense) benefit   

Distributable Cash Flow 

$ 

$ 

(a)  Under our partnership agreement, maintenance capital expenditures are capital expenditures made to maintain our long-term 

operating income or operating capacity. Examples of maintenance capital expenditures are those made to maintain existing 
contract volumes, including payments to renew existing distribution contracts, or to maintain our sites in leasable condition, 
such as parking lot or roof replacement/renovation, or to replace equipment required to operate our existing business.  

64 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
     
  
 
 
 
 
     
  
  
  
  
     
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
     
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Contractual Obligations  
The following table sets forth our contractual obligations that are required to be settled in cash as of December 31, 2014 (in 
thousands):  

Long-term debt (a) 
Financing obligations (b)   
Operating lease obligations (c) 
Management Fees (d) 
Other long-term liabilities (e) 

Total 

Payments due by period  

Total  
$263,505  
  94,983  
  116,208  
  38,190  
  —    

Less Than 1 Year  
9,128  
$ 
6,112  
16,417  
8,040  
—    

1 - 3 Years  
$  27,743  
  12,167  
  27,126  
  16,080  
—    

4 - 5 Years  
$ 221,283  
  12,365  
  21,136  
  14,070  
—    

More Than 
5 Years  

$ 

5,351  
64,339  
51,529  
—    
—    

$512,886  

$ 

39,697  

$  83,116  

$ 268,854  

$ 121,219  

(a) 

(b) 

(c) 
(d) 

(e) 

The Partnership’s credit facility expires March 4, 2019 and thus the principal balance outstanding at December 31, 2014 is 
included in the 4-5 year period. Interest, which is based on variable rates, was assumed to remain constant at a weighted-
average rate of 3.5%. Also, as a result of the sellers not exercising a put option that would have required us to purchase certain 
leased sites acquired in the Rocky Top acquisition, we have reflected the payoff of the $26.2 million financing in accordance 
with the purchase schedule prescribed in the applicable contracts. Note that this debt was classified as current in the 
December 31, 2014 balance sheet.  
The lease financing obligations consist of principal and interest payments due on sale-leaseback transactions for which the sale 
was not recognized because our predecessor retained continuing involvement in the underlying sites. Also included are 
principal and interest payments due on capital lease obligations, including the portions of the Getty lease agreements being 
accounted for as capital lease obligations.  
These operating leases expire through December 2028.  
Pursuant to the Amended Omnibus Agreement, the Partnership pays CST a management fee, which was initially $670,000 per 
month and a variable fee of between zero and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for retail 
fuel distribution at sites operated by the Partnership. The amounts above include only the fixed portion of the management fee. 
The initial term of the agreement is five years and automatically renews for additional one-year terms unless either party 
provides notice as stipulated in the agreement.  
Under the terms of various supply agreements, the Partnership is obligated to minimum volume purchases measured in gallons 
of motor fuel. Future minimum volume purchase requirements are 414 million gallons in 2015, reducing to 233 million gallons 
in 2019. Future minimum volume purchase requirements from 2020 through 2030 total 2.3 billion gallons. The aggregate 
dollar amount of the future minimum volume purchase requirements is dependent on the future weighted average wholesale 
cost per gallon charged under the applicable supply agreements. The amounts and timing of the related payment obligations 
cannot reasonably be estimated reliably. As a result, payment of these amounts has been excluded from the table above.  

Long-term Debt  
Debt outstanding at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 was as follows:  

Revolving credit facility 
Financing associated with Rocky Top acquisition 
Note payable 

Total 

December 31, 
2014  
$  200,400  
26,250  
929  

$  227,579  

December 31, 
2013  
$  146,330  
26,250  
980  

$  173,560  

65 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
Credit Facility  
In March 2014, we entered into an amended and restated credit agreement, and such agreement was further amended and restated on 
September 30, 2014 (the “Credit Facility”). The Credit Facility is a senior secured revolving credit facility maturing on March 4, 2019, 
with a total borrowing capacity of $550.0 million, under which swing-line loans may be drawn up to $10.0 million and standby letters 
of credit may be issued up to an aggregate of $45.0 million. The Credit Facility may be increased, from time to time, upon the 
Partnership’s written request, subject to certain conditions, up to an additional $100.0 million. All obligations under the Credit Facility 
are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Partnership and its subsidiaries. The notional amount of availability at 
December 31, 2014, was $333.2 million.  

Borrowings under the Credit Facility bear interest, at the Partnership’s option, at (1) a rate equal to the London Interbank Offering 
Rate (“LIBOR”), for interest periods of one week or one, two, three or six months, plus a margin of 2.00% to 3.25% per annum, 
depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio (as defined) or (2) (a) a base rate equal to the greatest of: (i) the federal funds rate, 
plus 0.5%, (ii) LIBOR for one month interest periods, plus 1.00% per annum or (iii) the rate of interest established by the agent, from 
time to time, as its prime rate, plus (b) a margin of 1.00% to 2.25% per annum depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio. In 
addition, we incur a commitment fee based on the unused portion of the revolving credit facility at a rate of 0.35% to 0.50% per 
annum depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio. The weighted-average interest rate on outstanding borrowings at 
December 31, 2014, was 2.7%. Letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2014 and 2013, totaled $16.4 million and $12.3 million, 
respectively.  

We are required to comply with certain financial covenants under the Credit Facility. Effective July 2, 2014, the Partnership is 
required to maintain a total leverage ratio (as defined) for the most recently completed four fiscal quarters of less than or equal to 
4.50:1.00 for periods after December 31, 2014, except for periods following a material acquisition. However, if an offering of Equity 
Interests (as defined) in the Partnership occurs after July 2, 2014, but prior to December 31, 2014, the total leverage ratio shall not 
exceed 4.50:1.00 for the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2014; and the total leverage ratio shall not exceed 5.00:1.00 for the first 
two full fiscal quarters following the closing of a material acquisition or 5.50 : 1:00 upon the issuance of Qualified Senior Notes (as 
defined) in the aggregate principal amount of $175.0 million or greater. We are also required to maintain a senior leverage ratio (as 
defined) after the issuance of Qualified Senior Notes of $175.0 million or greater of less than or equal to 3.00:1.00 and a consolidated 
interest coverage ratio (as defined) of at least 2.75 to 1.00.  

The Credit Facility prohibits us from making distributions to unitholders if any potential default or event of default occurs or would 
result from the distribution, or we are not in compliance with our financial covenants. In addition, the Credit Facility contains various 
covenants which may limit, among other things, our ability to grant liens; create, incur, assume, or suffer to exist other indebtedness; 
or make any material change to the nature of our business, including mergers, liquidations, and dissolutions; and make certain 
investments, acquisitions or dispositions.  

If an event of default exists under the Credit Facility, the lenders will be able to accelerate the maturity of the Credit Facility and 
exercise other rights and remedies. Events of default include, among others, the following:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

failure to pay any principal when due or any interest, fees or other amounts when due;  
failure of any representation or warranty to be true and correct in any material respect;  
failure to perform or otherwise comply with the covenants in the Credit Facility or in other loan documents without a 
waiver or amendment;  
any default in the performance of any obligation or condition beyond the applicable grace period relating to any other 
indebtedness of more than $7.5 million;  
a judgment default for monetary judgments not covered by insurance exceeding $20.0 million;  
bankruptcy or insolvency event involving the Partnership or any of its subsidiaries;  
an Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA) violation;  
a change of control without a waiver or amendment; and  
failure of the lenders for any reason to have a perfected first priority security interest in the security pledged by us or 
any of our subsidiaries or any of the security becomes unenforceable or invalid.  

66 

 
 
  
Financing of Rocky Top Acquisition  
In connection with the Rocky Top acquisition as described in Note 4, we entered into a lease for certain sites for which the Partnership 
is obligated to purchase these sites, at the election of the seller, either (a) in whole on or about August 1, 2015, or (b) in approximately 
equal parts over a 5 year period for an average of $5.3 million per year beginning in 2016. Interest accrues at an annual rate of 7.7% 
with monthly payments due until the balance is paid. The seller gave notice in 2015 that the put option will not be exercised, and as a 
result, the Partnership will purchase these sites beginning in 2016.  

Note Payable  
In connection with the June 2013 acquisition of certain sites in Florida noted previously, we issued a $1.0 million note payable with 
interest at 4.0%. The note matures July 1, 2018, at which time a balloon payment for all outstanding principal and any unpaid interest 
is due. The loan is secured by all the real and personal property at these sites.  

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements  
The Amended Omnibus Agreement contingently requires us to perform environmental remediation work as further discussed in Note 
13 to the financial statements. We also have operating leases and fuel purchase commitments as previously discussed in “Contractual 
Obligations.”  

Impact of Inflation  
Inflation in the United States has been relatively low in recent years and did not have a material impact on our results of operations for 
2014, 2013 and 2012.  

Critical Accounting Policies  
We prepare our financial statements in conformity with GAAP. The preparation of the financial statements requires us to make 
estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities as 
of the date of the financial statements, and the reported amount of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results 
could differ from those estimates.  

Critical accounting policies are those we believe are both most important to the portrayal of our financial condition and results, and 
require our most difficult, subjective or complex judgments, often as a result of the need to make estimates about the effect of matters 
that are inherently uncertain. Judgments and uncertainties affecting the application of those policies may result in materially different 
amounts being reported under different conditions or using different assumptions. We believe the following policies to be the most 
critical in understanding the judgments that are involved in preparing our financial statements.  

Revenue Recognition  
We recognize revenues from wholesale fuel sales when fuel is delivered to the customer. The purchase and delivery of motor fuels 
generally occurs on the same day. We recognize revenues from retail fuel sales when fuel is sold to the customer. We record inventory 
from the time of the purchase of motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to the end customer.  

We recognize revenue from leasing arrangements ratably over the term of the underlying lease. Renewals are not assumed unless 
reasonably assured.  

Revenues from retail food and merchandise sales are recognized net of applicable provisions for discounts and allowances upon 
delivery, generally at the point of sale.  

Accounts receivable primarily result from the sale of motor fuels and rental fees for sites to customers. The majority of our accounts 
receivable relate to motor fuel sales that can generally be described as high volume and low margin activities. Credit is extended to a 
customer based on an evaluation of the customer’s financial condition. In certain circumstances collateral may be required from the 
customer. Receivables are recorded at face value, without interest or discount.  

67 

 
 
  
The provision for bad debts is generally based upon a specific analysis of aged accounts while also factoring in any new business 
conditions that might impact the historical analysis, such as market conditions and bankruptcies of particular customers. Bad debt 
provisions are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

We review all accounts receivable balances on at least a quarterly basis and provide an allowance for doubtful accounts based on 
historical experience and on a specific identification basis.  

LGW collects motor fuel taxes, which consist of various pass through taxes collected from customers on behalf of taxing authorities, 
and remits such taxes directly to those taxing authorities. LGW’s accounting policy is to exclude the tax collected and remitted from 
wholesale revenues and cost of sales and account for them as liabilities. LGWS’s retail sales and cost of sales include motor fuel taxes 
as the taxes are included in the cost paid for motor fuel and LGWS has no direct responsibility to collect or remit such taxes to the 
taxing authorities.  

Business Combinations  
We account for acquisitions using the purchase method of accounting. Accordingly, assets acquired and liabilities assumed are 
recorded at their estimated fair values at the acquisition date. The excess of purchase price over fair value of net assets acquired, 
including the amount assigned to identifiable intangible assets, is recorded as goodwill. Given the time it takes to obtain pertinent 
information to finalize the acquired company’s balance sheet, it may be several quarters before we are able to finalize those initial fair 
value estimates. Accordingly, it is not uncommon for the initial estimates to be subsequently revised. The results of operations of 
acquired businesses are included in the consolidated financial statements from the acquisition date.  

Our recorded identifiable intangible assets primarily include the estimated value assigned to certain customer related and contract-
based assets. Identifiable intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over their estimated useful lives, which is the period over 
which the asset is expected to contribute directly or indirectly to our future cash flows. Wholesale fuel supply contracts are amortized 
on a straight-line or accelerated basis over the period the contracts are expected to contribute directly or indirectly to our future cash 
flows, which we approximate as being 10 years. Wholesale fuel distribution rights are amortized on a straight-line basis over an 
estimated useful life of 10 years. Trademarks are amortized on a straight-line basis over five years. Covenants not to compete are 
amortized on a straight-line basis over the shorter of the contract term or five years. Favorable/unfavorable lease arrangements are 
amortized on a straight-line basis over the remaining lease terms, which we approximate as being five years.  

The determination of the fair market value of the intangible asset and the estimated useful life are based on an analysis of all pertinent 
factors including (1) the use of widely-accepted valuation approaches, the income approach or the cost approach, (2) the expected use 
of the asset by us, (3) the expected useful life of related assets, (4) any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions, including renewal or 
extension periods that would cause substantial costs or modifications to existing agreements, and (5) the effects of obsolescence, 
demand, competition, and other economic factors. Should any of the underlying assumptions indicate that the value of the intangible 
assets might be impaired, we may be required to reduce the carrying value and subsequent useful life of the asset. If the underlying 
assumptions governing the amortization of an intangible asset were later determined to have significantly changed, we may be 
required to adjust the amortization period of such asset to reflect any new estimate of its useful life. Any write-down of the value or 
unfavorable change in the useful life of an intangible asset would increase expense at that time.  

The Partnership accounts for purchased goodwill in accordance with ASC 350, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets.” Goodwill 
represents the excess of cost over fair value of net assets of businesses acquired. Goodwill acquired in a business combination is 
recorded at fair value as of the date acquired. Goodwill is not amortized, but is instead tested for impairment at least annually and 
more frequently if events and circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired.  

Property and Equipment  
We record property and equipment at cost. We record property and equipment acquired through a business combination at fair value. 
We recognize depreciation using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets, including: 10 to 20 years 
for buildings and improvements and 5 to 15 years for equipment. The amortization of leasehold improvements is based upon the 
shorter of the remaining terms of the leases including renewal periods that are reasonably assured, or the estimated useful lives, which 
generally range from 7 to 10 years.  

68 

 
 
  
We capitalize expenditures for major renewals and betterments that extend the useful lives of property and equipment. We charge 
maintenance and repairs to operations as incurred. Gains or losses on the disposition of property and equipment are recorded in the 
period the sale meets the criteria for recognition.  

Asset Impairment  
We review long-lived assets, including property and equipment and intangible assets other than goodwill, for impairment when events 
or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the long-lived asset (group) might not be recoverable in accordance with 
ASC 360, “Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets.” Such events and circumstances include, among other factors: operating 
losses; market value declines; changes in the expected physical life of an asset; changes in our business plans or those of our major 
customers, suppliers or other business partners; changes in competition and competitive practices; uncertainties associated with the 
U.S. and world economies; changes in the expected level of capital, operating or environmental remediation expenditures; and 
changes in governmental regulations or actions. Our impairment evaluation is initially based on the projected undiscounted cash flows 
of the asset (group), including residual value upon eventual disposition. If the projected undiscounted cash flows of the asset (group) 
are less than its carrying value, the impairment loss is measured by comparing the present value of the future cash flows associated 
with the asset (group) to its carrying value and is recorded at that time. We recorded insignificant impairments in 2014 and 2013 and 
no impairments during 2012.  

Goodwill is not amortized, but is instead tested for impairment at least annually and more frequently if events and circumstances 
indicate that the asset might be impaired. A qualitative assessment is permitted, whereby companies may assess all relevant events and 
circumstances to determine if it is “more likely than not” (meaning a likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of the reporting 
unit goodwill is less than the carrying amount. If there is a more likely than not assessment, companies would need to perform the 
two-step process described below.  
• 

The fair value of the reporting unit is compared with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value 
of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered impaired. If 
the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, then companies must perform the second step of 
the goodwill impairment test to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any.  
The implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill is compared with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If 
the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an 
impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.  

• 

Companies are required to perform Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test if the carrying value of the reporting unit is zero or negative 
or adverse qualitative factors indicate that it is more likely than not that a goodwill impairment exists. Goodwill of a reporting unit is 
tested for impairment between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair 
value of the reporting unit below its carrying amount.  

The Partnership has defined its reporting units as its reportable segments. The Partnership performed its annual impairment test of 
goodwill at December 31. The Partnership utilized qualitative factors, such as macroeconomic factors, industry and market 
considerations, cost factors, overall financial performance and other relevant entity specific events, in their qualitative assessment of 
the goodwill for their reporting units. Based on that analysis, the Partnership concluded that it was more likely than not that the fair 
value of each of its reporting units exceeds its carrying value.  

Estimates and assumptions used to perform the impairment testing are inherently uncertain and can significantly affect the outcome of 
the impairment test. Changes in operating results and other assumptions could materially affect these estimates.  

69 

 
 
  
Assets Held for Sale  
The determination to classify a site as held for sale requires significant estimates by us about the asset and the expected market for the 
site, which are based on factors including recent sales of comparable sites, recent expressions of interest in the sites and the condition 
of the site. We must also determine if it will be possible under those market conditions to sell the site for an acceptable price within 
one year. When assets are identified by management as held for sale, we discontinue depreciating the assets and estimate the sales 
price, net of selling costs, of such assets. We generally consider sites to be held for sale when they meet criteria such as whether the 
appropriate level of management has approved the sale transaction and there are no known material contingencies relating to the sale 
such that the sale is probable and is expected to be completed within one year. If, in management’s opinion, the expected net sales 
price of the asset that has been identified as held for sale is less than the net book value of the asset, the asset is written down to fair 
value less the cost to sell. We present assets classified as held for sale separately in the balance sheet. We recorded $0.3 million, 
insignificant impairments and $0.4 million of impairments related to assets held in 2014, 2013 and for the period October 31, 2012 
through December 31, 2012, respectively. The Predecessor Entity recorded $0.8 million of impairments related to assets held for sale 
for the period January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012.  

Environmental and Other Liabilities  
We record a liability for all direct costs associated with the estimated resolution of contingencies at the earliest date at which it is 
deemed probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of such liability can be reasonably estimated. We estimate costs 
accrued based upon an analysis of potential results, assuming a combination of litigation and settlement strategies and outcomes. We 
generally recognize estimated losses from environmental remediation obligations no later than the completion of the remedial 
feasibility study. We adjust loss accruals as further information becomes available or circumstances change. We do not discount costs 
of future expenditures for environmental remediation obligations to their present value. We recognize recoveries of environmental 
remediation costs from other parties as assets when their receipt is deemed probable.  
We are subject to other contingencies, including legal proceedings and claims arising out of our businesses that cover a wide range of 
matters, including, among others, environmental matters and contract claims. Environmental and other legal proceedings may also 
include matters with respect to businesses previously owned. Further, due to the lack of adequate information and the potential impact 
of present regulations and any future regulations, there are certain circumstances in which no range of potential exposure may be 
reasonably estimated.  

Asset Retirement Obligations  
Prior to the GP Purchase, we recorded asset retirement obligations related to the removal of underground storage tanks when 1) the site was 
being sold and removing the tank was a condition of the sale; or 2) the lessor could require us to remove the tanks at the end of the lease.  
On October 1, 2014, concurrent with the GP Purchase and in an effort to conform operating and accounting policies, we recognized an 
asset retirement obligation at fee sites in addition to lease sites. Our accounting policy is to recognize the estimated future cost to 
remove our USTs over their estimated useful lives. We record a discounted liability for the fair value of an asset retirement obligation 
with a corresponding increase to the carrying value of the related long-lived asset at the time a UST is installed. We depreciate the 
amount added to property and equipment and recognize accretion expense in connection with the discounted liability over the 
remaining life of the UST.  
We base our estimates of such future costs on CST’s prior experience with removal and include normal and customary costs we 
expect to incur associated with UST removal. We compare our cost estimates with our actual removal cost experience on an annual 
basis, and when the actual costs we experience exceed our original estimates, we will recognize an additional liability for estimated 
future costs to remove the USTs. Because these estimates are subjective and are currently based on historical costs with adjustments 
for estimated future changes in the associated costs, the dollar amount of these obligations could change as more information is 
obtained.  
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013 our liabilities related to the removal of USTs recorded in the consolidated financial statements 
were $19.1 million and $2.2 million, respectively. A 10% change in our estimate of anticipated future costs for removal of USTs as of 
December 31, 2014 would change our asset retirement obligation by approximately $1.9 million. See also Note 12 under the caption 
“Asset Retirement Obligations” of the notes to the consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this annual report.  

Equity Incentive Compensation  
In connection with the IPO, we adopted the Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan under which various types of awards 
may be granted to employees, consultants and directors of the General Partner or its affiliates who provide services to us. Since we grant 
phantom units and profits interests to employees of DMI, the grants are measured at fair value at each balance sheet reporting date based 
on the fair market value of the Partnership’s common units, and the cumulative compensation cost related to that portion of the awards 
that have vested is recognized ratably over the vesting term and classified within selling, general and administrative expenses. The 
liability for the future grant of common units is included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities on the balance sheet.  

70 

 
 
  
If there are any modifications of the equity incentive compensation award after the date of grant, regardless of whether the vesting 
settlement is in common units or cash, we may be required to accelerate any remaining unearned equity incentive compensation 
expense or record additional equity incentive compensation expense.  

Income Taxes  
Income taxes attributable to our earnings and losses, excluding the earnings and losses of our wholly owned taxable subsidiary, are 
assessed at the individual level of the unitholder. Accordingly, we do not record a provision for income taxes other than for those 
earnings and losses generated or incurred by its wholly owned taxable subsidiary.  

Our wholly owned taxable subsidiary recognizes deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future income tax 
consequences of temporary differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the related income tax basis.  

We performed an evaluation of all material tax positions, if any, for the tax years subject to examination by major tax jurisdictions as 
of December 31, 2014 and 2013. Tax positions not meeting the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold at the financial statement 
date may not be recognized or continue to be recognized under the accounting guidance for income taxes. Based on such evaluation, 
we concluded there were no uncertain tax positions requiring adjustment in our financial statements as of December 31, 2014 and 
2013. Where required, we recognize interest and penalties for uncertain tax positions in income taxes.  

Valuation allowances are initially recorded and reevaluated each reporting period by assessing the likelihood of the ultimate 
realization of a deferred tax asset. We consider a number of factors in assessing the realization of a deferred tax asset, including the 
reversal of temporary differences, future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. The amount of 
deferred tax assets ultimately realized may differ materially from the estimates utilized in the computation of valuation allowances and 
may materially impact the financial statements in the future.  

ITEM 7A. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURE ABOUT MARKET RISK  
Market Risk  
We purchase gasoline and diesel fuel from several suppliers at costs that are subject to market volatility. These purchases are generally 
purchased pursuant to contracts or at market prices established with the supplier. In general, we do not engage in hedging activities for 
these purchases due to our pricing structure which allows us to generally pass on price changes to our customers and related parties.  

Commodity Price Risk  
Effective September 1, 2013, we assumed the lessor position for commission sites previously operated by LGO. Since then, we record 
retail sales of motor fuels to the end customer. Further, with the PMI acquisition, we have significantly more retail sales of motor 
fuels. We carry inventory on our balance sheet for the period from the purchase of the motor fuels from the third party suppliers to the 
retail sale to the end customer. During this period we are exposed to commodity price risk as it relates to motor fuel price fluctuations. 
During periods of market volatility, the retail segment margins could be significantly impacted. We currently do not hedge against this 
commodity price risk but may in the future. As of December 31, 2014, we had $5.2 million of motor fuel inventory. A $0.01 change in 
motor fuel pricing would not have had a significant on earnings and cash flow.  

Interest Rate Risk  
Market risk is the potential loss arising from adverse changes in the financial markets, including interest rates. Our exposure to interest 
rate risk relates primarily to our existing revolving credit facility.  

To manage interest rate risk and limit overall interest cost we may, from time-to-time, employ interest rate swaps to convert a portion 
of the floating-rate debt under our existing credit facility asset to a fixed-rate liability. Counterparties to these contracts are major 
financial institutions. These instruments are not used for trading or speculative purposes. The extent to which we use such instruments 
is dependent upon our access to them in the financial markets. Our objective in managing our exposure to market risk is to limit the 
impact on earnings and cash flow.  

71 

 
 
  
Interest rate differentials that arise under swap contracts are recognized in interest expense over the life of the contracts. If interest 
rates rise, the resulting cost of funds is expected to be lower than that which would have been available if debt with matching 
characteristics was issued directly. Conversely, if interest rates fall, the resulting costs would be expected to be higher. Gains and 
losses are recognized in net income.  

As of December 31, 2014, we had $200.4 million outstanding on our revolving credit facility at an average interest rate of 2.7%. A 
one percentage point change in our average rate would impact annual interest expense by an aggregate of approximately $2.0 million.  

See “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital 
Resources” for further discussion of our debt commitments.  

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA  
The financial statements and schedules referred to in the index contained on page F-1 of this report are incorporated herein by 
reference.  

ITEM 9. CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL 
DISCLOSURE  
None.  

ITEM 9A. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES  
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures  
As of December 31, 2014, management, with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, performed 
an evaluation of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) 
and 15d-15(e) of the Exchange Act. Our disclosure controls and procedures are designed to ensure that information required to be 
disclosed in the reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time 
periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and 
communicated to our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer, to allow timely decisions 
regarding required disclosures. Any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable 
assurance of achieving the desired control objective.  

We acquired PMI on April 30, 2014. PMI accounted for approximately 23% of consolidated total revenues for 2014 and 
approximately 11% of consolidated total assets as of December 31, 2014. The internal control over financial reporting of PMI was 
excluded from a formal evaluation of effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures. This decision was based upon the 
significance of PMI, and the timing of integration efforts underway to transition PMI’s processes, information technology systems and 
other components of internal control over financial reporting to our internal control structure. We have expanded our consolidation 
and disclosure controls and procedures to include PMI, and we continue to assess the current internal control over financial reporting 
at PMI. Risks related to the increased account balances were partially mitigated by our expanded controls.  

Based on this evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that, as of December 31, 2014, the design 
and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures were effective.  

Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting  
Aside from the change in internal control over financial reporting related to PMI noted previously, there were no other changes in our 
internal control over financial reporting (as that term is defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) that 
occurred during the quarter ended December 31, 2014, that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our 
internal control over financial reporting.  

72 

 
 
  
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting  
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in 
Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide 
reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements in accordance with 
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Internal control over financial reporting includes those 
policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the 
transactions and dispositions of our assets; provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit 
preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and 
that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of our management and directors; and provide 
reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of our assets that could 
have a material effect on our financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not 
prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projection of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods is subject to the risk that controls 
may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may 
deteriorate.  

In accordance with SEC rules, management excluded PMI from its evaluation of internal control over financial reporting due to the 
significance of PMI to our financial results and the migration of PMI’s legacy information technology systems, processes and controls 
to those of the Partnership. Total revenues for PMI accounted for 23% of consolidated total revenues for the year ended December 31, 
2014. As discussed above, we are continuing to enhance and evaluate processes, information technology systems and other 
components of internal control over financial reporting as part of our ongoing integration activities.  

Management has conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 
2014. In making this assessment, management used the criteria in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee 
of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 framework) (“COSO”).  

In connection with management’s assessment of our internal control over financial reporting, management has concluded that our 
internal control over financial reporting was effective at December 31, 2014.  

Attestation Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm  
Grant Thornton LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, has audited our internal control over financial reporting as of 
December 31, 2014. Their report dated February 27, 2015, expressed an unqualified opinion on our internal control over financial 
reporting, which is included in Item 15 of Part IV of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  

ITEM 9B. OTHER INFORMATION  
None.  

Part III  

DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE  

ITEM  10. 
Management  
Our General Partner manages our operations and activities on our behalf. Our General Partner is owned and controlled by CST 
effective October 1, 2014. All of our executive management personnel were employees of DMI through September 30, 2014. On 
October 1, 2014, certain of our executive management personnel were employed by an affiliate of CST and on January 1, 2015, all our 
executive management personnel were employed by an affiliate of CST.  

Our General Partner has a Board of Directors that oversees its management, operations and activities. The Board of Directors has 
seven members, three of whom, Gene Edwards, Justin A. Gannon and John B. Reilly, III, the Board of Directors has determined are 
independent as defined under the independence standards established by the NYSE and the Securities Exchange Act. These directors, 
whom we refer to as independent directors, are not officers or employees of our General Partner or its affiliates, and have been 
determined by the Board of Directors to be otherwise independent of CST and its affiliates.  

73 

 
 
  
Our General Partner is not elected by our unitholders and is not subject to re-election on a regular basis. Unitholders are not entitled to 
elect the directors of our General Partner or directly or indirectly participate in our management or operation. CST appoints all 
members to the Board of Directors of our General Partner.  

Our General Partner owes a fiduciary duty to our unitholders. However, our partnership agreement contains provisions that limit the 
fiduciary duties that our General Partner owes to our unitholders. Our General Partner is liable, as General Partner, for all of our debts 
(to the extent not paid from our assets), except for indebtedness or other obligations that are made specifically nonrecourse to it. 
Whenever possible, our General Partner intends to incur indebtedness or other obligations that are nonrecourse. Except as described in 
our partnership agreement and subject to its fiduciary duty to act in good faith, our General Partner has exclusive management power 
over our business and affairs.  

Directors and Executive Officers  
As it is commonly the case with publicly traded limited partnerships, the General Partner does not directly employ any of the persons 
responsible for managing or operating the Partnership. We are managed and operated by the Board of Directors and the executive 
officers of our General Partner. The following table shows information for the directors and executive officers of our General Partner.  

Directors and Executive Officers of the General Partner  

Name 
Current Directors and Executive Officers 

Kimberly S. Lubel 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
Gene Edwards 
Justin A. Gannon  
John B. Reilly, III 
Clayton E. Killinger 
Stephan F. Motz   
David F. Hrinak   
Mark L. Miller 
David A. Sheaffer 
Stéphane Trudel   
Gérard J. Sonnier  

Age 

Position with our General Partner 

50  Chairman of the Board of Directors 
59  Director, President and Chief Executive Officer 
58  Director 
65  Director 
53  Director 
54  Director 
56  Director 
59  Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer 
54  Chief Financial Officer & Treasurer 
53  Chief Accounting Officer 
46  Senior Vice President Mergers and Acquisitions 
56  Corporate Secretary 

Our General Partner’s directors hold office until the earlier of their death, resignation, removal or disqualification or until their 
successors have been elected and qualified. Executive officers of our General Partner serve at the discretion of the Board of Directors. 
In selecting and appointing directors to the Board of Directors, the owners of our General Partner do not intend to apply a formal 
diversity policy or set of guidelines. However, when appointing new directors, the owners of our General Partner will consider each 
individual director’s qualifications, skills, business experience and capacity to serve as a director, as described below for each director, 
and the diversity of these attributes for the Board of Directors as a whole.  

Kimberly S. Lubel was appointed Chairman of the Board of Directors of our General Partner in October 2014. Mrs. Lubel has been 
the Chairman and a member of the board of directors of CST Brands since November 2012 and has served as its Chief Executive 
Officer and President since January 1, 2013. Mrs. Lubel previously served as Executive Vice President and General Counsel of Valero 
Energy Corporation, a position she held from October 2008 until her election to her position with CST Brands. She also serves as a 
Director of WPX Energy, Inc. since December 31, 2011. Ms. Lubel holds a Bachelor of Arts degree in Spanish and International 
Studies from Miami University (Ohio), Master of Arts degree in International Relations from Baylor University, and her Juris 
Doctorate from the University Of Texas School Of Law. Mrs. Lubel is a 2009 graduate of the Stanford Executive Program.  

74 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. was appointed Chief Executive Officer of our General Partner in December 2011. Mr. Topper also served as 
chairman of the Board of Directors of our General Partner from January 1, 2014 through September 30, 2014. Mr. Topper has 26 years 
of management experience in the wholesale and retail fuel distribution business. In 1987, Mr. Topper purchased his family’s retail fuel 
business and five years later founded our predecessor, where he has been the Chief Executive Officer since 1992. Mr. Topper 
currently serves on the Board of Trustees for Villanova University and the board of directors for Lehigh Valley PBS. He is the past 
President of the Board for Lehigh Valley PBS and the Lehigh Valley PBS Foundation. He also served as a board member for the Good 
Shepherd Rehabilitation Hospital in Allentown. Mr. Topper holds a master of Business Administration degree from Lehigh University 
and a Bachelor of Science degree in Accounting from Villanova University. Mr. Topper is also a Certified Public Accountant.  

Gene Edwards was appointed as a director of our General Partner in October 2014. Mr. Edwards served as Executive Vice President 
and Chief Development Officer of Valero Energy Corporation until his retirement in April 2014. Mr. Edwards began his 32-year 
career with Valero as an Analyst in Planning & Economics and spent his tenure with Valero in various managerial positions Planning 
and Economics, Refinery Operations, Business Development, and Marketing. He was a director of the board of directors of CST 
Brands from May 2013 until December 2013. Mr. Edwards has served as a director of Green Plains Inc. since June 2014 where he 
serves as a member of the audit committee and compensation committee. He also served as a director of PBF Energy Inc. since July 
2014 where he serves on the nominating and governance committee. Mr. Edwards holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Chemical 
Engineering from Tulane University and a Master’s degree in Business Administration from the University of Texas at San Antonio.  

Justin A. Gannon was appointed as a director of our General Partner in October 2014. Mr. Gannon has acted as an independent 
consultant and private investor since September 2013. From February 2013 through August 2013, Mr. Gannon served in various roles 
at Grant Thornton LLP, including as National Leader of Merger and Acquisition Development from June 2011 through August 2013, 
Central Region Managing Partner from October 2009 through May 2011. Since November 30, 2014, Mr. Gannon has served on the 
board of directors of California Resources Corporation. He is a former chairman of the board of directors of American Red Cross 
Chapters in the Tulsa, Oklahoma and San Antonio, Texas areas. Mr. Gannon received a Bachelor of Science degree in Accounting 
from Loyola Marymount University and is a Certified Public Accountant licensed in Texas and California.  

John B. Reilly, III was appointed as a director of our General Partner in May 2012. Mr. Reilly has also served as the President of City 
Center Investment Corp since October 2011. Prior thereto he was President of Landmark Communities and Managing Partner of 
Traditions of America since 2009. Mr. Reilly has thirty years of experience in commercial and residential real estate development and 
planning, finance management and law. Mr. Reilly serves as a trustee of Lafayette College and also served as the Chairman of the 
Board of Trustees for the Lehigh Valley Health Network. He holds a Juris Doctor degree from Fordham University Law School and a 
bachelor degree in economics from Lafayette College. He is a Certified Public Accountant and a member of the Pennsylvania Bar 
Association.  

Clayton E. Killinger was appointed as a director of our General Partner in October 2014. Mr. Killinger was elected Senior Vice 
President and Chief Financial Officer of CST Brands effective January 1, 2013. Previously, he served as Senior Vice President and 
Controller of Valero from July 2007 until January 2013. Mr. Killinger is a Certified Public Accountant, with a Bachelor of Business 
Administration in Accounting from the University of Texas at San Antonio, where he graduated Summa Cum Laude. 

Stephan F. Motz was appointed as a director of our General Partner in October 2014. Mr. Motz was first elected Senior Vice 
President of CST Brands effective January 1, 2013, and became Senior Vice President and Chief Development Officer on March 11, 
2013. He previously served as Vice President of U.S. Retail Asset Development and Administration of Valero from October 2003 
until January 2013. He received his Bachelor of Business Administration from Wilfrid Laurier University, Waterloo, Ontario.  

David F. Hrinak was appointed Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of our General Partner in October 2014. 
Previously, he served as President of our General Partner since May 2012. Mr. Hrinak was the President of DMI from September 2010 
until May 2012. From 2005 until September 2010, Mr. Hrinak served as the Vice President of Wholesale for DMI. Mr. Hrinak has 
36 years of experience in the wholesale and retail fuel distribution business. Prior to joining DMI, Mr. Hrinak was the Branded 
Wholesale Manager at ConocoPhillips.  

75 

 
 
  
Mark L. Miller was appointed Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of our General Partner in July 2012. Previously, he was Vice 
President of Acquisitions at DMI managing acquisitions, divestitures, acquisition financing and working capital requirements since 
2004. Prior to joining DMI, Mr. Miller was the Chief Financial Officer for several middle market companies in various industries. 
Mr. Miller also spent six years with Deloitte & Touche LLP. Mr. Miller holds a Bachelor of Science degree in Accounting from 
Northeastern University and is a Certified Public Accountant.  

David A. Sheaffer was appointed Chief Accounting Officer of our general partner in June 2013. Previously, he was Director of 
Financial Reporting at DMI since November 2012. Prior to joining DMI, Mr. Sheaffer was Senior Manager of Financial Reporting for 
Graham Packaging Company, Inc., a publicly traded, specialty-packaging company, from June 2008 to November 2012 and was 
Manager of Technical Accounting and Financial Reporting for Rite Aid Corporation, a publicly traded, pharmacy-retail chain, from 
March 2005 to June 2008. Mr. Sheaffer also has more than nine years of experience with public accounting firms. He holds a Bachelor 
of Science degree in Accounting from Elizabethtown College and is a Certified Public Accountant.  

Stéphane Trudel has served as Senior Vice President Mergers and Acquisitions for CrossAmerica since October 2014. Mr. Trudel 
has over 23 years of experience in the fuel marketing business, including 18 years of service with CST Brands in Canada. Mr. Trudel 
recently served as CST Brands’ Vice President of Strategic Development for U.S. and Canada, leading M&A and other growth 
projects. He was also the Director of IT between 2001 and 2008 and subsequently in management roles of the Heating and Retail 
operations where he was responsible for growing the company-operated network in Canada. Mr. Trudel started his career at Petro-
Canada (now Suncor) where he held various positions. Mr. Trudel holds an Executive MBA and a B.B.A from Sherbrooke University 
with a minor in Management Information Systems.  

Gérard Sonnier has served as CrossAmerica Corporate Secretary since October 1, 2014. He joined CST Brands, Inc. as Senior Vice 
President, General Counsel and Corporate Secretary in August of 2014. Prior to joining CST Brands, Inc., Mr. Sonnier served as Vice 
President and General Counsel at Quanta Services, Inc. Mr. Sonnier has served as General Counsel and Assistant General Counsel for 
several Fortune 300 companies since leaving the private practice of law after 14 years in 1997 to join Baker Hughes Incorporated, 
where he held various positions, including Acting General Counsel and Chief Compliance Counsel from 2000 to 2001. Mr. Sonnier 
joined Waste Management, Inc. and from 2001 to 2012 served as Assistant General Counsel — Litigation and Chief Foreign Corrupt 
Practices Act Compliance Officer. Gérard earned his B.A. from the University of Colorado and his J.D. from The Tulane University 
School of Law.  

Director Independence  
Section 303A of the New York Stock Exchange listed company manual provides that limited partnerships are not required to have a 
majority of independent directors. The Board of Directors has adopted a policy that the Board of Directors shall at all times have at 
least three independent directors or such higher number as may be necessary to comply with the applicable federal securities law 
requirements. For the purposes of this policy, “independent director” has the meaning set forth in Section 10A(m)(3) of the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, any applicable stock exchange rules and the rules and regulations promulgated in the Partnership 
governance guidelines available on its website www.crossamericapartners.com. The Board of Directors has determined that Messrs. 
Edwards, Gannon and Reilly meet the independent standards required of directors who serve on an audit committee of a board of 
directors established by the Securities Exchange Act and the rules and regulations of the Commission thereunder and by the National 
Securities Exchange on which any class of Partnership Interests is listed for or admitted to trading.  

76 

 
 
  
Composition of the Board of Directors  
Our General Partner’s Board of Directors consists of seven members. The Board of Directors holds regular and special meetings at 
any time as may be necessary. Regular meetings may be held without notice on dates set by the Board of Directors from time to time. 
Special meetings of the Board of Directors or meetings of any committee thereof may be held at the request of the Chairman of the 
Board of Directors or a majority of the Board of Directors (or a majority of the members of such committee) upon at least two days (if 
the meeting is to be held in person) or 24 hours (if the meeting is to be held telephonically) prior oral or written notice to the other 
members of the board or committee or upon such shorter notice as may be approved by the directors or members of such committee. A 
quorum for a regular or special meeting will exist when a majority of the members are participating in the meeting either in person or 
by telephone conference. Any action required or permitted to be taken at a board meeting may be taken without a meeting if such 
action is evidenced in writing and signed by a majority of the members of the Board of Directors.  

Meeting of Non-Management Directors and Communications with Directors  
At each of our four regularly scheduled meetings of the Board of Directors of our General Partner, all of our independent directors 
intend to meet in an executive session without participation by management. A non-management director will preside over each 
executive session of the non-management directors, although the same director is not required to preside over each session. Any non-
management director may request that additional executive sessions of the non-management directors be held, and the presiding non-
management director for the previous session will determine whether to call any such meeting.  

Unitholders or interested parties may communicate directly with the Board of Directors of our General Partner, any committee of the 
Board of Directors, any independent directors, or any one director, by sending written correspondence by mail addressed to the Board 
of Directors, committee or director to the attention of our Secretary at the following address: c/o Corporate Secretary, CrossAmerica 
Partners LP, 645 Hamilton Street, Suite 500, Allentown, PA 18101. Communications are distributed to the Board of Directors, 
committee of the Board of Directors, or director, as appropriate, depending on the facts and circumstances outlined in the 
communication. Commercial solicitations or communications will not be forwarded.  

Committees of the Board of Directors  
Prior to October 1, 2014, the Board of Directors of our General Partner had an audit committee, a compensation committee, a 
nominating and corporate governance committee, a conflicts committee and an acquisitions committee. Effective October 1, 2014, the 
Board of Directors of our General Partner dissolved all committees and established an audit committee and a conflicts committee. The 
charter for each of the committees can be found in its entirety on CrossAmerica Partners’ website at www.crossamericapartners.com 
under the “Corporate Governance” tab in the “Investors” section. The Board of Directors held six meetings prior to October 1, 2014 
and two meetings after October 1, 2014, and each director attended at least 80% of the Board and respective committee meetings 
while she or he was a director for the meetings prior to October 1, 2014 and after October 1, 2014, each director attended 100% of the 
Board and respective committee meetings while she or he was a director.  

Audit Committee  
Concurrent with the GP Purchase to CST Brands, effective October 1, 2014, Justin A. Gannon, Gene Edwards and John B. Reilly, III 
were appointed as members of the audit committee. Mr. Gannon is the chair of the audit committee. As required by the NYSE, the 
audit committee is comprised entirely of directors who meet the financial literacy standards required of directors who serve on an 
audit committee in accordance with the rules and regulations established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act. The rules and 
regulations established by the NYSE and the Exchange Act also generally require that our audit committee consist entirely of 
independent directors. The Board of Directors of our General Partner has determined that Messrs. Edwards, Gannon and Reilly meet 
the independence standards required of audit committee members by the NYSE and the Exchange Act. The Board of Directors of our 
General Partner has determined that Messrs. Edwards, Gannon and Reilly are both “audit committee financial experts” as defined by 
SEC rules. The audit committee assists the Board of Directors in its oversight of the integrity of our financial statements and our 
compliance with legal and regulatory requirements and partnership policies and controls. The audit committee may also review and 
resolve matters that the Board of Directors determines may involve a conflict of interest under the Code of Conduct. The audit 
committee held three meetings for the period January 1, 2014 through September 30, 2014 and two meetings for the period October 1, 
2014 through December 31, 2014.  

77 

 
 
  
Conflicts Committee  
Effective October 1, 2014, Gene Edwards, Justin A. Gannon and John B. Reilly, III were appointed as members of the conflicts 
committee. Pursuant to our partnership agreement, the members of the conflicts committee may not be officers or employees of our 
General Partner or directors, officers or employees of its affiliates, and must meet the independence standards established by the 
NYSE and the Exchange Act to serve on an audit committee of a Board of Directors. The Board of Directors of our General Partner 
has determined that Messrs. Edwards, Gannon and Reilly qualify to serve on the conflicts committee. The conflicts committee is 
responsible for reviewing specific matters that the Board of Directors of our General Partner believes may involve conflicts of interest 
between the General Partner and its affiliates and the Partnership. The conflicts committee determines if the resolution of the conflict 
is fair and reasonable to our partnership. The conflicts committee held seven meetings for the period January 1, 2014 through 
September 30, 2014, and eight meetings for the period October 1, 2014 through December 31, 2014. 

Committees Serving Prior to October 1, 2014  
Prior to October 1, 2014, the Board of Directors of the General Partner also had a compensation committee, a nominating and 
corporate governance committee and an acquisitions committee, which held 5, 1 and 2 meetings during 2014, respectively. The 
responsibilities of these committees have been assumed by the Board of Directors of the General Partner as of October 1, 2014.  

Meetings of Unitholders  
Our partnership agreement provides that the General Partner manages and operates us and that, unlike holders of common stock in a 
corporation, unitholders only have limited voting rights on matters affecting our business or governance. Accordingly, we do not hold 
annual meetings of unitholders.  

Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance  
Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act requires our General Partner’s Board of Directors and officers, and beneficial owners of more than 
10% of a class of our equity securities registered pursuant to Section 12 of the Exchange Act (the “Reporting Person”), to file reports 
of beneficial ownership and reports of changes in beneficial ownership of such securities with the SEC Reporting Persons are required 
by SEC regulations to furnish to us copies of all Section 16(a) forms they file with the SEC.  

SEC regulations require us to identify in this Form 10-K anyone who filed a required report late during the most recent fiscal year. 
Based on our review of forms we received, or written representations from reporting persons stating that they were not required to file 
these forms, we believe that during 2014, all Section 16(a) filing requirements were satisfied on a timely basis with the exception of 
the following:  

•  

•  

One Form 4 relating to the purchase of units by Mr. Malloy filed on May 20, 2014, and was two days late, and  
One Form 4 for each of Messrs. Gannon, Edwards and Reilly filed on December 31, 2014, related to the phantom unit 
award for their service as independent directors granted on November 10, 2014, and disclosed in Form 8-K on  
October 24, 2014.  

Code of Conduct and Business Conduct  
The Board of Directors of our General Partner has adopted a Code of Ethics and Business Conduct that applies to directors and 
executive officers of CrossAmerica GP LLC and all employees of DMI. Our General Partner also expects all employees of DMI and 
CST performing services for the Partnership and its operating subsidiaries to adhere to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct. 
Amendments to or waivers from the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct can be found in its entirety on CrossAmerica Partners’ 
website at www.crossamericapartners.com under the “Corporate Governance” tab in the “Investors” section. The Board of Directors 
of our General Partner has also adopted Governance Guidelines that outline important policies and practices regarding our 
governance, which can also be found in its entirety on CrossAmerica Partners’ website at www.crossamericapartners.com under the 
“Corporate Governance” tab in the “Investors” section. Requests for print copies may be directed to Investor Relations at 
info@crossamericapartners.com or to Investor Relations, CrossAmerica Partners LP, and 645 Hamilton St., Suite 500, Allentown, PA 
18101 or made by telephone at (610) 625-8126. The information contained on, or connected to, our website is not incorporated by 
reference into this Annual Report on Form 10-K and should not be considered part of this or any other report that we file with or 
furnish to the SEC.  

78 

 
 
  
Reimbursement of Expenses of Our General Partner  
Except as otherwise set forth in our omnibus agreement, our partnership agreement requires us to reimburse our General Partner for all 
direct and indirect expenses it incurs or payments it makes on our behalf and all other expenses reasonably allocable to us or otherwise 
incurred by our General Partner in connection with operating our business. The partnership agreement does not limit the amount of 
expenses for which our General Partner and its affiliates may be reimbursed. These expenses include salary, bonus, incentive 
compensation and other amounts paid to persons who perform services for us or on our behalf and expenses allocated to our General 
Partner by its affiliates. Our General Partner is entitled to determine in good faith the expenses that are allocable to us. Please read 
“Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions and Director Independence—Omnibus Agreement.”  

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION  

ITEM 11. 
Compensation Discussion and Analysis  
This Compensation Discussion and Analysis (“CD&A”) discusses the principles underlying our General Partner’s compensation 
programs and the key executive compensation decisions that were made during 2014. It also explains the most important factors 
relevant to such decisions. This CD&A provides context and background for the compensation earned and awarded to our named 
executive officers (“NEOs”) under the 2012 Incentive Award Plan (“IAP”) and the 2014 Performance-Based Equity Program (the 
“Performance Program”) by us, as reflected in the compensation tables that follow the CD&A. Our NEOs for 2014 were as follows:  

Joseph V. Topper, Jr., President and Chief Executive Officer  

•  
•   Mark L. Miller, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer  
•  David F. Hrinak, Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer  
•   Tracy Derstine, Executive Vice President, Administration (1)  
• 
•   David A. Sheaffer, Chief Accounting Officer  

Frank Macerato, General Counsel, Secretary & Chief Compliance Officer (2)  

(1)  Ms. Derstine resigned effective December 31, 2014  
(2)  Mr. Macerato resigned effective September 30, 2014  

Overview  
Neither we nor our general partner directly employs any of the persons responsible for managing our business as of December 31, 
2014. All of our General Partner’s executive officers and other personnel necessary for managing our business were employees of 
DMI or CST. However, the Board of Directors of our General Partner believes it is important to promote the interests of the 
Partnership and the General Partner by providing incentive compensation awards to employees, who perform services for us or on our 
behalf, for their service. Accordingly, pursuant to our partnership agreement, the General Partner is permitted to, and has adopted, the 
IAP and the related Performance-Based Equity Awards Program (the “Performance Program” and, together with the IAP, the 
“Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program”). During 2014, the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program was administered 
by the compensation committee of the Board of Directors. Under the terms of the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement 
(defined herein), with DMI, we reimburse DMI for all expenses incurred by DMI in connection with the provision of general and 
administrative services, including the provision of executive management services. See Related Party Transactions herein. Except for 
awards under the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program, DMI and its Board of Directors have the decision-making authority 
with respect to the compensation of our NEOs.  

79 

 
 
  
Roles and Responsibilities  
Through September 30, 2014, the former compensation committee of the Board of Directors (the “Committee) was responsible for 
reviewing and approving the compensation of our chief executive officer (“CEO”) and, with the recommendation of our CEO, the 
compensation of the other executive officers, and for administering the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program. The 
Committee met five times in 2014. The CEO generally attended the meetings, but was excused during discussions of the CEO 
compensation arrangements. The Committee, among other duties, determined (a) the annual incentives and long-term incentives 
awarded to our NEOs; (b) the criteria for achieving annual and long-term incentive awards; (c) whether the conditions for the payment 
of awards have been met, and (d) whether recommended increases in base compensation should be approved. The Committee 
periodically reviewed all of the elements of our executive compensation program to make sure they were consistent with our business 
strategy and unit holder interests and that our incentive compensation programs remained competitive in light of changing trends, 
practices and market conditions while not encouraging excessive risk taking.  

Effective October 1, 2014, in connection with the GP Purchase, the Committee was dissolved and duties and responsibilities delegated 
to the Committee reverted to the Board of Directors.  

In 2013, the Partnership engaged Pay Governance, LLC (“Pay Governance”) as their independent executive compensation consultant. 
To assist the Committee with compensation decisions regarding fiscal year 2014, Pay Governance provided the Committee with an 
analysis on general marketplace practices. Pay Governance does not provide any other services to the Partnership and has not had any 
prior relationship with any of our executive officers. In compliance with the SEC and the NYSE disclosure requirements regarding the 
independence of compensation consultants, Pay Governance has affirmed their independence with regard to their partners, consultants 
and employees who provide services to the Committee on executive compensation matters.  

The CEO and the Executive Vice President, Administration, who had overall responsibility for Human Resources, reviewed the 
general marketplace compensation data and information provided by the Committee’s independent compensation consultant. Based on 
feedback from the Committee regarding this data and the CEO’s subjective view of each executive officer’s performance, the CEO 
and Executive Vice President, Administration recommended annual incentive targets as a percentage of base compensation for each 
NEO, other than the CEO, The Committee reviewed these recommendations along with other general marketplace data, and 
determined the final annual incentive targets for all executive officers, other than the CEO. The Committee reviewed this data for the 
CEO and the performance of the CEO and determined the CEO’s incentive award as a percentage of base compensation. Except as 
described above, the CEO does not participate in this process. Management also reviews policies and plans that impact executive 
compensation and benefits and makes appropriate recommendations regarding these policies and plans to the Board of Directors based 
on general marketplace data, best practices and good corporate governance. For the first three quarters of 2014, the CEO elected to be 
paid his base compensation in profit interests (as defined herein) rather than cash. In anticipation of the GP Purchase, the 
compensation committee voted to pay the CEO for his services from January 1, 2014 to September 30, 2014 in profit interests (as 
defined herein), the number to be calculated based on the closing price of the partnership’s common units on the dates on which the 
CEO would have received cash compensation, which were to be award at the next open trading window period for the CEO, and 
would immediately vest upon their grant. See note 17 for a description of the profits interests.  

Compensation Objectives and Philosophy  
Our 2014 NEO compensation framework was designed to provide retention incentives for our NEOs and incent our NEOs to increase 
the value of our common units. Our compensation program is intended to:  

• 

• 

• 

motivate and retain our General Partner’s key executives;  
align the long-term economic interests of our General Partner’s executives with those of our unit holders; 
and  
reward excellence and performance by our General Partner’s executives that increases the distribution 
and value of our units. These objectives govern the Committee’s decisions with respect to the amount of 
compensation that can be earned by our NEOs under the IAP.  

80 

 
 
  
Elements of Executive Compensation  
Our executive compensation programs are designed to reflect the philosophy and objectives described above. The elements of 
executive pay are presented in the table below and discussed in more detail in the following paragraphs.  

Component 

Base Salary 

Type of Payment/Benefit 

Purpose 

Fixed cash payments with each executive generally 
eligible for annual increase. 

To attract and retain qualified executives. 

Incentive compensation 

under the IAP   

Phantom Units or Profits Interests (as defined 
herein) at the election of the NEO 

Align long-term interests of NEOs with those of our 
public unitholders by rewarding for performance 
based performance and growth. 

Our compensation philosophy for our NEOs has been driven by the need to recruit, develop, motivate and retain top talent both in the 
short-term and long-term. The same compensation philosophy has been applied to all levels of managerial employees. The Committee 
considered other factors, which included internal pay equity and consistency and the NEO’s job responsibilities, management 
experience, individual contributions, number of years in his or her position and recent compensation adjustments, as well as other 
relevant considerations (with no particular weighting assigned to any of these factors). Our emphasis on variable or “at risk” 
components of incentive pay results in actual compensation based on the achievement of the objectives established in our annual and 
long-term incentive plans and changes in the distributions and value of our common units. While the Partnership believes that each 
compensation component should be considered separately and that payments or awards derived from one component should not 
negate or reduce payments or awards derived from other components, the components are considered within the context of each 
executive’s total compensation.  

The Committee did not adopt any formal or informal policies or guidelines for allocating compensation between long-term and annual 
compensation or among different forms of non-cash compensation. However, our strategy includes ongoing evaluation and adaptation, 
as necessary, of our compensation programs to ensure continued alignment between company performance and pay.  

Cash Compensation Except as described below, we have not directly paid, and do not intend to directly pay, any cash compensation to 
our NEOs. The compensation information for our NEOs contained in the 2014 Summary Compensation Table was paid by DMI under 
the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement.  

Effective as of July 22, 2013, the Committee, upon request by DMI and with input from Pay Governance LLC, its independent 
compensation consultant, decided to change the structure of Mr. Topper’s base compensation. In lieu of cash, the Committee granted 
Mr. Topper 10,997 profits interests (as defined herein) under the IAP on September 27, 2014, with the award to be made and 
immediately vest on the next open window period for the CEO. The value of these profit interests on the date of grant was equal to the 
amount of cash the CEO would have received base cash compensation for the period beginning on January 1, 2014, and ending on 
September 30, 2014. Because base compensation is paid by DMI and included in the monthly payments made by us to DMI under the 
Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, DMI will reimburse us for the value of the profits interests in the amount of $308,385, 
which is the amount of compensation Mr. Topper would have received.  

Long Term Incentives. Our General Partner adopted the IAP for employees, officers, consultants and directors of our General Partner 
and any of its affiliates, including DMI, who perform services for us. The IAP provides for the grant of restricted units, unit options, 
performance awards, phantom units, unit awards, unit appreciation rights, distribution equivalent rights and other unit-based awards. 
Generally, we grant long-term incentive awards on or about March 15 of each year in conjunction with the review of other elements of 
total compensation. We do not time IAP grants in coordination with the release of material non-public information.  

81 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Phantom Units. A phantom unit represents a notional common unit granted under the IAP, which, upon vesting, entitles the phantom 
unit holder to receive (as determined by the Board in its discretion) either a common unit or an amount of cash equal to the fair market 
value of a common unit. The phantom units generally have a three year vesting period so long as the award recipient remains in 
continuous service with us, our General Partner or any of our General Partner’s affiliates and any forfeiture restrictions lapse upon 
vesting. No distributions are payable to the holders of any phantom unit award until such award vests and converts to common units, 
and then only if and when distributions are made by us to our common unit holders. The amounts of the awards granted to the NEOs 
were based on the CEO’s recommendations, considering factors such as scope of responsibility, longevity with the Partnership’s 
predecessor and performance.  

Profits Interests. Effective March 6, 2014, the former Committee approved a new type of other unit-based award: profits interests. 
Profits interests are represented by Class B Units of our wholly-owned subsidiary, LGP Operations LLC (“Operations”), which are 
designed to constitute “profits interests” within the meaning of the Internal Revenue Code and published Internal Revenue Service 
guidance and will generally not be taxed at the time of grant, though the holder will be required to report on his income tax return his 
allocable share of Operations’ income, gain, loss, deduction, and credit, regardless of whether Operations makes a distribution of cash. 
Instead, such units are generally taxed upon a disposition of the unit or distributions of money to the extent that such amounts received 
exceed the basis in the units. Generally, no deduction is available to the Partnership or Operations upon the grant, vesting or 
disposition of the long-term incentive Class B Units. The profits interests are subject to vesting schedules determined by the 
Committee. Holders of vested Class B Units are entitled to receive distribution equivalents from us generally on the same terms as our 
common unit holders and vested Class B Units are redeemable for our common units beginning on the second anniversary of the grant 
date at a conversion ratio of not greater than 1:1.  

Performance-Based Equity Awards Program under the IAP. Our NEO’s participate in the Performance Program. Pursuant to this 
program, each NEO will receive a certain percentage of his or her actual base salary (which is paid by DMI), as shown below, as a 
performance bonus if the Partnership achieves certain performance goals in 2014. The annual incentive opportunity percentage is 
determined solely at the discretion of the Board, but is generally based on the level of accountability and future potential of each 
executive and the achievement of outstanding individual results.  

The Performance Program for executive officers, as determined by the Board, was based on the achievement of pre-determined targets 
for earnings of $65.0 million, before interest, tax, depreciation and amortization, as adjusted for acquisitions and certain extraordinary 
expenses (“EBITDA”) weighted at 65%, and growth weighted at 35% for a target multiple on acquisitions of 8x. The Committee 
believed the EBITDA goal reflects how we have performed in all areas of managing our business, and the growth goal, which is 
measured by the dollar value of acquisitions which are within the Partnership’s pre-determined valuation formulas, is a key driver in 
growing the distributions and value of the Partnership.  

The EBITDA and Growth goals for 2014 were:  

Measure 
EBITDA (as adjusted) 
Growth   

75% of Payout 

100% of Payout 
90% of EBITDA target  100% of EBITDA target  110% of EBITDA target 
90% of Growth target  100% of Growth target  110% of Growth target 

125% of Payout 

No payout is earned for a particular goal if less than 90% of such goal is achieved. If greater than 90% of the goal is achieved but less 
than 110% of the goal is achieved, the Payout is pro-rated. For example, if 95% of the goal is achieved, then 87.5% of the Payout for 
that goal is paid to the participant. The actual performance bonus will be paid 100% in phantom units or profits interests, one-third of 
which will vest on each anniversary of the grant date until fully vested. However, the Committee has historically retained the 
discretion to pay up to 75% of the performance bonus in cash to the participants before the grant date. However, for the 2014 award, 
the Board of Directors has chosen to pay all amounts in common units or profits interest that will be fully vested on the grant date.  

For 2014, the NEOs earned 103.00% of the annual incentive opportunity. This percentage equals weighted average result of the 
Partnership achieving a lower than target threshold for the EBITDA portion, resulting in a pro rata result of 91.15% with respect to the 
EBITDA component resulting in a 59.25% actual achievement factor, and meeting the maximum 125% target for the Growth 
component resulting in a 43.75% actual achievement factor. These combined, resulted in a 103.00% actual achievement factor for 
determination of the payout of the annual incentive opportunity.  

82 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
The calculation of amounts payable under the IAP for 2014 are demonstrated in the table below. Actual amounts paid are also 
reflected in the Summary Compensation Table in the column titled “Bonus”.  

Name and Principal Position 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 

2014 Salary  

Target Bonus 
Potential 
Percentage  

Bonus Potential 
Target  

Achievement 
Factor (1)  

Actual Bonus Paid  

President and Chief Executive Officer 

$  525,000    

100% 

Mark L. Miller 

Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer 

$  333,668    

75% 

David F Hrinak 

Executive Vice President and Chief 
Operating Officer 

Tracy A. Derstine (2) 

$  335,535    

Executive Vice President, Administration 

$  243,338    

75% 

50% 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

525,000    

103.00% 

$ 

540,750   

250,251    

103.00% 

$ 

257,759   

251,651    

103.00% 

$ 

259,201   

121,669    

103.00% 

$ 

125,319   

Frank M. Macerato (3) 

General Counsel, Secretary & Chief 
Compliance Officer 

David A. Sheaffer 

Chief Accounting Officer 

—      

—    

—      

—    

—     

$  174,068    

40% 

$ 

69,627    

103.00% 

$ 

71,716   

(1)  The Achievement Factor for the NEO’s is calculated by multiplying the percentage achievement for the Partnership against the 

pre-determined targets for each component by the respective weights given to each component.  

(2)  Ms. Derstine resigned effective December 31, 2014.  
(3)  Mr. Macerato resigned effective September 30, 2014.  

The total number of common units to be awarded will be determined on or before March 13, 2015 of this year and will be based on the 
value of the award and the closing price of our common units on the NYSE on March 13, 2015. The number of profits interests to be 
awarded is the same as the number of phantom units that otherwise would have been awarded.  

Other Benefits  
Under the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, we provide other benefits to DMI employees who provided services to the 
Partnership, such as medical coverage and life and disability insurance and a 401(k) plan. NEOs are eligible for the same benefits 
provided to other DMI employees who provide services to the Partnership, including medical coverage and life and disability 
insurance, as well as supplemental plans chosen and paid for by employees who wish for additional coverage. There are no special 
insurance plans for NEOs. Through September 30, 2014, we also provided perquisites limited to an automobile allowance.  

Severance and Change in Control Benefits  
On May 28, 2014, the Committee adopted the Lehigh Gas Partners LP Executive Income Continuity Plan (the “EICP”). Those 
individuals who are either (a) designated as executive officers of the Partnership (other than the Chief Executive Officer) by resolution 
of the Board of Directors (the “Officers”) or (b) designated as EICP participants participate in the EICP (each a “Participant”).  

The EICP provides that if an Officer is terminated from providing management services to the Partnership or the General Partner other 
than due to death, disability, retirement, Cause (as defined in the EICP) or voluntarily resignation (other than for Good Reason (as 
defined in the EICP)) (a “Termination”), then such Officer is entitled to receive a severance payment, paid in twelve equal monthly 
installments, equal to the sum of (i) the Officer’s annual salary as of the date of the date of termination, plus (ii) the amount of the 
Officer’s annual target bonus under the applicable annual incentive compensation plan in place at the time the termination occurs. In 
addition, the Officer (and his dependents, as applicable) will receive the continuation of their medical, dental and other benefits for a 
period of one year from the date of termination. Further, all unvested awards under the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program 
held by such Officer shall vest immediately upon Termination.  

83 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
If the Termination of an Officer occurs in connection with, or within 24 months after, a Change in Control (as defined in the EICP), 
then the Officer will receive a severance payment, paid in a single lump sum in cash, equal to 2.99 times the sum of (i) the Officer’s 
annual salary as of the date of termination, plus (ii) the amount of the Officer’s annual target bonus under the applicable annual 
incentive compensation plan in place at the time the termination occurs. In addition, the Officer (and his dependents, as applicable) are 
entitled to receive the continuation of their medical, dental and other benefits for a period of three years from the date of termination. 
Further, all unvested awards under the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program held by such Officer shall vest immediately 
upon a Change in Control. The Officer is also entitled to be reimbursed for job hunting expenses for one year subsequent to the 
Termination, and, in certain circumstances, reimbursement of relocation expenses and legal fees and expenses  

All payments due under the EICP will be conditioned on the execution by the Participant of a non-disparagement agreement and a 
waiver, effectively waiving all claims of the Participant against the Partnership and the General Partner (including its directors, 
officers, employees and agents) arising out of such Participant’s employment with DMI and the provision of the management services 
to the Partnership and the General Partner.  

If amounts payable to an Officer under the EICP (together with any other amounts that are payable by the Company as a result of a 
Change in Control (collectively, the “Payments”) exceed the amount allowed under section 280G of the Internal Revenue Code of 
1986, as amended (the “Code”) for such Officer, thereby subjecting the Officer to an excise tax under section 4999 of the Code, then 
the Payments shall either be: (i) reduced to the level at which no excise tax applies, such that the full amount of the Payments would 
be equal to three times the Officer’s “base amount” (as defined in the Code), or (ii) paid in full, which would subject the Officer to the 
excise tax. The Company will determine, in good faith, which route produces the best net after tax position for an Officer, but the 
Company will not provide any gross-up payments for excise taxes.  

Employment Agreements  
Our NEOs, other than the CEO, do not have employment agreements with either their employer, the Partnership, or the General 
Partner. However, concurrent with the GP Purchase, Mr. Topper and the CST entered into an employment agreement dated as of 
October 1, 2014 (the “Topper Employment Agreement”), pursuant to which Mr. Topper was appointed as the Chief Executive Officer 
and President of the General Partner. The Topper Employment Agreement has a term of one year and will automatically renew for an 
additional one year term unless the parties agree otherwise or either party gives 60-day written notice prior to the end of the initial 
term. Mr. Topper’s base salary is $525,000 per year. He is eligible to receive a short-term incentive award equal to 75% of his base 
salary and an equity award equal to 200% of his base salary. Mr. Topper is entitled to participate in all employee benefit plans and 
programs generally available to similarly situated executives of CST. CST may terminate Mr. Topper’s employment at any time for 
any reason.  

Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, Mr. Topper agrees that, during his employment and for a period equal to the 
greater of (i) the balance of his employment term and (ii) one year following termination for cause or his resignation without good 
reason (the “Restricted Period”), (x) he will not solicit or in any way be involved with any prior, current or prospective customer, 
client, consultant, broker or business partner of, or any person who had dealings with, CST or the Partnership and (y) he will not 
solicit for employment any person who is or was within the preceding six months an employee or consultant of CST or the 
Partnership. Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, during the Restricted Period, Mr. Topper also agrees that he will not 
associate in any way with any business that at any time during the Restricted Period is engaged in the business of CST or the 
Partnership other than those activities and businesses that Mr. Topper controls as of October 1, 2014.  

Relation of Compensation Policies and Practices to Risk Management  
Policies and practices are designed to provide rewards for short-term and long-term performance, both on an individual, and 
partnership basis. In general, optimal financial and operational performance, particularly in a competitive business, requires some 
degree of risk-taking. Accordingly, the use of compensation as an incentive for performance can foster the potential for management 
and others to take unnecessary or excessive risks to reach performance thresholds that qualify them for additional compensation.  

From a risk management perspective, our policy is to conduct our commercial activities within pre-defined risk parameters that are 
closely monitored and are structured in a manner intended to control and minimize the potential for unwarranted risk-taking. We also 
routinely monitor and measure the execution and performance of our operations and acquisitions relative to expectations.  

84 

 
 
  
We expect our compensation arrangements to contain a number of design elements that serve to minimize the incentive for taking 
unwarranted risk to achieve short-term, unsustainable results. Those elements include delaying the rewards and subjecting such 
rewards to forfeiture for terminations related to violations of our risk management policies and practices or of our Code of Ethics and 
Business.  

In combination with our risk-management practices, we do not believe that risks arising from our compensation policies and practices 
for our employees are reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on us.  

Pension Benefits  
Currently, we do not, and do not intend to, provide pension benefits to our NEOs. Our General Partner may revisit this policy in the 
future.  

Nonqualified Deferred Compensation  
Currently, we do not, and do not intend to, sponsor or adopt a nonqualified deferred compensation plan. Our General Partner may 
revisit this policy in the future.  

Unit Ownership Requirements  
Our General Partner does not have any express unit ownership requirements. Our General Partner may revisit this policy in the future.  

Guidelines for Trades by Insiders  
We maintain an Insider Trading Policy that governs trading in our units by officers and directors required to report under Section 16 of 
the Exchange Act, as well as certain other employees who may have regular access to material non-public information about us. These 
policies include pre-clearance requirements for all trades and periodic trading “black-out” periods designed with reference to our 
quarterly financial reporting schedule. We also require pre-approval of all trading plans adopted pursuant to Rule 10b5-1 promulgated 
under the Exchange Act. To mitigate the potential for abuse, no trades are allowed under a trading plan within 30 days after adoption. 
In addition, we discourage termination or amendment of trading plans by prohibiting trades under new or amended plans within 30 
days following a plan termination or amendment. In addition, this policy prohibits or restricts (a) speculative transactions in our units 
such as short-term trading, short sales, puts, calls or other similar transactions in an effort to hedge certain economic risks or 
otherwise; (b) holding securities of the Partnership in a margin account; and (c) pledging Partnership securities as collateral for loans. 
A copy of our Insider Trading Policy is available in its entirety on CrossAmerica Partners’ website www.crossamericapartners.com 
under the “Corporate Governance” tab in the “Investors” section.  

Impact of Regulatory Requirements  
We are a limited partnership and not a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes. Therefore, we believe that the compensation 
paid to the named executive officers is not subject to the deduction limitations under Section 162(m) of the Internal Revenue Code and 
therefore is generally fully deductible for federal income tax purposes.  

Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation. On October 22, 2004, the American Jobs Creation Act of 2004 was signed into law, changing 
the tax rules applicable to non-qualified deferred compensation arrangements. The employment agreement with Mr. Topper and the 
EICP may be subject to these provisions. However, we believe we are in compliance with the statutory provisions, which were 
effective January 1, 2005, and the regulations, which became effective on January 1, 2009.  

85 

 
 
  
Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation. We account for stock-based compensation in accordance with the requirements of FASB 
ASC Topic 718 for all of our stock-based compensation plans. See Note 17 of the notes to our consolidated financial statements 
included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014, for a discussion of all assumptions made in the 
calculation of this amount.  

Policy on Recovery of Compensation. Our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are required to repay certain bonuses 
and stock-based compensation they receive if we are required to restate our financial statements as a result of misconduct as required 
by Section 304 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.  

Committee Report  
The Board of Directors has reviewed and discussed the Compensation Discussion and Analysis required by Item 402(b) of 
Regulation S-K with management and, has included this Compensation Discussion and Analysis in our Annual Report on Form 10-K.  

The members of the Board of Directors have submitted this Report on February 25, 2015:  

2014 Summary Compensation Table  
The following Summary Compensation Table sets forth the compensation for our NEOs: our Chief Executive Officer, Mr. Topper: our 
Chief Financial Officer, Mr. Miller, and our General Partner’s three other most highly compensated executive officers for the fiscal 
year ended December 31, 2014. It also includes any executive officer who would have been one of the General Partner’s three other 
most highly compensated executive officers had such person been an executive officer on December 31, 2014.  

Name and Principal Position 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr (3) 

Chief Executive Officer 

Mark L. Miller 

Chief Financial Officer 

David F Hrinak 
President 

Tracy A. Derstine  

Executive Vice President, 
Administration 

Frank M. Macerato 

General Counsel, Secretary & Chief 
Compliance Officer 

David A. Sheaffer 

Chief Accounting Officer 

Fiscal Year  

Salary 
($)(1)(2)  

Bonus 
($)(4)  

Stock Awards 
($)(5)  

All Other 
Compensation 
($)  

Total 
($)  

2014  
2013  

$411,366  
  170,523  

$ 540,750  
  152,491  

$ 

 —    
—    

2014  
2013  

$344,007  
  —    

$ 257,759  
  85,497  

 —    
$ 
  1,222,715  

2014  
2013  

$309,808  
  —    

$ 259,201  
  85,500  

$ 
 —    
  1,358,570  

$ 

$ 

$ 

9,794  
—    

$  961,910  
323,014  

14,531(6) 
—    

$  616,297  
  1,308,212  

26,231(7) 
—    

$  595,240  
  1,440,070  

2014  
2013  

$239,326  
  —    

$ 125,319  
  43,588  

2014  
2013  

$178,896  
  —    

$ 
 —    
  32,885  

2014  
2013  

$153,731  
  —    

$  71,716  
—    

$ 

$ 

$ 

 —    
649,602  

$  1,132,707(8) 

—    

$1,497,352  
693,190  

 —    
110,034  

$  1,249,085(9) 

—    

$1,427,981  
142,919  

 —    
—    

$ 

9,279(10) 
—    

$  234,726  
—    

(1) 

(2) 

This column represents salaries paid by DMI under the provisions of the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, unless 
otherwise stated, to our NEOs for their service to the Partnership. Our NEOs did not receive any base compensation directly 
from the Partnership in 2014, with the exception of change in control payments made under the provisions of the EICP as 
further described herein.  
The annual base salaries for Messrs. Topper, Miller, Hrinak, Macerato, and Sheaffer and Ms. Derstine were increased during 
fiscal 2014. Therefore the amounts shown reflect a base salary paid at different annual rates during fiscal 2014.  

86 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
(4) 

(3)  Mr. Topper’s salary reflects the cash compensation received from CST for the period October 1, 2014, through December 31, 
2014, in the amount of $102,980, plus the dollar value of $308,385 of the 10,997 common units issued to Mr. Topper for the 
period January 1, 2014 through September 31, 2014, (to be issued in 2015) and is based on the average closing price for the 
common units of the Partnership on the dates on which Mr. Topper would have received the cash compensation for his base 
pay. For 2013, amount represents the dollar value of 6,304 common units issued to Mr. Topper for services provided to the 
Partnership, and reimbursed by DMI.  
This amount represents the dollar amount due our NEOs under the Performance Program. The number of common units or 
profits interests will be determined based on the closing price of our common units on the NYSE on the grant date, which is 
expected to be March 14, 2015. Due to the timing of the grants, the awards are not reflected in this Summary Compensation 
Table as equity for the 2014 year, and will instead be disclosed as equity for the 2015 Grants of Plan Based Awards Table. The 
amount for 2013 was previously disclosed under All Other Compensation in 2013.  
This column represents the aggregate grant date fair value for the phantom units granted in 2013 under the IAP. Fair value was 
calculated using the closing price of our units on the date of grant. The per unit grant date fair value for the 2013 grants was 
$22.65. Mr. Sheaffer was not a disclosed NEO in 2013.  
Includes contributions to the DMI 401(k) plan in the amount of $10,400, and amounts attributable to group term life insurance 
and a car allowance.  
Includes contributions to the DMI 401(k) plan in the amount of $10,400, a housing allowance of $11,400 and amounts 
attributable to group term life insurance and a car allowance.  

(6) 

(7) 

(5) 

(8)  Ms. Derstine resigned effective December 31, 2014. Accordingly this amount includes a severance payment pursuant to the 

EICP Plan of $1,119,189 to be paid in 2015. Amount also includes contributions to the DMI 401(k) plan of $9,573, and 
amounts attributable to group term life insurance and a car allowance.  

(9)  Mr. Macerato resigned effective September 30, 2014. Accordingly this amount includes a severance payment pursuant to the 
EICP Plan of $1,238,085 to be paid in 2015. Amount also includes contributions to the DMI 401(k) plan of $7,794, and 
amounts attributable to group term life insurance and a car allowance.  
Includes contributions to the DMI 401(k) plan in the amount of $6,149, and amounts attributable to group term life insurance 
and a car allowance.  

(10) 

Grants of Plan Based Awards in 2014  
The following table provides information regarding plan-based awards granted to our NEOs during fiscal year 2014.  

Name 
Joseph Topper 
Mark Miller (2) 
David F. Hrinak   
Tracy A. Derstine  
Frank Macerato 

Grant 
Date  
3/14/2014  
3/14/2014  
3/14/2014  
3/14/2014  
3/14/2014  

All Other 
Stock  
Awards: 
(#)(1) 

Grant Date Fair Value of Units and 
Option Awards  

$ 

5,670  
1,907  
3,179  
1,620  
4,858  

152,466  
51,279  
85,483  
43,562  
32,860  

(1)  Represents phantom units or profits interest granted under the Performance Program. With the exception of Mr. Topper, all 
awards vested under the provisions in the EICP. All awards that were Phantom Units converted to common units. These are 
2014 Grants related to the 2013 bonus pad under the Performance Program.  

(2)  Mr. Miller’s total award was for $85,497 of which he elected to receive $34,199 in cash and received and 1,907 Phantom Units  

87 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Outstanding Equity Awards at December 31, 2014  
The following table provides information regarding the number of outstanding equity awards held by our NEOs at December 31, 2014.  

Name 
Joseph V Topper, Jr (3) 
Mark Miller (4) 
David C. Hrinak (4) 
Tracy Derstine (4) 
Frank Macerato (4) 
David A. Sheaffer (4) 

Unit Awards  

Number of 
Units That 
Have Not 
Vested 
(#)(1)  

Market Value of 
Units That Have 
Not Vested 
($)(2)  

5,670  
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

228,443  
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

(1)  The award in this column is profits interests issued under the Performance Program in connection with the 2013 annual 

incentive program, which vest ratably every year beginning March 15, 2015, through March 15, 2017.  

(2)  Amount in this column is based upon a fair market value of $40.29 per unit which was the NYSE closing price of our common 

units on December 31, 2014.  

(3)  The award for Mr. Topper does not include 10,997 profits interest that will be granted in 2015 related to his compensation for 

his services to the Partnership for the period January 1, 2014, through September 30, 2014.  

(4)  Messrs. Miller, Hrinak, Macerato, Sheaffer and Ms. Derstine were covered under the EICP and, as a result, all outstanding awards 
were subject to accelerated vesting upon the GP Purchase. Accordingly, no awards are outstanding as of December 31, 2014.  

Option Exercises and Stock Vested in 2014  
The following table summarizes for each NEO the units vested during 2014.  

Name 
Joseph V Topper, Jr. 
Mark Miller (5) 
David C. Hrinak (6) 
Tracy Derstine (7) 
Frank Macerato (8) 
David A. Sheaffer (9) 

Unit Awards  

Number of 
Units Acquired 
on Vesting 
(#) (1)(4)  

—    
34,204  
35,174  
19,437  
4,059  
2,009  

Value Realized on 
Vesting 
($) (2)(3)  

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

—    
1,774,591  
2,007,779  
963,415  
195,374  
119,682  

(1)  Under the provisions of the EICP with respect to the GP Purchase, all of outstanding awards for Messrs. Miller, Hrinak, 

Macerato, Sheaffer and Ms. Derstine vested.  

the vesting date.  

(2)  Amount in this column is based upon a fair market value per unit which was the NYSE closing price of our common units as of 

(3)  Profits interest can be converted to either cash or common units, at the discretion of the board, on a basis no greater than one 

common unit or cash equivalent for each profits interests. The number of profits interests awarded was the same number as 
those awarded to recipients of phantom units.  

(4)  Common units listed were acquired as a result of the conversion of phantom units, less any common units withheld for payment 

of applicable withholding taxes.  
(5)  Amount represents all common units.  

88 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(6)  Amount represents 35,174 common units and 3,179 profits interest, not included in this table, which are exchangeable in the 

(7)  Amount represents 19,437 common units and 1,620 profits interest, not included in this table, which are exchangeable in the 

(8)  Amount represents all common units.  
(9)  Amount represents 2,009 common units and 726 profits interest, not included in this table, which are exchangeable in the future 

future for common units.  

future for common units.  

for common units.  

Potential Payments upon Termination or Change-in-Control  
As previously indicated, on May 28, 2014, the former Committee adopted the EICP. Those individuals who are either (a) designated 
as executive officers of the Partnership (other than the Chief Executive Officer) by resolution of the Board (the “Officers”) or 
(b) designated as EICP participants participate in the EICP.  

Termination of Employment Prior to a Change in Control  
The EICP provides that if an Officer is terminated from providing management services to the Partnership or the General Partner other 
than due to death, disability, retirement, Cause (as defined in the EICP) or voluntarily resignation (other than for Good Reason (as 
defined in the EICP)) (a “Termination”), then such Officer is entitled to receive a severance payment, paid in twelve equal monthly 
installments, equal to the sum of (i) the Officer’s annual salary as of the date of the date of termination, plus (ii) the amount of the 
Officer’s annual target bonus under the applicable annual incentive compensation plan in place at the time the termination occurs. In 
addition, the Officer (and his dependents, as applicable) will receive the continuation of their medical, dental and other benefits for a 
period of one year from the date of termination. Further, all unvested awards under the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program 
held by such Officer shall vest immediately upon Termination.  

Termination of Employment Following a Change in Control  
If the Termination of an Officer occurs in connection with, or within 24 months after, a Change in Control (as defined in the EICP), 
then the Officer will receive a severance payment, paid in a single lump sum in cash, equal to 2.99 times the sum of (i) the Officer’s 
annual salary as of the date of termination, plus (ii) the amount of the Officer’s annual target bonus under the applicable annual 
incentive compensation plan in place at the time the termination occurs. In addition, the Officer (and his dependents, as applicable) 
will receive the continuation of their medical, dental and other benefits for a period of three years from the date of termination. 
Further, all unvested awards under the Partnership’s Incentive Compensation Program held by such Officer shall vest immediately 
upon a Change in Control.  

89 

 
 
Potential Payments  
The table below summarizes the potential payments either a termination of employment for (i) good reason (as defined by the plan) or 
(ii) involuntary termination without cause, within 24 months of October 1, 2014.  

Name 
Joseph V. Topper (4) 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 

involuntary termination without cause (4)  

Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
following a change in control 

Death of NEO 

Mark L. Miller 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
following a change in control 

Death of NEO 

David F Hrinak 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
following a change in control 

Death of NEO 

David A. Sheaffer 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
Voluntary termination for good reason or 
involuntary termination without cause 
following a change in control 

Death of NEO 

$ 

$ 

$ 

$ 

Cash Severance 
Payment 
($)  

Acceleration of 
Equity Awards 
($) (1)  

Continuing 
Benefits as of 
December 31, 2014 
($) (2)  

Life Insurance 
Benefits 
($) (3)  

Total 
($)  

$ 

$ 

$ 

 —     $ 

—    

$ 

 —    

$ 

 —    

$ 

 —    

 —     $ 

 —     $ 

—    

—    

$ 

$ 

 —    

 —    

$ 

$ 

 —    

$ 

 —    

200,000  

$  200,000  

$ 

583,919   $ 

—    

$ 

18,578  

$ 

 —    

$  602,497  

$  1,745,918   $ 
—     $ 
$ 

—    
—    

$ 
$ 

75,732  
—    

$ 
$ 

 —    
200,000  

$1,821,650  
$  200,000  

$ 

587,186   $ 

—    

$ 

22,651  

$ 

 —    

$  609,837  

$  1,755,687   $ 

—     $ 

—    

—    

$ 

$ 

87,954  

—    

$ 

$ 

 —    

$1,843,641  

200,000  

$  200,000  

243,695   $ 

—    

$ 

8,586  

$ 

 —    

$  252,281  

728,649   $ 

—     $ 

—    

—    

$ 

$ 

45,760  

—    

$ 

$ 

 —    

$  774,409  

200,000  

$  200,000  

(2) 

(1)  All outstanding awards vested as a result of the change in control provisions under the EICP for the NEO. In addition, the 2014 

award, to be received in 2015 will be fully vested on grant date.  
If Messrs. Miller, Hrinak or Sheaffer terminates for good reason (as defined in the plan), or is involuntarily terminated without 
cause each are entitled to outplacement services for a period of 12 months, a continuation of his health and dental benefits for up 
to 3 years and under certain circumstances, reimbursement of moving expenses and legal fees and expenses.  

(3)  Each NEO is entitled to premiums for a life insurance policy, pursuant to our group term life insurance plan, equal to 2.0X the 

NEO’s base salary as of December 31, 2014, subject to a maximum of $200,000.  

(4)  Mr. Topper is not covered under the EICP and, accordingly he is not entitled to any change in control provisions.  

90 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mr. Macerato and Ms. Derstine are also not listed as they resigned effective September 30, 2014, and December 31, 2014, 
respectively, of which these payments are scheduled to be paid six months after the resignation date.  

Current Directors in 2014  
On and effective as of October 1, 2014, Melinda B. German, Warren S. Kimber, Jr., John F. Malloy, Maura E. Topper and Robert L. 
Wiss, each a member of the Board of Directors of the General Partner, resigned in his or her capacity as such. These resignations were 
not a result of any disagreements between the General Partner and the directors on any matter relating to the General Partner’s 
operations, policies or practices.  

Mr. Topper and Mr. Reilly remain members of the Board of Directors of the General Partner. CST Brands has agreed to cause the 
appointment of Mr. Topper as a director of the General Partner for a period of at least five years commencing on October 1, 2014 or 
until a change in control of CST Brands including circumstances in which CST Brands no longer controls the General Partner. 
Further, Mr. Topper may be removed from the Board of Directors of the General Partner in certain circumstances where cause exists.  

On and effective as of October 1, 2014, CST Brands as the owner of the General Partner appointed each of the following as members 
to the Board of Directors of the General Partner: Kimberly S. Lubel, Chief Executive Officer, President and Chairman of the board of 
directors of CST Brands, Clayton E. Killinger, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of CST Brands, and Stephan F. 
Motz, Senior Vice President and Chief Development Officer of CST Brands, as directors of the Board of Directors of the General 
Partner, and Gene Edwards and Justin A. Gannon as independent directors of the Board of Directors of the General Partner.  

There is no arrangement or understanding between any of these newly elected directors, and any other person pursuant to which such 
directors were elected. There are no relationships of the newly elected directors that would require disclosure pursuant to Item 404(a) 
of Regulation S-K.  

Ms. Lubel replaced Mr. Topper as Chairman of the Board of Directors of the General Partner. Each of Messrs. Reilly, Edwards and 
Gannon are serving as independent members of the Board of Directors of the General Partner and have been named to the audit and 
conflicts committees of the Board of Directors of the General Partner. Mr. Gannon will serve as Chairman of the audit committee and 
Mr. Edwards will serve as Chairman of the conflicts committee.  

Current Director Compensation  
Each independent director will receive cash compensation of $60,000 per year (paid on a quarterly basis), an award of phantom units 
in an amount equal $70,000 based on the closing price of the Partnership’s units on the date of grant, and the chairman of each of the 
audit committee and conflicts committee will receive an additional cash compensation of $10,000 per year (paid on a quarterly basis). 
For 2014, Directors affiliated with either the Partnership or CST Brands will not receive any compensation for their service on the 
Board of Directors of the General Partner.  

In addition, non-employee directors are reimbursed for all out-of-pocket expenses in connection with attending meetings of the Board 
of Directors or committees. Each director is fully indemnified by us for actions associated with being a director to the extent permitted 
under Delaware law.  

Former Directors Compensation  
For 2014, each non-employee director was to receive an annual compensation of $55,000. On March 14, 2014, each director, at his/her 
option, received a grant of either phantom units or profits interests, valued based on the closing price of our common units on 
March 13, 2014. Each director also had the election to receive $5,000 in cash per quarter ($20,000 annually) in lieu of an equivalent 
value of his/her equity grant. No changes were made to the meeting fees or fees for serving as a committee chair. Concurrent with the 
GP Purchase, all outstanding awards vested as approved by the former Compensation Committee.  

In addition, non-employee directors are reimbursed for all out-of-pocket expenses in connection with attending meetings of the Board 
of Directors or committees. Each director is fully indemnified by us for actions associated with being a director to the extent permitted 
under Delaware law.  

91 

 
 
  
The following table sets forth certain information concerning the compensation earned by our current and former directors for the year 
ended December 31, 2014: (i) the aggregate dollar amount of all fees earned in cash for services as a director, (ii) the dollar value of 
the phantom units or profits interests to be granted to the directors on March 15, 2015 and (iii) the total compensation earned by each 
director.  

Name 
Current Directors 

Kimberly S. Lubel (3) 
Joseph V Toper (3) 
Gene Edwards (5) 
Justin A. Gannon (5) 
John B. Reilly III (4) 
Clayton E. Killinger (3) 
Stephen F. Motz (3) 

Former Directors 

Warren S. Kimber, Jr. (6)   
John F. Malloy (6) 
James H. Miller (8) 
Maura E. Topper (6) 
Robert L. Wiss (6) 
Melinda German (1) 

Fees Earned or 
Paid in Cash 
($) (1)  

All other 
compensation 
($) (2)(5)(6)(7)(8)  

Total 
($)  

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

 —    
 —    
17,500  
17,500  
29,000  
 —    
 —    

9,500  
16,500  
8,750  
11,250  
15,500  
10,500  

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

 —    
 —    
82,474  
82,474  
164,867  
 —    
 —    

82,393  
82,393  
—    
82,393  
82,393  
72,538  

 —    
$ 
$ 
 —    
$  99,974  
$  99,974  
$ 193,867  
 —    
$ 
 —    
$ 

$  92,193  
$  98,893  
$  8,750  
$  93,643  
$  97,893  
$  83,038  

(1)  Fees earned or paid in cash, and all other compensation for former Directors are for the period January 1, 2014, through 

September 30, 2014, for the current Directors, and for the period October 1, 2014 through December 31, 2014, for the former 
Directors.  

(2)  This amount represents the dollar amount paid to our directors under the IAP. Under the IAP, the directors will have the ability 
to elect to receive either phantom units or profits interests. Phantom units and profits interest can be converted to common units 
or cash, at the discretion of the Director.  

(3)  Ms. Lubel and Messrs. Topper, Killinger and Motz are employees of CST Brands and did not receive any compensation for 

their services as Directors for the period October 1, 2014, through December 31, 2014.  

(4)  For Mr. Reilly, the fees earned or paid in cash represent $14,000 for his service as a Director for the period January 1, 2014, 
through September 31, 2014, and $15,000 for his services as a Director for the period October 1, 2014 through December 31, 
2014. All other compensation represents 2,045 phantom units for his service for the period January 1, 2014, through 
September 30, 2014, and 2,047 phantom units for his service as a Director for the period October 1, 2014 through December 31, 
2014. Each phantom unit is the economic equivalent of one common unit representing a limited partner interest. The amount 
represented is based upon a fair market value of $40.29 per unit which was the NYSE closing price of our common units on 
December 31, 2014. The award of 2,045 phantom units vested on October 3, 2014, and were converted to common units as 
provided by the IAP.  

(5)  For Messrs. Edwards and Gannon amount represents 2,047 phantom units with the economic equivalent of one common unit 
representing a limited partner interest that is based upon a fair market value of $40.29 per unit which was the NYSE closing 
price of our common units on December 31, 2014. Each of these phantom units will vest on November 10, 2015, provided the 
indicated Director was in continuous service as of the vesting date. These awards were all outstanding as of December 31, 2014.  

(6)  For Messrs. Kimber, Malloy, and Ms. Topper, amount represents 2,045 profits interest and for Mr. Wiss amount represents 

2,045 phantom units. Amounts disclosed are based upon the fair value of $40.29 per unit which was the NYSE closing price of 
our common units on December 31, 2014. All profits interest were vested as of December 31, 2014.  

(7)  For Ms. German, amount represents 1,301 profits interest based upon the fair value of $40.29 per unit which was the NYSE 

closing price of our common units on December 31, 2014. All profits interest were vested as of December 31, 2014, and a 
$20,000 cash retainer.  

(8)  Mr. Miller resigned from the board effective April 2, 2014. As a result, all awards outstanding were forfeited.  

92 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation  
Messrs. Malloy, Miller and Kimber served on the Committee for the period January 1, 2014 through September 30, 2014. Concurrent 
with the GP Purchase to CST Brands, the Compensation Committee was disbanded and the responsibilities of the Compensation 
Committee were assumed by the Board. There are no interlocking relationships requiring disclosure pursuant to Item 407(e)(4)(iii).  

ITEM 12. SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED 
UNITHOLDER MATTERS  
As of February 25, 2015, the following table sets forth the beneficial ownership of our common and subordinated units of:  
each person known by us to be a beneficial owner of more than 5% of our outstanding common units;  
our General Partner;  
each NEO and director of our General Partner; and  
all of the executive officers and directors of our General Partner, as a group.  

•  

•  

•  

• 

Name of Beneficial Owner (1) 
Harvest Fund Advisors LLC (3) 
Oppenheimer Funds, Inc. (4) 
Goldman Sachs Asset Management, L.P. (5)  
Clearbridge Investments, LLC (6) 
Cross America GP LLC (7) 
Dunne Manning Inc.  

(fka Lehigh Gas Corporation) (8)(9) 

Joseph V. Topper, Jr. (8)(9)(10)(11) 
Energy Realty Partners, LLC (8)(9)  
CST Brands (12)   
Mark L. Miller 
David F. Hrinak (13) 
Frank M. Macerato (15) 
Tracy A. Derstine (13)(14)  
David A. Sheaffer (13) 
Gene Edwards 
Justin A. Gannon  
Clayton E. Killinger 
Kimberly S. Lubel 
Stephan F. Motz   
John B. Reilly, III (17) 
All executive officers and directors as a group (12 

persons) 

Common 
Units 
Beneficially 
Owned (2)  
  2,026,534    
  1,545,416    
  1,523,965    
  778,440    
—      

—      
  562,321    
  487,270    
  2,060,267    
34,204    
38,353    
5,309    
23,557    
2,735    
2,047    
2,047    
—      
—      
—      
  111,080    

Percentage 
of Common 
Units 
Beneficially 
Owned  

Subordinated 
Units 
Beneficially 
Owned  

Percentage of 
Subordinated 
Units 
Beneficially 
Owned  

Percentage 
of Total 
Units 
Beneficially 
Owned  

11.97% 
9.13% 
9.00% 
4.60% 
—    

—    
3.32% 
2.88% 
12.17% 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
* 
—    
—    
—    

*% 

—      
—      
—      
—      
—      

  3,732,218    
  6,786,499    
  1,334,259    
  6,786,499    
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
—      
738,501    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

49.60%   
90.19%   
17.73%   
90.19%   
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
9.81%   

8.28% 
6.32% 
6.23% 
3.18% 
—    

15.26% 
30.04% 
7.45% 
36.17% 
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
3.47% 

  781,653    

4.62% 

  7,525,000    

100%   

33.96% 

* 
(1) 

Less than 1%  
The address of each individual or entity named in the table above, other than Harvest Fund Advisors LLC, Oppenheimer 
Funds, Inc., Goldman Sachs Asset Management, L.P. and Clearbridge Investments, LLC, is c/o CrossAmerica GP LLC, 645 
Hamilton Street, Suite 500, Allentown, PA 18101.  

93 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
(2) 

(3) 

(4) 

(5) 

(6) 

(7) 
(8) 

(9) 

Beneficial ownership of our NEOs does not include the 2014 awards of common units and profit interests under the IAP, as 
disclosed in the Summary Compensation Table, in the aggregate amount of $1,254,745 that will vest upon award date. Had 
that award been granted on February 25, 2015, aggregate ownership would have increased by approximately 34,661 units.  
Harvest Fund Advisors LLC has (i) sole power to vote 2,026,534 common units and (ii) sole power to dispose of 2,026,534 
common units, based on its Schedule 13G filed on December 10, 2014. The address for Harvest Fund Advisors LLC is 100 W. 
Lancaster Avenue, Suite 200, Wayne, PA 19087.  
Oppenheimer Funds, Inc. had, as of December 31, 2014, (i) shared power to vote 1,558,197 common units and (ii) shared 
power to dispose of 1,558,197 common units, based on its Amendment No. 1 to Schedule 13G filed on February 4, 2015. The 
number of common units reported includes those beneficially owned by Oppenheimer SteelPath MLP Income Fund, which 
had, as of December 31, 2014, (i) sole power to vote 1,545,416 common units and (ii) shared power to dispose of 1,545,416 
common units. The address for Oppenheimer Funds, Inc. is Two World Financial Center, 225 Liberty Street, New York, NY 
10281.  
Goldman Sachs Asset Management, L.P., together with GS Investment Strategies, LLC, had, as of December 31, 2014, 
(i) shared power to vote 1,523,965 common units and (ii) shared power to dispose of 1,523,965 common units, based on their 
Amendment No. 1 to Schedule 13G jointly filed on February 13, 2015. The address for Goldman Sachs Asset Management, 
L.P. is 200 West Street, New York, NY 10282.  
Clearbridge Investments, LLC had, as of December 31, 2014, (i) sole power to vote 778,440 common units and (ii) sole power 
to dispose of 778,440 common units, based on its Schedule 13G filed on February 17, 2015. The address for Clearbridge 
Investments, LLC is 620 8th Avenue, New York, NY 10018.  
CrossAmerica GP LLC is the general partner of the Partnership and is wholly owned by CST Brands.  
In connection with the General Partner Acquisition, Mr. Topper entered into a Voting Agreement dated as of October 1, 2014 
by and among Mr. Topper, the Topper Trust, Dunne Manning Inc., an entity wholly owned by the Topper Trust for which 
Mr. Topper is the trustee (collectively, the “Topper Entities”), and CST Brands (the “Voting Agreement”), pursuant to which 
each of the Topper Entities agrees that at any meeting of the holders of shares of CST Brands common stock or common units 
or subordinated units of the Partnership, it will vote or cause to be voted such Topper Entities’ shares or units, respectively, in 
accordance with the recommendation of the board of directors of CST Brands or the board of directors of the General Partner, 
respectively. The Voting Agreement will remain in effect with respect to any Topper Entities for so long as any such Topper 
Entities is (a) a director or officer of CST Brands or affiliate thereof, including the Partnership, (b) the beneficial owner of 
more than 3% of the outstanding common stock of CST Brands or (c) the beneficial owner of 10% or more of the outstanding 
common units or subordinated units of the Partnership.  
The units shown as beneficially owned by Joseph V. Topper, Jr. include units beneficially owned by entities that are controlled 
by Mr. Topper, including Dunne Manning Inc. and Energy Realty Partners, LLC. The units that are beneficially owned by 
Mr. Topper by way of his control of Dunne Manning Inc. and Energy Realty Partners, LLC are also shown as beneficially 
owned by those entities in the table above. The units shown as beneficially owned by Mr. Topper do not include a grant of 
10,997 profits interests (as described below in footnote 12) on September 27, 2014. The award is to be made and immediately 
vest during the next open window period for Mr. Topper.  

(10)  Mr. Topper, as the President, Chief Executive Officer of our General Partner and sole director of Dunne Manning Inc. and as a 
trustee of a trust that is the sole shareholder of Dunne Manning Inc., may be deemed to have beneficial ownership of the units 
beneficially owned by Dunne Manning Inc. The units beneficially owned by Dunne Manning Inc. are included in the number 
of units shown as beneficially owned by Mr. Topper in the table above.  

(11)  Mr. Topper, as the sole manager and indirect owner of Energy Realty Partners, LLC, may be deemed to have beneficial 

ownership of the units beneficially owned by Energy Realty Partners, LLC. The units beneficially owned by Energy Realty 
Partners, LLC are included in the number of units shown as beneficially owned by Mr. Topper in the table above.  

(12)  By virtue of the Voting Agreement described above, these amounts include 562,321 common units and 6,786,499 subordinated 
units that are owned by Joseph V. Topper, Jr. and units beneficially owned by entities that are controlled by Mr. Topper, 
including Dunne Manning Inc. and Energy Realty Partners, LLC. The units that are beneficially owned by Mr. Topper by way 
of his control of Dunne Manning Inc. and Energy Realty Partners, LLC are also shown as beneficially owned by those entities 
in the table above.  
Includes common units to be issued upon the conversion of vested profits interests as follows: Mr. Hrinak 3,179 common 
units; Ms. Derstine 1,620 common units; and Mr. Sheaffer 726 common units. See “Item Executive Compensation—
Compensation Discussion and Analysis—Elements of Executive Compensation—Profits Interests” for a description of the 
profits interests.  

(13) 

(14)  The Beneficial Ownership for our NEOs, does not reflect the Performance Program award for 2014, to be granted in 2015. See 

the 2014 Summary Compensation Table in Item 11, Executive Compensation for further information.  

(15)  Mr. Macerato resigned as an officer of the General Partner effective September 30, 2014.  
(16)  Ms. Derstine resigned as an officer of the General Partner effective December 31, 2014.  
(17) 

John B. Reilly, III may be deemed to share beneficial ownership of 738,501 subordinated units beneficially owned by the 2008 
Irrevocable Agreement of Trust of John B. Reilly, Jr. (the “Reilly Trust”) in his capacity as one of two trustees of the Reilly 
Trust.  

94 

 
 
Securities Authorized For Issuance under Equity Compensation Plans  
The following table summarizes information about our equity compensation plans as of December 31, 2014:  

Plan Category 
Equity compensation plans approved 

by security holders: 

CrossAmerica Partners LP 2012 
Incentive Award Plan (1) 

Number of securities to be 
issued upon exercise of 
outstanding options, 
warrants and rights (1)  

Weighted-average 
exercise price of 
outstanding options, 
warrants and rights  

Number of securities 
remaining 
available for future 
issuance 
under equity 
compensation plans  

565,553     

n/a     

506,074   

(1)  Does not include phantom units or profits interests to be granted on March 13, 2015.  

ITEM  13. 

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR 
INDEPENDENCE  

As of February 20, 2015, CST owned 6.1% of the Partnership’s outstanding units and, pursuant to a voting agreement with Joseph V. 
Topper, Jr. and certain affiliates, has voting control over an additional 30.0% of the Partnership’s outstanding units. CST also owns 
the IDRs.  

As of February 20, 2015, Mr. Topper owned or controlled 30.0% of the Partnership’s outstanding units, the voting for which is 
controlled by CST. Prior to October 1, 2014, Mr. Topper indirectly controlled our General Partner through his ownership and control 
of DMI, which had a 100% membership interest in our General Partner, and also held 85% of the IDRs.  

As of February 20, 2015, John B. Reilly, III owned or controlled 3.5% of the Partnership’s outstanding units. Prior to October 1, 2014, 
Mr. Reilly also held 15% of the IDRs.  

The terms of the transactions and agreements disclosed in this section were determined by and among related parties and, 
consequently, are not the result of arm’s length negotiations. Such terms are not necessarily at least as favorable to the parties to these 
transactions and agreements as the terms which could have been obtained from unrelated third parties.  

Distributions and Payments to our General Partner and Certain Related Parties  
The following table summarizes the distributions and payments to be made by us to our General Partner and certain related parties in 
connection with the ongoing operation of our business and distributions and payments that would be made by us if we were to 
liquidate in accordance with the terms of our partnership agreement.  

Operational Stage  

Distributions to our General Partner  We will generally make cash distributions to the unitholders, including CST, DMI and its 

affiliates, Messrs. Topper and Reilly and a trust of which Mr. Reilly is a trustee. 

Assuming we have sufficient cash available for distribution to pay the full minimum quarterly 
distribution on all of our outstanding units for four quarters, CST, DMI and its affiliates, 
Messrs. Topper and Reilly and a trust of which Mr. Reilly is a trustee would receive an annual 
distribution of $17.0 million, collectively, on their common and subordinated units. 

95 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
  
Payments to our General Partner  

and its affiliates 

If distributions exceed the minimum quarterly distribution and other higher target levels, CST, 
as the holder of the IDRs, is entitled to increasing percentages of the distributions, up to 
50.0% of the distributions above the highest target level. 

Cash distributions to our General Partner, DMI and its affiliates, Messrs. Topper and Reilly 
and a trust of which Mr. Reilly is a trustee amounted to $17.2 million in 2014. 

We pay CST a management fee, which is initially $670,000 per month plus a variable fee of 
between zero and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for 
retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. In addition, and subject to certain restrictions on 
CST’s ability to incur third-party fees, costs, taxes and expenses, the Partnership is required to 
reimburse CST and the General Partner for all reasonable out-of-pocket third-party fees, 
costs, taxes and expenses incurred by CST or the General Partner on the Partnership’s behalf 
in connection with providing the services required to be provided by CST under the Amended 
Omnibus Agreement. The Partnership incurred $2.5 million in management fees under the 
Amended Omnibus Agreement for the period October 1, 2014 through December 31, 2014. 

Prior to October 1, 2014, we paid DMI a management fee under the Original Omnibus 
Agreement. The Partnership incurred $6.1 million for the period January 1, 2014 through 
September 30, 2014. 

Liquidation Stage 

Liquidation 

Upon our liquidation, the partners, including our General Partner, is entitled to receive 
liquidating distributions according to their particular capital account balances. 

Ownership of Our General Partner  
Since October 1, 2014, CST indirectly owns all of the membership interests in our General Partner.  

Agreements with CST and its Affiliates  
On October 1, 2014, in connection with the GP Purchase, we entered into certain agreements with CST and its affiliates, as described 
in more detail below.  

Amended Omnibus Agreement  
We entered into an Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, dated October 1, 2014, by and among the Partnership, the General 
Partner, DMI, CST Services, LGO and Mr. Topper (the “Amended Omnibus Agreement”), which amends and restates the Original 
Omnibus Agreement. The terms of the Amended Omnibus Agreement were approved by the former conflicts committee of the board 
of directors of the General Partner, which is comprised solely of independent directors.  

Management Services and Term. Pursuant to the Amended Omnibus Agreement, CST provides us and our General Partner with 
management, administrative and operating services. These services include accounting, tax, legal, internal audit, risk management and 
compliance, environmental compliance and remediation management oversight, treasury, information technology and other 
administrative functions. As the Partnership does not have any employees, CST provides the Partnership and our General Partner with 
personnel necessary to carry out these services and any other services necessary to operate the Partnership’s business. We do not have 
any obligation to compensate the officers of our General Partner or employees of CST.  

Pursuant to the terms of a transition services agreement by and between DMI and CST Services, DMI provided the management 
services it provided under the Original Omnibus Agreement to the Partnership on behalf of CST Services through December 31, 2014.  

The initial term of the Amended Omnibus Agreement is five years and will automatically renew for additional one year terms unless 
any party provides written notice to the other parties 180 days prior to the end of the then current term. The Partnership has the right to 
terminate the agreement at any time upon 180 days’ prior written notice.  

96 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
Fees and Reimbursements. We pay CST a management fee, which is initially $670,000 per month plus a variable fee of between zero 
and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. In addition, 
and subject to certain restrictions on CST’s ability to incur third-party fees, costs, taxes and expenses, the Partnership is required to 
reimburse CST and the General Partner for all reasonable out-of-pocket third-party fees, costs, taxes and expenses incurred by CST or 
the General Partner on the Partnership’s behalf in connection with providing the services required to be provided by CST under the 
Amended Omnibus Agreement. Examples of these types of fees, costs, taxes and expenses, include:  

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

legal, accounting and other fees and expenses associated with being a public company;  
expenses related to our financings, mergers, acquisitions or dispositions of assets, and other similar 
transactions;  
expenses related to insurance coverage for our assets or operations;  
sales, use, excise, value added or similar taxes with respect to the services provided by CST to us; and  
remediation costs or expenses incurred in connection with our environmental liabilities and third-party claims 
that are based on environmental conditions that arise at our sites following the closing of our initial public 
offering; and  
costs or expenses incurred in connection with environmental compliance, including but not limited to, storage 
tank compliance and registration, as well as monitoring and oversight expenses.  

The Partnership incurred $2.5 million in management fees under the Amended Omnibus Agreement for the period October 1, 2014 
through December 31, 2014.  

Rights of First Refusal. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, that for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, if 
(a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates have the opportunity to acquire assets used, or a controlling interest in 
any business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, and (b) the assets or 
businesses proposed to be acquired have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate, then Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their 
controlled affiliates will offer such acquisition opportunity to the Partnership and give the Partnership a reasonable opportunity to 
acquire, at the same price plus any related transaction costs and expenses, such assets or business, either before or promptly after the 
consummation of such acquisition by Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates. The decision to acquire or not acquire any 
such assets or businesses requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. Any assets 
or businesses that the Partnership does not acquire pursuant to the right of first refusal may be acquired and operated by Mr. Topper, 
DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates.  

Rights of First Offer. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, to notify the 
Partnership of their desire to sell any of their assets or businesses if (a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates, 
decides to attempt to sell (other than to another controlled affiliate of Mr. Topper, DMI or LGO) any assets used, or any interest in any 
business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, to a third party and 
(b) the assets or businesses proposed to be sold have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate. Prior to selling such assets or 
businesses to a third party, Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO are required to negotiate with the Partnership exclusively and in good faith for 
a reasonable period of time in order to give the Partnership an opportunity to enter into definitive documentation for the purchase and 
sale of such assets or businesses on terms that are mutually acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and the 
Partnership. If the Partnership and Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates have not entered into a letter of intent or a 
definitive purchase and sale agreement with respect to such assets or businesses within such period, Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, and their 
controlled affiliates, have the right to sell such assets or businesses to a third party following the expiration of such period on any 
terms that are acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and such third party. The decision to acquire or not 
to acquire assets or businesses pursuant to this right requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the 
General Partner.  

97 

 
 
  
Review of Management Fee. At the end of each calendar year, we have the right to submit to CST a proposal to reduce the amount of 
the management fee for such year if we believe that the services performed by CST do not justify payment of the amount of 
management fees paid by us for such year. In addition, CST has the right, at the end of each calendar year, to submit to us a proposal 
to increase the amount of the management fee for such year if CST believes that the services performed by CST justify an increase in 
the management fee. If any such proposal is submitted, we will negotiate with CST to determine if the management fee for such year 
should be reduced or increased, and, if so, the amount of such reduction or increase. In addition, upon a material change in our 
structure or our business, the conflicts committee of our General Partner will review the management fee. If the conflicts committee 
determines that, based on a change in our structure or our business, the management fee should be modified or otherwise altered, we 
will negotiate with CST to determine the appropriate modification or alteration of the management fee.  

General Indemnification; Limitation of Liability. Pursuant to the Amended Omnibus Agreement, we are required to indemnify CST 
for any liabilities incurred by CST attributable to the management, administrative and operating services provided to us under the 
agreement, other than liabilities resulting from CST’s bad faith, fraud, or willful misconduct. In addition, CST is required to indemnify 
us for any liabilities we incur as a result of CST’s bad faith, fraud, or willful misconduct in providing management, administrative and 
operating services under the Amended Omnibus Agreement. Other than indemnification claims based on CST’s bad faith, fraud, or 
willful misconduct, CST’s liability to us for services provided under the Amended Omnibus Agreement cannot exceed $5,000,000 in 
the aggregate.  

Fuel Distribution and Lease Agreement  
We entered into a fuel distribution agreement and a lease agreement with CST that covers sites owned by the Partnership and operated 
by CST. For 2014, these agreements mandate the terms related to the sites acquired in the Nice N Easy acquisition that CST has 
operated since November 1, 2014. The fuel distribution and lease agreements have initial 10-year terms with 5-year renewal terms 
until the agreements are terminated as permitted in the agreements. The fuel distribution agreement provides the Partnership with a 
fixed mark-up per gallon ($0.06 in the case of the Nice N Easy sites) and the lease agreement is a triple net lease.  

Revenues from fuel sales, cost of revenues from fuel sales and rent income amounted to $13.2 million, $12.8 million and $0.4 million 
in 2014, respectively. Amounts receivable from CST totaled $3.2 million at December 31, 2014, which included $2.2 million for fuel 
sales and $1.0 million as reimbursement for certain transaction costs associated with the sale of the General Partner.  

Drop Down of Fuel Supply Interests  
Pursuant to a Contribution Agreement (the “Contribution Agreement”), dated December 16, 2014, by and among the Partnership, CST 
and CST Services, on January 2, 2015, we completed the acquisition, effective January 1, 2015, of a 5% limited partner interest in 
CST Fuel Supply LP (“CST Fuel”) from CST Services in exchange for 1,497,946 newly issued common units representing limited 
partner interests in the Partnership.  

CST Fuel owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in CST Marketing and Supply LLC (“CSTMS”), which is a 
party to a fuel supply agreement with a subsidiary of Valero Energy Corporation. The general partner of CST Fuel is CST USA, Inc., 
a wholly owned subsidiary of CST. CST will continue to indirectly own a 95% limited partner interest in CST Fuel.  

Immediately prior to closing and effective January 1, 2015, CST Services, CSTMS and certain subsidiaries of CST Services 
(“Purchasers”) entered into a fuel distribution agreement (the “Fuel Distribution Agreement”), pursuant to which CSTMS, on an 
annual basis, sells and delivers to the Purchasers, and the Purchasers purchase, for at least 10 years no less than 1.57 billion gallons of 
branded and unbranded motor fuels at a fixed net margin of $0.05 per gallon for resale at retail sites operated by such Purchasers.  

The terms of the Contribution Agreement and Fuel Distribution Agreement were approved by the independent conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner. The conflicts committee retained independent legal and financial advisors to assist in 
evaluating and negotiating the transaction. In approving the transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an 
opinion from its independent financial advisor that the consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common 
unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of view.  

98 

 
 
  
Agreements with DMI and its Affiliates and LGO  
On October 30, 2012, in connection with the closing of our IPO, we entered into certain agreements with DMI, its affiliates and LGO 
as described in more detail below.  

Original Omnibus Agreement  
On October 30, 2012, in connection with the closing of our initial public offering, we and our General Partner entered into an omnibus 
agreement with DMI, LGO, and for limited purposes, Mr. Topper (the “Original Omnibus Agreement”). The Original Omnibus 
Agreement provided for management services previously provided by DMI on substantially the same terms and conditions as are 
applicable to CST under the Amended Omnibus Agreement.  

Environmental Indemnification by DMI. Pursuant to the Original Omnibus Agreement, DMI is required to indemnify us for any costs 
or expenses that we incur for environmental liabilities and third-party claims, regardless of when a claim is made, that are based on 
environmental conditions in existence at our predecessor’s sites prior to the closing of our initial public offering. DMI is the 
beneficiary of escrow accounts created to cover the cost to remediate certain environmental conditions. In addition, DMI maintains 
insurance policies to cover environmental liabilities and/or, where available, participates in state programs that may also assist in 
funding the costs of environmental investigation and remediation.  

Under the Original Omnibus Agreement, DMI is required to name us as an additional insured under its environmental insurance 
policies, except for certain remediation cost containment policies. As an additional insured under these insurance policies, we have the 
right to directly seek coverage from the insurance companies for claims under these policies. To the extent DMI or its successors fail 
to do so, we have the right under the Original Omnibus Agreement to compel DMI or its successors to access the escrow accounts 
and/or its remediation cost containment policies for purposes of covering the costs to satisfy its indemnification obligations under the 
Original Omnibus Agreement.  

Environmental Indemnification of DMI. Other than with respect to liabilities resulting from DMI’s bad faith or willful misconduct, we 
are required to indemnify DMI for any costs or expenses it incurs in connection with environmental liabilities and third-party claims 
that are based on environmental conditions that arise at our sites following the closing of our initial public offering. We maintain 
insurance policies with insurers in amounts and with coverage and deductibles as our General Partner believes are reasonable and 
prudent to cover environmental liabilities and third-party claims that are based on environmental conditions that arise at our sites 
following the closing of our initial public offering. However, we cannot assure you that this insurance is adequate to protect us from 
all material expenses related to potential environmental liabilities or that these levels of insurance are available in the future at 
economical prices. Under the Original Omnibus Agreement, we are required, where permitted under our insurance policies, to name 
DMI as an additional insured under these policies.  

Tax Indemnification by DMI. Pursuant to the Original Omnibus Agreement, DMI is required to indemnify us for any costs or expenses 
that we incur for federal, state and local income tax liabilities attributable to the ownership and operation prior to the closing of our 
initial public offering of the assets and subsidiaries that were contributed to us in connection with our initial public offering, excluding 
any federal, state and local income taxes reserved for in our financial statements in connection therewith. This indemnification 
obligation survives until the 60th day following the expiration of the applicable statute of limitations.  

Title Indemnification by DMI. Pursuant to the Original Omnibus Agreement, DMI is required to indemnify us for any costs or 
expenses that we incur for losses resulting from defects in title to the assets contributed or sold to us in connection with the 
transactions entered into in connection with our initial public offering and any failure to obtain, prior to the time they were contributed 
to us, certain consents and permits necessary to conduct our business.  

99 

 
 
  
Sale of Wholesale Fuel Supply Contracts and Assignment of Leases to DMI  
The Partnership, DMI and LGO consummated a series of transactions pursuant to which DMI acquired, for an aggregate purchase 
price of $5.7 million and an earn-out in the amount of $0.8 million if DMI renews a certain customer contract, the wholesale fuel 
supply rights for 78 locations in Pennsylvania and New York previously supplied by the Partnership and the fuel supply rights of the 
Partnership to such sites was terminated. In addition, subleases for 12 of the sites, previously leased to the Partnership, were assigned 
to DMI or its affiliates. The terms of the transaction were approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the 
General Partner, which was comprised solely of independent directors. The volume associated with these sites for 2013 was 
approximately 94 million gallons, of which approximately 36 million gallons represents sales to a sub-wholesaler at a de minimus 
margin and approximately 28 million gallons relates to a contract with a single customer for which the contract expires in 2015. In 
addition, rent expense for the leasehold sites included in the transaction exceeded the rent income on an annual basis by approximately 
$0.6 million for 2013.  

Because this was a transaction between entities under common control, the Partnership derecognized the assets and liabilities 
associated with the wholesale fuel supply contracts and leases and recognized the approximate $2.3 million excess of the purchase 
price over the net book value of the net assets divested as a contribution to partners’ capital on October 1, 2014.  

Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement with LGO  
In connection with the IPO, the Partnership and LGO entered into a PMPA Franchise Agreement pursuant to which the Partnership is 
the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to all sites operated by LGO for a period of 15 years. We have the right to impose the brand of 
fuel that is distributed to LGO. There are no minimum volume requirements that LGO is required to satisfy. We charged LGO the 
“dealer tank wagon” prices for each grade of product in effect at the time title to the product passes to LGO. The conflicts committee 
of our General Partner shall, no less than annually, review the DTW prices charged to LGO to ensure that the prices are not below 
reasonable market rates charged to similarly situated or otherwise comparable third-party sites over a representative period of time. 
We have a right of first refusal in connection with any proposed transfer by LGO of its interest in the wholesale supply agreement. 
The wholesale supply agreement contains cross-default provisions with each lease agreement with LGO.  

We entered into an Amendment to the PMPA Franchise Agreement, effective as of October 1, 2014, by and between LGW, a 
subsidiary of the Partnership, and LGO (the “Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment”) pursuant to which the pricing terms 
were amended. Prior to the Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment, the agreement provided that we charge LGO dealer tank 
wagon pricing, which provided for a variable cent-per-gallon margin for each grade of product in effect at the time title to the product 
passed to LGO. The Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement Amendment amends the pricing terms of the agreement to provide for rack 
plus pricing and was approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Revenues from fuel sales to LGO amounted to $676.2 million in 2014.  

Lease Agreement with LGO  
We have entered into lease agreements with LGO pursuant to which LGO, as applicable, leases or subleases from us sites in order to 
operate the retail operations at our sites. The terms of the each lease agreements are typically 15 years and LGO has the right under the 
lease agreements to extend each lease for two additional five-year terms. The leases with LGO are typically modified triple-net leases 
under which LGO is responsible for all expenses that arise from the use of the site, including, but not limited to, taxes, insurance, 
maintenance and repair costs, other than expenses related to the maintenance, repair and replacement of the underground storage 
tanks. We typically have the right to terminate leases with LGO upon providing LGO with 180 days prior written notice and 
reimbursing LGO for all unamortized capital expenses incurred by LGO in connection with the leased site. The leases typically 
contain cross-default provisions with the wholesale supply agreement and each other lease agreement with LGO. The rent under these 
leases, and any additional leases, may be less favorable to us than the terms that we could have obtained from unaffiliated third 
parties. In addition, for a site we sub-lease to LGO, the rent we receive from LGO may not be sufficient to cover our annual lease 
obligations for this site.  

100 

 
 
  
On May 28, 2014, we entered into a Master Lease Agreement (the “Lease”) with LGO, with an effective date of June 1, 2014 which 
consolidated all of the individual leases then in effect into a single master lease. The terms and conditions of the Lease are 
substantially identical to the existing individual leases except as follows: our right to terminate each lease was deleted, and in its place, 
each party has the right to either sever, in the case of LGO, up to 7.0% of the leased premises each year, or recapture, in the case of the 
Partnership, up to 5.0% of the leased premises each year from the Lease at any time prior to the fifth anniversary of the 
commencement date (as defined) for such leased premises. Each party’s right is cumulative in that if a party does not sever or 
recapture, as applicable, the full amount of leased premises for which it has rights, then the non-utilized amount may be carried 
forward into subsequent years. The Lease was approved by the former conflicts committee of the General Partner of the Partnership.  

Rent income from LGO amounted to $20.4 million for 2014.  

Lease and Supply Agreements with other Related Parties  
The Partnership sells motor fuel and leases property to a related party owned by a relative of the Chief Executive Officer and President 
of the General Partner. Total revenues amounted to $75.8 million for 2014. Accounts receivable amounted to $0.4 million at 
December 31, 2014.  

The Partnership and the Predecessor Entity lease certain motor fuel stations from related parties under cancelable operating leases. 
Rent expense under these agreements was $1.1 million for 2014.  

Maintenance and Environmental Costs  
On December 31, 2012, Mr. Topper purchased Synergy Environmental Inc. (“Synergy”). Prior to the purchase, Synergy served as the 
Predecessor Entity’s independent environmental consultants. Synergy continues to provide environmental consulting as well as certain 
maintenance services to the Partnership. The purchase of Synergy was approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors 
of the General Partner. The Partnership incurred $1.1 million of costs with Synergy in 2014. Future annual costs for the Partnership 
will be dependent on the nature and extent of the maintenance and environmental consulting services performed (for example, our 
future acquisition activity).  

Aircraft Usage  
The Partnership uses aircraft owned by a group of individuals that includes the CEO and another member of the board of directors of 
the General Partner, as approved by the disinterested members of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General 
Partner. The Partnership incurred $0.3 million for the use of these aircraft in 2014.  

Review, Approval and Ratification of Related Person Transactions  
The board of directors of our General Partner has adopted a Code of Ethics that provides that the board of directors of our General 
Partner or its authorized committee will periodically review all related person transactions that are required to be disclosed under SEC 
rules and, when appropriate, initially authorize or ratify all such transactions. In the event that the board of directors of our General 
Partner or its authorized committee considers ratification of a related person transaction and determines not to so ratify, the Code of 
Ethics provides that our management will make all reasonable efforts to cancel or annul the transaction.  

The Code of Ethics provides that, in determining whether or not to recommend the initial approval or ratification of a related person 
transaction, the board of directors of our General Partner or its authorized committee should consider all of the relevant facts and 
circumstances available, including (if applicable) but not limited to: (i) whether there is an appropriate business justification for the 
transaction; (ii) the benefits that accrue to us as a result of the transaction; (iii) the terms available to unrelated third parties entering 
into similar transactions; (iv) the impact of the transaction on a director’s independence (in the event the related person is a director, 
an immediate family member of a director or an entity in which a director or an immediately family member of a director is a partner, 
shareholder, member or executive officer); (v) the availability of other sources for comparable products or services; (vi) whether it is a 
single transaction or a series of ongoing, related transactions; and (vii) whether entering into the transaction would be consistent with 
the Code of Ethics.  

Director Independence  
For a discussion of the independence of the board of directors of our General Partner, please see “Item 10. Directors, Executive 
Officers and Corporate Governance—Management.”  

101 

 
 
  
ITEM 14. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES  
The audit committee of the board of directors of our General Partner selected Grant Thornton LLP, or Grant Thornton, an independent 
registered public accounting firm, to audit our consolidated financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2014. The audit 
committee’s charter requires the audit committee to approve in advance all audit and non-audit services to be provided by our 
independent registered public accounting firm. All services reported in the audit, audit-related, tax and all other fees categories below 
with respect to this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approved by the audit committee.  

The following table summarizes the aggregate Grant Thornton fees that were allocated to us for independent auditing, tax and related 
services for each of the last two fiscal years (in thousands):  

Audit fees (1) 
Audit-related fees (2) 
Tax fees (3) 
All other fees (4)  
Total 

2014  
$1,346.5  
  —    
  —    
  —    
$1,346.5  

2013  
$ 910.6  
  —    
  —    
  —    
$ 910.6  

(1)  Audit fees represent amounts billed for each of the years presented for professional services rendered in connection with those 
services normally provided in connection with statutory and regulatory filings or engagements including comfort letters, 
consents and other services related to SEC matters. In 2014 and 2013, Grant Thornton provided services related to our equity 
offerings. In 2013, Grant Thornton also provided services related to our S-3 shelf registration statement.  

(2)  Audit-related fees represent amounts billed in each of the years presented for assurance and related services that are reasonably 

related to the performance of the annual audit or quarterly reviews.  

(3)  Tax fees represent amounts billed in each of the years presented for professional services rendered in connection with tax 

compliance, tax advice and tax planning.  

(4)  All other fees represent amounts billed in each of the years presented for services not classifiable under the other categories 

listed in the table above. No such services were rendered by Grant Thornton during 2013.  

Audit Committee Approval of Audit and Non-audit Services  
The audit committee of the board of directors of our General Partner has adopted a pre-approval policy with respect to services which 
may be performed by Grant Thornton. This policy lists specific audit-related services as well as any other services that Grant Thornton 
is authorized to perform and sets out specific dollar limits for each specific service, which may not be exceeded without additional 
audit committee authorization. The audit committee reviews the policy at least annually in order to approve services and limits for the 
current year. Any service that is not clearly enumerated in the policy must receive specific pre-approval by the audit committee prior 
to engagement.  

Part IV  

ITEM 15. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES  
Documents filed as part of the Report:  
(1)  Financial Statements:  

See Index to Financial Statements and Supplementary Data in Item 8 of this Report.  

(2)  Financial Statement Schedules:  

The following Financial Statement Schedules are included herein:  

Schedule II—Valuation and Qualifying Accounts  
All other schedules are not submitted because they are not applicable or not required or because the required 
information is included in the financial statements or the notes thereto.  
The financial statements included in this annual report are listed under “Item 8. Financial Statements and 
Supplementary Data.” All exhibits filed with this annual report are listed in (3) below.  

102 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
(3)  Exhibits:  

The exhibit index attached hereto is incorporated herein by reference.  

103 

 
 
  
  
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report 
to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.  

SIGNATURES  

February 27, 2015 

CROSSAMERICA PARTNERS LP 

By: 

CROSSAMERICA GP LLC, its General Partner 

/S/ JOSEPH V. TOPPER, JR. 

By: 
Name:  Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
Title:  Chief Executive Officer and President 

(On behalf of the registrant, and in the capacity of  
principal executive officer) 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on 
behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on February 27, 2015.  

Signature 

Title 

/S/ KIMBERLY S. LUBEL 
Kimberly S. Lubel 

/S/ JOSEPH V. TOPPER, JR. 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 

/S/ MARK L. MILLER 
Mark L. Miller 

/S/ DAVID A. SHEAFFER 
David A. Sheaffer 

/S/ GENE EDWARDS 
Gene Edwards 

/S/ JUSTIN A. GANNON 
Justin A. Gannon 

/S/ CLAYTON E. KILLINGER 
Clayton E. Killinger 

/S/ STEPHAN F. MOTZ 
Stephan F. Motz 

/S/ JOHN B. REILLY, III 
John B. Reilly, III 

Chairman of the Board of Directors 

Chief Executive Officer and President 
(Principal Executive Officer) 

Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer) 

Chief Accounting Officer 
(Principal Accounting Officer) 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

Director 

104 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS  

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm  

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2014 and 2013   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for CrossAmerica Partners LP for the Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 and 
the Period from October 31, 2012 to December 31, 2012, and Combined Statement of Operations for Lehigh Gas Entities 
(Predecessor) for the Period from January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012 

Consolidated Statements of Partners’ Capital and Comprehensive Income for CrossAmerica Partners LP for the Years Ended 

December 31, 2014 and 2013 and for the Period from October 31, 2012 to December 31, 2012   

Combined Statement of Owners’ Deficit and Comprehensive Loss for Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor) for the Period from 

January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for CrossAmerica Partners LP for the Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 
and the Period from October 31, 2012 to December 31, 2012, and Combined Statement of Cash Flows for Lehigh Gas 
Entities (Predecessor) for the Period from January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012 

Notes to Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements 

Financial Statement Schedule—Schedule II   

F-2  

F-4  

F-5  

F-6  

F-7  

F-8  

F-9  

  F-56  

F-1 

 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

Grant Thornton LLP 
2001 Market Street 
Two Commerce Square, 7th Floor 
Philadelphia, PA 19103 

T 215.561.4200 
F 215.561.1066 
www.GrantThornton.com 

Board of Directors  
General Partner and Limited Partners of Cross America Partners LP  

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Cross America Partners LP (a Delaware Limited Partnership) 
(formerly Lehigh Gas Partners LP) and subsidiaries (the “Partnership”) as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the related 
consolidated statements of operations, changes in partners’ capital and comprehensive income, cash flows for the years ended 
December 31, 2014 and 2013 and the period October 31, 2012 to December 31, 2012. We have also audited the accompanying 
combined statements of operations, owner’s deficit, and cash flows for Lehigh Gas Entities and affiliated entities under common 
control (collectively “Predecessor Entity”) for the period from January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012. Our audits of the basic 
consolidated and combined financial statements include the financial statement schedule listed in the index appearing under Item 15. 
These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Partnership’s and Predecessor Entity’s 
management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our 
audits.  

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those 
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of 
material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial 
statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as 
evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.  

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of 
Cross America Partners LP and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows 
for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 and the period from October 31, 2012 to December 31, 2012 in conformity with 
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. In addition, the combined financial statements referred to 
above present fairly, in all material respects, the results of the operations and cash flows for Lehigh Gas Entities and affiliated entities 
under common control for the period from January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012, in conformity with accounting principles generally 
accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to 
the basic consolidated and combined financials statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set 
forth therein.  

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the 
Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal 
Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and 
our report dated February 27, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion.  

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP  

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania  
February 27, 2015  

Grant Thornton LLP  
U.S. member firm of Grant Thornton International Ltd  

F-2 

 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM 

Board of Directors 
General Partner and Limited Partners of Lehigh Gas Partners LP 

Grant Thornton LLP 
2001 Market Street 
Two Commerce Square, 7th Floor 
Philadelphia, PA 19103 

T 215.561.4200 
F 215.561.1066 
www.GrantThornton.com 

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Lehigh Gas Partners LP (a Delaware corporation) (formerly Lehigh 
Gas Partners LP) and subsidiaries (the “Partnership”) as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal 
Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The 
Partnership’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of 
the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control 
Over Financial Reporting (“Management’s Report”). Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control 
over financial reporting based on our audit. Our audit of, and opinion on, the Partnership’s internal control over financial reporting 
does not include the internal control over financial reporting of Petroleum Marketers, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary, whose 
financial statements reflect total revenues and assets constituting 23.2% and 11.4% of the related consolidated financial statement 
amounts as of, and for the year ended, December 31, 2014, respectively. As indicated in Management’s report, Petroleum Marketers, 
Inc. was acquired during 2014. Management’s assertion on the effectiveness of the Partnership’s internal control over financial 
reporting excluded internal control over financial reporting of Petroleum Marketers, Inc.  

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those 
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over 
financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over 
financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of 
internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. 
We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.  

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of 
financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting 
principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the 
maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the 
company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in 
accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in 
accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding 
prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect 
on the financial statements.  

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections 
of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in 
conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.  

In our opinion, the Partnership maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 
December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by COSO.  

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the 
consolidated financial statements of the Partnership as of and for the year ended December 31, 2014, and our report dated 
February 27, 2015 expressed as an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.  

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP  

Philadelphia, Pennsylvania  
February 27, 2015  

Grant Thornton LLP  
U.S. member firm of Grant Thornton International Ltd  

F-3 

 
 
 
  
 
 
  
  
  
CrossAmerica Partners LP  
Consolidated Balance Sheets  
(Amounts in thousands, except unit data)  

Assets 
Current assets: 

Cash and cash equivalents 
Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $754 and $136 at  

$ 

15,170  

$ 

4,115  

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively 

Accounts receivable from related parties 
Inventory 
Environmental indemnification asset – current portion 
Assets held for sale   
Other current assets   

Total current assets 

Property and equipment, net 
Intangible assets, net 
Environmental indemnification asset – noncurrent portion 
Deferred financing fees, net 
Goodwill 
Other assets 
Total assets 
Liabilities and equity 
Current liabilities: 

Long-term debt – current portion 
Lease financing obligations – current portion 
Accounts payable 
Motor fuel taxes payable 
Environmental liability – current portion 
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 

Total current liabilities   

Long-term debt 
Lease financing obligations 
Environmental liabilities 
Deferred tax liabilities 
Other liabilities 
Total liabilities 
Commitments and contingencies (Note 14) 
Equity: 
Limited Partners’ Interest 

Common units—public (14,812,704 and 10,472,348 units issued and outstanding at 

December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively)   

Common units—affiliates (625,000 units issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014 and 

2013) 

Subordinated units—affiliates (7,525,000 units issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014 

and 2013) 
General Partner’s Interest   
Total partners’ capital 
Noncontrolling interests 
Total equity 
Total liabilities and equity  

23,435  
14,897  
12,069  
372  
2,584  
7,597  
76,124  
391,499  
77,780  
702  
6,881  
40,328  
11,332  
$  604,646  

$ 

26,303  
2,780  
33,575  
10,042  
372  
20,961  
94,033  
201,276  
60,008  
702  
23,692  
34,444  
414,155  

7,342  
16,558  
2,141  
477  
1,328  
3,535  
35,496  
288,729  
47,005  
761  
5,743  
9,324  
4,563  
$  391,621  

$ 

51  
2,568  
20,567  
7,186  
477  
8,008  
38,857  
173,509  
64,364  
761  
4,957  
14,502  
296,950  

326,139  

211,544  

(44,322) 

(42,885) 

(91,295) 
—    
190,522  
(31) 
190,491  
$  604,646  

(73,988) 
—    
94,671  
—    
94,671  
$  391,621  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements.  

F-4 

 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
CrossAmerica Partners LP and Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor)  
Consolidated and Combined Statements of Operations  
(Amounts in thousands, except unit and per unit data)  

Revenues: 

Revenues from fuel sales 
Revenues from fuel sales to related parties 
Revenues from food and merchandise sales 
Rent income 
Rent income from related parties 
Other revenues 

Total revenues  

Costs and Expenses: 

Cost of revenues from fuel sales 
Cost of revenues from fuel sales to related parties 
Cost of revenues from food and merchandise sales 
Rent expense 
Operating expenses   
Depreciation and amortization 
Selling, general and administrative expenses 
Gains on sales of assets, net 

Operating income  
Interest expense   
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
Other income, net  

Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes  
Income tax expense (benefit) from continuing operations 

Income (loss) from continuing operations after income taxes 
Income from discontinued operations 

Net income (loss)  
Net loss attributable to noncontrolling interests 

Net income (loss) attributable to partners 

Incentive distribution right holders’ interest in net income 
Limited partners’ interest in net income (loss) 
Net income (loss) per common and subordinated unit-basic 
Net income (loss) per common and subordinated unit-diluted 
Weighted average limited partners’ units outstanding 

Common units—basic 
Common units—diluted 
Subordinated units—basic and diluted  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Year Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Year Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

$  1,788,963   $  877,685   $  143,695  
162,792  
  1,015,121  
—    
—    
1,950  
15,518  
3,228  
26,059  
109  
1,676  

764,509  
71,307  
21,764  
21,494  
1,280  

   $  846,735  
709,645  
—    
10,075  
5,969  
1,078  

  2,669,317  

  1,936,059  

311,774  

  1,573,502  

  1,749,682  
735,202  
53,709  
19,051  
31,386  
32,981  
40,319  
(1,653) 

858,996  
989,326  
—    
15,509  
4,577  
20,963  
16,558  
(47) 

8,640  
(16,631) 
—    
466  

(7,525) 
(1,354) 

(6,171) 
—    

(6,171) 
(9) 

30,177  
(14,182) 
—    
359  

16,354  
(1,716) 

18,070  
—    

18,070  
—    

139,226  
157,325  
—    
2,045  
541  
2,551  
9,676  
(471)    

310,893  

881  
(1,926)    
—    
31  
(1,014)    
342  
(1,356)    
—    
(1,356)    
—    

825,724  
697,868  
—    
9,563  
4,734  
13,773  
9,811  
(3,119) 

  1,558,354  

15,148  
(11,369) 
(571) 
(403) 

2,805  
—    

2,805  
309  

3,114  
—    

3,114  

n/a  

$ 

$ 
$ 
$ 
$ 

(6,162)  $ 

18,070   $ 

245   $ 
(6,407)  $ 
(0.32)  $ 
(0.32)  $ 

—     $ 
18,070   $ 
1.18   $ 
1.18   $ 

(1,356)     $ 

—    
(1,356)       
(0.09)       
(0.09)       

  12,402,938  
  12,402,938  
  7,525,000  

  7,731,471  
  7,780,357  
  7,525,000  

  7,525,000  
  7,525,000  
  7,525,000  

Total costs and operating expenses 

  2,660,677  

  1,905,882  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements.  

F-5 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
     
 
     
 
     
     
CrossAmerica Partners LP  
Consolidated Statements of Partners’ Capital and Comprehensive Income  
(Amounts in thousands, except unit data)  
Limited Partners’ Interest  
Common 
Unitholders – 
Affiliates  

Common 
Unitholders – 
Public  

Subordinated 
Units – Affiliates  

Units  

Dollars  

Units  

Dollars  

Units  

Dollars  

General 
Partner’s 
Interest  
Dollars  

Incentive 
Distribution 
Rights  
Dollars  

Noncontrolling 
Interest  
Dollars  

Equity  
Dollars  

Initial capitalization upon formation of Partnership

Contribution of certain assets, liabilities and equity 

interests from Predecessor 

Proceeds from initial public offering and 

overallotment exercise, net of issuance costs 

Net income and comprehensive income 
Distributions paid  
Balance at December 31, 2013 
Equity-based director compensation 
Issuance of units to affiliate for equity-based 

compensation   

Payment to affiliate for Commission Sites (Note 1) 
Proceeds of equity offering and overallotment 

exercise, net of issuance costs 

Net income (loss) and comprehensive income (loss) 
Distributions paid  
Balance at December 31, 2013 
Equity-based director compensation 
Vesting of incentive awards, net of units withheld 

for taxes 

Proceeds of equity offering and overallotment 

exercise, net of issuance costs 

Sale of wholesale fuel supply contracts and 

assignment of leases to DMI 

Net income (loss) and comprehensive income (loss) 
Distributions paid  
Balance at December 31, 2014 

—     $  —    

  —     $ 

1  

—     $  —    

$  —     $  —     $ 

—    

$ 

1  

—    

  —     625,000  

(5,604)  7,525,000  

  (67,471) 

  —    

—    

—    

  (73,075) 

  125,715  
(622) 
  —    

  6,900,000  
—    
—    

  —    
(678) 
  —    
  6,900,000   $125,093   625,000   $(42,399)  7,525,000   $(68,149) 
  —    

  —    
(56) 
  (36,740) 

  —    
  —    
  —    

—    
—    
—    

  —    

  —    

1,044  

—    

21  

  —    
  —    
  —    
$  —     $  —     $ 
  —    

—    
—    
—    

—    

6,304  
—    

171  
(1,608) 

  —    
  —    

  —    
(146) 

—    
—    

  —    
(1,754) 

  —    
  —    

—    
—    

  91,370  
8,417  
  (11,920) 

  3,565,000  
—    
—    

  —    
8,913  
  (12,998) 
10,472,348   $211,544   625,000   $(42,885)  7,525,000   $(73,988) 
  —    

  —    
740  
(1,080) 

  —    
  —    
  —    

—    
—    
—    

  —    

  —    

6,217  

182  

—    

  —    
  —    
  —    
$  —     $  —     $ 
  —    

—    
—    
—    

—    

194,139  

5,918  

  —    

  —    

—    

  —    

  —    

  4,140,000  

  135,032  

  —    

  —    

—    

  —    

  —    

—    

—    

—    
—    
—    

764  
(2,419) 
  (15,652) 
14,812,704   $326,139   625,000   $(44,322)  7,525,000   $(91,295) 

1,494  
(3,787) 
  (24,244) 

  —    
  —    
  —    

64  
(201) 
(1,300) 

—    
—    
—    

  —    
  —    
  —    
$  —     $  —     $ 

—    
245  
(245) 

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—    
—    

—    
—    
—    
—    
—    

—    

  125,715  
(1,356) 
  (36,740) 
$  14,545  
21  

171  
(3,508) 

  91,370  
  18,070  
  (25,998) 
$  94,671  
182  

5,918  

—    

  135,032  

2,322  
—    
(6,171) 
(9) 
  (41,463) 
(22) 
(31)  $190,491  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements.  

F-6 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor)  
Combined Statements of Owners’ Deficit and Comprehensive Income  
(Amounts in thousands)  

Balance, December 31, 2011 
Net income and comprehensive income 
Contributions from owners 
Distributions to owners 

Balance, October 30, 2012  

Owner’s 
Deficit  
$ (32,687) 
3,114  
3,746  
(7,670) 

$ (33,497) 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements.  

F-7 

 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
CrossAmerica Partners LP and Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor)  
Consolidated and Combined Statements of Cash Flows  
(Amounts in thousands)  

Cash Flows From Operating Activities 

Net income (loss) 
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net 

cash provided by operating activities: 
Depreciation and amortization 
Accretion of interest on asset retirement obligations 
Amortization of debt discount 
Amortization of deferred financing fees 
Amortization of below (above) market leases, net 
Gains on change in fair value of derivative instruments   
Loss on extinguishment of debt 
Gains on sales of assets, net 
Provision for losses on doubtful accounts 
Equity-based incentive compensation expense  
Equity-based director compensation expense 
Deferred income taxes 
Settlement of capital lease obligations (Note 11) 
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions 

Net cash provided by operating activities 

Cash Flows From Investing Activities 

Proceeds from sale of property and equipment 
Proceeds from divestiture of lubricants business 
Proceeds from sale of wholesale fuel supply contracts and assignment of 

leases to DMI 

Purchase of property and equipment 
Principal payments received on notes receivable 
Cash paid in connection with acquisitions, net of cash acquired  
Net cash provided (used in) by investing activities 

Cash Flows From Financing Activities 

Proceeds (repayments) under the revolving credit facility 
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt   
Repayment of long term debt 
Repayment of lease financing obligations   
Payment of deferred financing fees 
Payment to affiliate for Commission Sites (Note 1) 
Proceeds from issuance of common units, net 
Distributions paid on common and subordinated units 
Distributions paid to noncontrolling interests 
Distributions paid to holders of incentive distribution rights 
Advances to affiliates   
Advances repaid by affiliates 
Contributions from owners 
Distributions to owners 
Redemption of mandatorily redeemable preferred equity 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities 
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents 

Cash and Cash Equivalents 
Beginning of period 
End of period 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Year Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Year Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

$ 

(6,171)  $ 

18,070   $ 

(1,356) 

   $ 

3,114  

32,981    
359    
—      
2,780    
236    
—      
—      
(1,653)   
618    
11,400    
558    
(1,762)   
(393)   
(10,422)   
28,531    

3,504    
10,001    

5,700    
(13,972)   
2,179    
(163,562)   
(156,150)   

54,070    
—      
(51)   
(2,531)   
(3,918)   
—      
135,032    
(41,196)   
(22)   
(245)   
(5,434)   
2,969    
—      
—      
—      
138,674    
11,055    

20,963    
50    
—      
2,666    
96    
—      
—      
(47)   
161    
3,141    
21    
(2,948)   
(214)   
(12,337)   
29,622    

2,210    
—      

—      
(6,959)   
64    
(42,334)   
(47,019)   

(37,442)   
—      
—      
(7,270)   
(408)   
(3,508)   
91,370    
(25,998)   
—      
—      
(1,720)   
1,720    
—      
—      
—      
16,744    
(653)   

2,551  
4  
—    
409  
(29) 
—    
—    
(471) 
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
2,141  
3,249  

3,704  
—    

—    
(260) 
10  
(75,523) 
(72,069) 

183,751  
—    
(182,911) 
(151) 
(4,076) 
—    
125,715  
(36,740) 
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
(12,000) 
73,588  
4,768  

13,823  
334  
642  
486  
(146) 
(354) 
571  
(3,356) 
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
(10,956) 
4,158  

4,012  
—    

—    
(1,729) 
690  
(500) 
2,473  

—    
15,568  
(20,673) 
(623) 
(117) 
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
—    
2,532  
3,746  
(7,670) 
—    
(7,237) 
(606) 

4,115    
15,170   $ 

$ 

4,768    
4,115   $ 

—    
4,768  

   $ 

2,082  
1,476  

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements.  

F-8 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
CrossAmerica Partners LP and Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor)  
Notes to the Consolidated and Combined Financial Statements  

1. Organization and Basis of Presentation  
The financial statements are comprised of CrossAmerica Partners LP (formerly Lehigh Gas Partners) (“the Partnership”) and its 
wholly-owned subsidiaries. The Partnership was formed in December 2011 by CrossAmerica GP LLC (formerly Lehigh 
Gas GP LLC), which is the general partner to the Partnership (the “General Partner”).  

On May 11, 2012, the Partnership filed a Registration Statement on Form S-1 with the Securities and Exchange Commission, which 
was declared effective on October 24, 2012, and on October 25, 2012, began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the 
symbol “LGP” (NYSE:LGP). On October 30, 2012, the Partnership completed its initial public offering (the “IPO”).  

References in these combined financial statements to the “Predecessor” or “Predecessor Entity” refer to the portion of the business of 
Dunne Manning Inc. (formerly Lehigh Gas Corporation) (“DMI”) and its subsidiaries and affiliates under common control that were 
contributed to the Partnership in connection with the IPO (the “Contributed Assets”). All of the Contributed Assets were recorded at 
historical cost as this transaction was considered to be a reorganization of entities under common control. The Partnership issued 
common units and subordinated units to the shareholders, or their assigns, of the Predecessor Entity in consideration of their transfer 
of the Contributed Assets to the Partnership.  

Accordingly, the accompanying consolidated and combined financial statements are presented in accordance with requirements for 
predecessor financial statements, which include the financial results of both the Partnership and the Predecessor Entity. The results of 
operations contained in the consolidated financial statements for the Partnership include the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 
and the period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012. The results of operations contained in the combined financial 
statements for the Predecessor Entity include the period from January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012. The consolidated balance 
sheet presents the financial position of the Partnership only as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.  

Prior to September 1, 2013, the Partnership’s fuel sales represented wholesale distribution to the operators of the sites, who then resold 
the fuel to the end customer on a retail basis. On September 1, 2013, the Partnership assumed certain commission agreements and 
subleases from Lehigh Gas—Ohio, LLC, a related party (“LGO”) that resulted in the Partnership recording the retail sale of motor 
fuels to the end customer. See Note 20 for additional information. Further, as a result of the April 30, 2014 acquisition of Petroleum 
Marketers Incorporated (“PMI”) discussed in Note 4, the Partnership began operating convenience stores.  

With the addition of the retail business described above, the Partnership engages in:  

•  

•  

•  

•  

the wholesale distribution of motor fuels (generally using unrelated third party transportation service providers) to sub-
wholesalers, independent dealers, lessee dealers, LGO and others;  
the retail distribution of motor fuels to end customers at Commission Sites;  
the owning or leasing of sites used in the retail distribution of motor fuels and, in turn, generating rent income from the 
lease or sublease of the sites to third parties or LGO; and  
the operation of convenience stores and branded, quick-service restaurants (see “PMI Acquisition” in Note 4).  

The audited consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Partnership and all of its subsidiaries. The Partnership’s 
primary operations are conducted by the following consolidated wholly owned subsidiaries:  

•   Lehigh Gas Wholesale LLC (“LGW”), which distributes motor fuels on a wholesale basis;  
•   LGP Realty Holdings LP (“LGPR”), which functions as the property holding company of the Partnership; and  
•   Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc. (“LGWS”), which owns and leases (or leases and sub-leases) real estate and 

personal property used in the retail distribution of motor fuels as well as provides maintenance and other services to 
lessee dealers and other customers (including LGO). LGWS also distributes motor fuels on a retail basis to end 
customers at the Commission Sites and, effective April 30, 2014, Petroleum Marketers, Inc. (“PMI”), a wholly-
owned subsidiary of LGWS, operates convenience stores and branded quick-service restaurants.  

F-9 

 
 
LGO is an operator of motor fuel stations that purchases a significant portion of its motor fuel requirements from the Partnership on a 
wholesale basis in accordance with the PMPA Franchise Agreement between LGO and LGW, and then re-sells motor fuel on a retail 
basis. LGO also leases motor fuel stations from the Partnership. The financial results of LGO are not consolidated with those of the 
Partnership. For more information regarding the Partnership’s relationship with LGO, see Note 20.  

Acquisition by CST of the General Partner Membership Interests  
On October 1, 2014, CST Brands, Inc. (“CST”) completed the sale to CST of 100% of the membership interests in the Partnership’s 
General Partner from DMI, an entity wholly owned by the Topper Trust for which Joseph V. Topper, Jr. is the trustee (“GP 
Purchase”), and all of the membership interests in limited liability companies formed by trusts for which each of Mr. Topper and John 
B. Reilly, III serves as trustee, which limited liability companies own all of the incentive distribution rights (“IDRs”). CST is one of 
the largest independent retailers of motor fuels and convenience merchandise in North America.  

The General Partner manages the operations and activities of the Partnership. The Partnership is managed and operated by the board 
of directors and executive officers of the General Partner. As a result of the acquisition of the General Partner, CST controls the 
General Partner and has the right to appoint all members of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Immediately following the GP Purchase, the Partnership changed its name from Lehigh Gas Partners LP to “CrossAmerica Partners 
LP” and began trading on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “CAPL” effective October 6, 2014.  

Mr. Topper entered into a Voting Agreement dated as of October 1, 2014, by and among Mr. Topper, the Topper Trust, DMI, an entity 
wholly owned by the Topper Trust for which Mr. Topper is the trustee (collectively, the “Topper Sellers”) and CST (the “Voting 
Agreement”) pursuant to which each of the Topper Sellers agrees that at any meeting of the holders of shares of CST common stock 
or common units or subordinated units of the Partnership it will vote or cause to be voted such Topper Seller’s shares or units, 
respectively, in accordance with the recommendation of the board of directors of CST or the board of directors of the General Partner, 
respectively. The Voting Agreement will remain in effect with respect to any Topper Seller for so long as any such Topper Seller is 
(a) a director or officer of CST or affiliate thereof, including the Partnership, (b) the beneficial owner of more than 3% of the 
outstanding common stock of CST or (c) the beneficial owner of 10% or more of the outstanding common units or subordinated units 
of the Partnership.  

On and effective as of October 1, 2014, Melinda B. German, Warren S. Kimber, Jr., John F. Malloy, Maura E. Topper and Robert L. 
Wiss, each a member of the board of directors of the General Partner, resigned in his or her capacity as such. Mr. Topper and 
Mr. Reilly remain members of the board of directors of the General Partner. CST has agreed to cause the appointment of Mr. Topper 
as a director of the General Partner for a period of at least five years commencing on October 1, 2014 or until a change in control of 
CST including circumstances in which CST no longer controls the General Partner. Further, Mr. Topper may be removed from the 
board of directors of the General Partner in certain circumstances where cause exists.  

On and effective as of October 1, 2014, CST as the owner of the General Partner appointed each of the following as members to the 
board of directors of the General Partner: Kimberly S. Lubel, Chief Executive Officer, President and Chairman of the board of 
directors of CST, Clayton E. Killinger, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of CST, and Stephan F. Motz, Senior Vice 
President and Chief Development Officer of CST, as directors of the board of directors of the General Partner, and Gene Edwards and 
Justin A. Gannon as independent directors of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Mr. Topper and CST Services LLC (“CST Services”) entered into an employment agreement dated as of October 1, 2014 (the “Topper 
Employment Agreement”), pursuant to which Mr. Topper was appointed as the Chief Executive Officer and President of the General 
Partner. The Topper Employment Agreement has a term of one year and will automatically renew for an additional one year term 
unless the parties agree otherwise or either party gives 60-day written notice prior to the end of the initial term. Mr. Topper’s base 
salary is $525,000 per year. He is eligible to receive a short-term incentive award equal to 75% of his base salary and an equity award 
equal to 200% of his base salary. Mr. Topper is entitled to participate in all employee benefit plans and programs generally available 
to similarly situated executives of the CST Services LLC (“CST Services”). CST Services may terminate Mr. Topper’s employment at 
any time for any reason.  

F-10 

 
 
  
Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, Mr. Topper agrees that, during his employment and for a period equal to the 
greater of (i) the balance of his employment term and (ii) one year following termination for cause or his resignation without good 
reason (the “Restricted Period”), (x) he will not solicit or in any way be involved with any prior, current or prospective customer, 
client, consultant, broker or business partner of, or any person who had dealings with, CST Services or the Partnership and (y) he will 
not solicit for employment any person who is or was within the preceding six months an employee or consultant of CST Services or 
the Partnership. Per the terms of the Topper Employment Agreement, during the Restricted Period, Mr. Topper also agrees that he will 
not associate in any way with any business that at any time during the Restricted Period is engaged in the business of CST Services or 
the Partnership other than those activities and businesses that Mr. Topper controls as of October 1, 2014.  

See Note 20 for additional discussion of the relationship with CST.  

2. Initial Public Offering  
On October 30, 2012, the Partnership completed its IPO of 6,000,000 common units at a price of $20.00 per unit, and on November 9, 
2012, issued an additional 900,000 common units at a price of $20.00 per unit pursuant to the full exercise by the underwriters of their 
over-allotment option. The Partnership received net proceeds of $125.7 million from the sale, net of underwriting discounts and 
structuring fees and $2.6 million of IPO expenses. Of this amount, the proceeds from the over-allotment option of approximately 
$16.7 million were distributed to Joseph V. Topper Jr., the then Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer of the 
General Partner of the Partnership, and to certain of Mr. Topper’s affiliates and family trusts, and to John B. Reilly, III, a member of 
the board of directors of the General Partner of the Partnership. The net proceeds retained by the Partnership were applied to (a) the 
repayment of approximately $57.8 million of indebtedness outstanding under the Credit Facility (see Note 10), which was drawn on 
and applied to the repayment in full of the indebtedness then outstanding under the Predecessor Entity’s prior credit facility; (b) the 
repayment in full of $14.3 million aggregate principal amount in outstanding mortgage notes; (c) the payment of $13.0 million 
(inclusive of a $1.0 million termination fee) to entities owned by adult children of Warren S. Kimber, Jr., a director of the General 
Partner, as consideration for the cancellation of mandatorily redeemable preferred equity of the Predecessor owned by these entities 
and to pay these entities for accrued but unpaid dividends on the mandatorily redeemable preferred equity of $0.5 million; (d) the 
distribution of an aggregate of $20.0 million to certain of the Topper Group Parties (as defined herein) as reimbursement for certain 
capital expenditures made by the Topper Group Parties with respect to the assets they contributed, and/or consideration for the 
purchase of all of the assets of one or more of the entities contributed to the Partnership in connection with the IPO.  

In connection with the IPO, the Partnership incurred costs of approximately $6.3 million primarily related to legal, accounting, tax and 
other related costs and fees, which are included in selling, general and administrative expenses for the period from October 31, 2012 
through December 31, 2012.  

Contribution Agreement  
In connection with the IPO, pursuant to an agreement with the Lehigh Gas Entities, the Lehigh Gas Entities contributed certain assets, 
liabilities, operations and/or equity interests (the “Contributed Assets”) to the Partnership. In consideration of the Contributed Assets, 
the Partnership issued and/or distributed to the Lehigh Gas Entities an aggregate: 625,000 common units and 7,525,000 subordinated 
units.  

F-11 

 
 
  
The following is a summary of the Contributed Assets (in thousands):  

Accounts receivable 
Other current assets 
Property and equipment, net 
Deferred financing costs, net and other assets 
Goodwill 

Total assets contributed 

Accounts payable  
Motor fuel taxes payable and other accrued expenses   
Debt (a)  
Mandatorily redeemable preferred equity (a)  
Lease financing obligations 
Other long-term liabilities   

Total liabilities contributed 

Net total liabilities contributed 

$  16,550  
7,044  
  194,194  
  10,180  
4,043  

  232,011  
  17,445  
  11,152  
  182,911  
  13,000  
  71,401  
9,177  

  305,086  

$  73,075  

(a)  Subsequently paid off with proceeds from the IPO  

3. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies  
Use of Estimates  
The preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America 
(“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and 
accompanying notes. These estimates are based on knowledge of current events, historical experience and various other assumptions 
that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ from those estimates.  

Critical estimates made in the preparation of the financial statements include, among others, determining the fair value of acquired 
assets and liabilities; assessing the collectability of accounts receivable; determining the useful lives and recoverability of property and 
equipment and amortized intangible assets; assessing the impairment of goodwill; measuring stock-based compensation expense; 
estimating asset retirement obligations; estimating environmental indemnification assets and liabilities, estimating accruals for various 
commitments and contingencies; and determining the recoverability of deferred tax assets.  

Fair Value Measurements  
Accounting guidance on fair value measurements defines and establishes a framework for measuring fair value. Management uses fair 
value measurements to measure, among other items, acquired assets and liabilities in business combinations, leases and derivative 
contracts. Management also uses them to assess impairment of sites, intangible assets and goodwill.  

Where available, fair value is based on observable market prices or parameters, or is derived from such prices or parameters. Where 
observable prices or inputs are not available, unobservable prices or inputs are used to estimate the current fair value, often using an 
internal valuation model. These valuation techniques involve some level of management estimation and judgment, the degree of which 
is dependent on the item being valued.  

Business Combinations  
The Partnership accounts for business combinations in accordance with the guidance under Accounting Standards Codification 
(“ASC”) 805, “Business Combinations.” Acquisitions of assets or entities that include inputs and processes and have the ability to 
create outputs are accounted for as business combinations. The purchase price is recorded for assets acquired and liabilities assumed 
based on fair value. The excess of the fair value of the consideration conveyed over the fair value of the net assets acquired is recorded 
as goodwill. The income statement includes the results of operations for each acquisition from their respective date of acquisition.  

F-12 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
Segment Reporting  
The Partnership presents its segment reporting in accordance with ASC 280, “Segment Reporting.” Effective September 1, 2013, the 
Partnership engages in both the wholesale and retail distribution of motor fuels, primarily gasoline and diesel fuel. Further, effective 
with the PMI acquisition, the Partnership also engages in the retail operation of convenience stores and branded quick-service 
restaurants. Given these changes, the Partnership is deemed to conduct its business in two segments: 1) the wholesale segment and 2) 
the retail segment. The class of customer and gross margins are sufficiently different between these two businesses to warrant two 
reportable segments. See Note 21 for additional information.  

Prior to September 1, 2013, the Partnership operated in one operating segment – the distribution of motor fuels, consisting of gasoline 
and diesel fuel, and to own and lease real estate used in the distribution of motor fuels, with a single management team that reports to 
the Chief Executive Officer, who is the chief operating decision maker. Accordingly, the Partnership did not prepare discrete financial 
information with respect to separate product lines or by site and did not have separately reportable segments.  

Revenue Recognition  
Revenues from wholesale fuel sales are recognized when fuel is delivered to the customer. Revenues from retail fuel sales are 
recognized when fuel is sold to the customer. Substantially all revenues from fuel sales are from sales of gasoline, with the remainder 
comprised of diesel and other products.  

Revenues from leasing arrangements in which the Partnership is the lessor are recognized ratably over the term of the underlying 
lease. Renewals are not assumed unless reasonably assured.  

Revenues from retail food and merchandise sales are recognized net of applicable provisions for discounts and allowances upon 
delivery, generally at the point of sale.  

Motor Fuel Taxes  
LGW collects motor fuel taxes, which consist of various pass through taxes collected from customers on behalf of taxing authorities, 
and remits such taxes directly to those taxing authorities. LGW’s accounting policy is to exclude the taxes collected and remitted from 
wholesale revenues and cost of sales and account for them as liabilities. LGWS’s retail sales and cost of sales include motor fuel taxes 
as the taxes are included in the cost paid for motor fuel and LGWS has no direct responsibility to collect or remit such taxes to the 
taxing authorities.  

Cost of Sales  
The Partnership includes in cost of revenues from fuel sales all costs incurred to acquire fuel, including the costs of purchasing and 
transporting inventory prior to delivery to customers. Cost of revenues from fuel sales does not include any depreciation of property 
and equipment; rather, depreciation is separately classified in the income statement. Total cost of revenues from fuel sales of suppliers 
who accounted for 10% or more of total cost of revenues from fuel sales for the periods presented are as follows:  

ExxonMobil 
BP Products 
Motiva Enterprises 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

38% 
29% 
21% 

43%   
25%   
15%   

44%      
27%      
14%      

41% 
27% 
19% 

F-13 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents  
The Partnership considers all short-term investments with maturity of three months or less at the date of purchase to be cash 
equivalents. Cash and cash equivalents are stated at cost, which, for cash equivalents, approximates fair value due to their short-term 
maturity. The Partnership is potentially subject to financial instrument concentration of credit risk through its cash and cash 
equivalents. The Partnership maintains cash and cash equivalents with several major financial institutions. The Partnership has not 
experienced any losses on their cash equivalents.  

Accounts Receivable  
Accounts receivable primarily result from the sales of motor fuels and rental fees for sites to customers. The majority of the 
Partnership’s accounts receivable relate to its motor fuel sales that can generally be described as high volume and low margin 
activities. Credit is extended to a customer based on an evaluation of the customer’s financial condition. In certain circumstances 
collateral may be required from the customer. Receivables are recorded at face value, without interest or discount.  

The provision for bad debts is generally based upon a specific analysis of aged accounts while also factoring in any new business 
conditions that might impact the historical analysis, such as market conditions and bankruptcies of particular customers. Bad debt 
provisions are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

The Partnership reviews all accounts receivable balances on at least a quarterly basis and provides an allowance for doubtful accounts 
based on historical experience and on a specific identification basis.  

Inventory  
Motor fuel inventory consists of gasoline, diesel fuel and other petroleum products and is stated at the lower of average cost or market 
using the first-in, first-out method. No provision for potentially obsolete or slow-moving inventory has been made. The Partnership 
records inventory from the time of the purchase of motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to the end customer.  

Food and merchandise inventory is valued at the lower of average cost or market using the first-in, first-out method.  

Property and Equipment  
Property and equipment is recorded at cost. Property and equipment acquired through a business combination is recorded at fair value. 
Depreciation is recognized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets, including: 10 to 20 years 
for buildings and improvements and 5 to 30 years for equipment. Amortization of leasehold improvements is based upon the shorter of 
the remaining terms of the leases including renewal periods that are reasonably assured, or the estimated useful lives, which generally 
range from 7 to 10 years.  

Expenditures for major renewals and betterments that extend the useful lives of property and equipment are capitalized. Maintenance 
and repairs are charged to operations as incurred. Gains or losses on the disposition of property and equipment are recorded in the 
period the sale meets the criteria for recognition.  

Debt Issuance Costs  
Debt issuance costs that are incurred in connection with the issuance of debt are deferred and amortized to interest expense using the 
straight line method (which approximates the effective interest method) over the contractual term of the underlying indebtedness.  

Intangibles and Other Long-Lived Assets  
Intangibles are recorded at fair value upon acquisition. Intangible assets associated with wholesale fuel supply contracts, wholesale 
fuel distribution rights and trademarks are amortized over 10 years. Covenants not to compete are amortized over the shorter of the 
contract term or 5 years. Intangible assets associated with above and below market leases are amortized over the lease term, which 
approximates 5 years.  

F-14 

 
 
  
Asset Impairment  
The Partnership reviews long-lived assets, including property and equipment and intangible assets other than goodwill, for impairment 
when events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of the long-lived asset (group) might not be recoverable in 
accordance with ASC 360, “Property Plant and Equipment.” Such events and circumstances include, among other factors: operating 
losses; market value declines; changes in the expected physical life of an asset; changes in business plans or those of major customers, 
suppliers or other business partners; changes in competition and competitive practices; uncertainties associated with the U.S. and 
world economies; changes in the expected level of capital, operating or environmental remediation expenditures; and changes in 
governmental regulations or actions. The impairment evaluation is initially based on the projected undiscounted cash flows of the 
asset (group), including residual value upon eventual disposition. If the projected undiscounted cash flows of the asset (group) are less 
than its carrying value, the impairment loss is measured by comparing the present value of the future cash flows associated with the 
asset (group) to its carrying value and is recorded at that time.  

Goodwill  
The Partnership accounts for purchased goodwill in accordance with ASC 350, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets.” Goodwill 
represents the excess of cost over fair value of net assets of businesses acquired. Goodwill acquired in a business combination is 
recorded at fair value as of the date acquired. Goodwill is not amortized, but is instead tested for impairment at least annually and 
more frequently if events and circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired.  

A qualitative assessment is permitted, whereby companies may assess all relevant events and circumstances to determine if it is “more 
likely than not” (meaning a likelihood of more than 50%) that the fair value of the reporting unit goodwill is less than the carrying 
amount. If there is a more likely than not assessment, companies would need to perform the two-step process described below.  

• 

• 

The fair value of the reporting unit is compared with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a 
reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered impaired. If the carrying 
amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, then companies must perform the second step of the goodwill 
impairment test to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any.  
The implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill is compared with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the 
carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss is 
recognized in an amount equal to that excess.  

Companies are required to perform Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test if the carrying value of the reporting unit is zero or negative 
or adverse qualitative factors indicate that it is more likely than not that a goodwill impairment exists. Goodwill of a reporting unit is 
tested for impairment between annual tests if an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair 
value of the reporting unit below its carrying amount.  

The Partnership has defined its reporting units as its reportable segments. The Partnership performed its annual impairment test of 
goodwill at December 31. The Partnership utilized qualitative factors, such as macroeconomic factors, industry and market 
considerations, cost factors, overall financial performance and other relevant entity specific events, in their qualitative assessment of 
the goodwill for their reporting units. Based on that analysis, the Partnership concluded that it was more likely than not that the fair 
value of each of its reporting units exceeds its carrying value.  

Estimates and assumptions used to perform the impairment testing are inherently uncertain and can significantly affect the outcome of 
the impairment test. Changes in operating results and other assumptions could materially affect these estimates.  

Environmental and Other Liabilities  
The Partnership accrues for all direct costs associated with the estimated resolution of contingencies at the earliest date at which it is 
deemed probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of such liability can be reasonably estimated. Costs accrued are 
estimated based upon an analysis of potential results, assuming a combination of litigation and settlement strategies and outcomes. 
Estimated losses from environmental remediation obligations generally are recognized no later than completion of the remedial 
feasibility study. Loss accruals are adjusted as further information becomes available or circumstances change. Costs of future 
expenditures for environmental remediation obligations are not discounted to their present value. Recoveries of environmental 
remediation costs from other parties are recognized as assets when their receipt is deemed probable.  

F-15 

 
 
  
The Partnership and the Predecessor Entity maintain insurance of various types with varying levels of coverage that is considered 
adequate under the circumstances to cover operations and properties. The insurance policies are subject to deductibles that are 
considered reasonable and not excessive. In addition, the Partnership has entered into indemnification and escrow agreements with 
various sellers in conjunction with certain of their acquisition transactions.  

The Partnership is subject to other contingencies, including legal proceedings and claims arising out of its businesses that cover a wide 
range of matters, including, among others, environmental matters and contract and employment claims. Environmental and other legal 
proceedings may also include matters with respect to businesses previously owned. Further, due to the lack of adequate information 
and the potential impact of present regulations and any future regulations, there are certain circumstances in which no range of 
potential exposure may be reasonably estimated.  

Leases  
The Partnership accounts for leases in accordance with ASC 840, “Leases.” The Partnership leases certain sites from third parties 
under long-term arrangements with various expiration dates. U.S. GAAP requires leases be evaluated and classified as either operating 
or capital for financial reporting purposes. The lease term used for lease evaluation includes option periods only in instances in which 
the exercise of the option period can be reasonably assured and failure to exercise such options would result in an economic penalty. 
Minimum lease payments are expensed on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease including renewal periods that are reasonably 
assured at the inception of the lease. In addition to minimum lease payments, certain leases require additional contingent payments 
based on sales volume or future inflation.  

The Partnership is the lessee in certain sale-leaseback transactions for certain sites, and as the Partnership has continuing involvement 
in the underlying sites, or the lease agreement has a repurchase feature, the sale-leaseback arrangements are accounted for as financing 
transactions.  

Asset Retirement Obligations  
Prior to the GP Purchase, we recorded asset retirement obligations related to the removal of underground storage tanks when 1) the 
site was being sold and removing the tank was a condition of the sale; or 2) the lessor could require us to remove the tanks at the end 
of the lease.  

On October 1, 2014, concurrent with the GP Purchase and in an effort to conform operating and accounting policies, we recorded a 
liability, which is referred to as an asset retirement obligation, at fair value for the estimated cost to remove underground storage tanks 
(“USTs”) used to store motor fuel at owned and leased retail sites at the time we incur that liability, which is generally when the UST 
is installed. We record a discounted liability for the fair value of an asset retirement obligation with a corresponding increase to the 
carrying value of the related long-lived asset. We depreciate the amount added to property and equipment and recognize accretion 
expense in connection with the discounted liability over the estimated remaining life of the UST. Accretion expense is reflected in 
depreciation, amortization and accretion expense. We base our estimates of the anticipated future costs for removal of a UST on our 
prior experience with removal. Removal costs include the cost to remove the USTs and may include soil remediation costs resulting 
from the spillage of small quantities of motor fuel in the normal operations of our business and other miscellaneous costs. We review 
our assumptions for computing the estimated liability for the removal of USTs on an annual basis. Any change in estimated cash flows 
is reflected as an adjustment to the liability and the associated asset.  

Equity-Based Compensation  
In connection with the IPO, the Partnership adopted the Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan under which various 
types of awards may be granted to employees, consultants and directors of the General Partner or its affiliates who provide services to 
the Partnership. Since the Partnership grants awards to employees of DMI, the grants are measured at fair value at each balance sheet 
reporting date based on the fair market value of the Partnership’s common units, and the cumulative compensation cost related to that 
portion of the awards that have vested is recognized ratably over the vesting term and classified within selling, general and 
administrative expenses. The liability for the future grant of common units is included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities 
on the balance sheet.  

If there are any modifications of the equity incentive compensation award after the date of grant, regardless of whether the vesting 
settlement is in common units or cash, the Partnership may be required to accelerate any remaining unearned equity incentive 
compensation expense or record additional equity incentive compensation expense.  

F-16 

 
 
  
Income Taxes  
The Partnership’s wholly owned taxable subsidiaries recognize deferred income tax assets and liabilities for the expected future 
income tax consequences of temporary differences between financial statement carrying amounts and the related income tax basis.  

Each of the Predecessor Entity’s respective form of legal ownership was a combination of a corporation, a limited liability company 
(LLC), or a partnership. Income taxes were generally assessed at the individual level of the respective entities’ stockholder(s) (who 
have elected to be taxed as a sub-chapter S corporation) or partners. Accordingly, the Predecessor Entity financial statements do not 
contain a provision for income taxes as no income taxes were assessed at the entity level.  

Likewise, income tax attributable to the Partnership’s earnings and losses, excluding the earnings and losses of its wholly owned 
taxable subsidiaries, are assessed at the individual level of the unitholder. Accordingly, the Partnership does not record a provision for 
income taxes other than for those earnings and losses generated or incurred by its wholly owned taxable subsidiaries.  

Tax positions not meeting the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold at the financial statement date may not be recognized or 
continue to be recognized under the accounting guidance for income taxes. Where required, the Partnership recognizes interest and 
penalties for uncertain tax positions in income taxes.  

Valuation allowances are initially recorded and reevaluated each reporting period by assessing the likelihood of the ultimate 
realization of a deferred tax asset. Management considers a number of factors in assessing the realization of a deferred tax asset, 
including the reversal of temporary differences, future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies. The 
amount of deferred tax assets ultimately realized may differ materially from the estimates utilized in the computation of valuation 
allowances and may materially impact the financial statements in the future.  

Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations  
The determination to classify an asset as held for sale requires significant estimates about the site and the expected market for the site, 
which are based on factors including recent sales of comparable sites, recent expressions of interest in the site and the condition of the 
site. Management must also determine if it will be possible under those market conditions to sell the site for an acceptable price within 
one year. When assets are identified by management as held for sale, depreciation is discontinued and the sales price, net of selling 
costs, is estimated. Management considers sites to be held for sale when they meet criteria such as whether the sale transaction has 
been approved by the appropriate level of management and there are no known material contingencies relating to the sale such that the 
sale is probable and is expected to qualify for recognition as a completed sale within one year. If, in management’s opinion, the 
expected net sales price of the asset that has been identified as held for sale is less than the net book value of the asset, the asset is 
written down to fair value less the cost to sell. Assets classified as held for sale are presented separately in the balance sheets.  

There is frequently significant continuing involvement as the Partnership may supply fuel to the site after selling the site. Such sites 
would not be considered discontinued operations prior to the adoption of new accounting guidance adopted January 1, 2014 (see 
below). Assuming no significant continuing involvement, both a site classified as held for sale and a sold site are considered a 
discontinued operation. Sites classified as discontinued operations are reclassified as such in the income statement for all periods 
presented. Cash flows from discontinued operations have not been segregated in the statements of cash flows.  

In April 2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standard Update (“ASU”) 2014-08, Reporting 
Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of an Entity, which revises the criteria to qualify as a discontinued operation 
and requires new disclosures. Under this guidance, a discontinued operation is (1) a component of an entity or group of components 
that has been disposed of or classified as held for sale that represents a strategic shift that has or will have a major effect on an entity’s 
operations and financial results or (2) an acquired business that is classified as held for sale on the date of acquisition. This guidance 
also permits companies to have continuing cash flows and significant continuing involvement with the disposed component.  

The Partnership disposes of individual sites or groups of sites from time to time that generally do not represent a strategic shift and 
generally do not have a major effect on operations or financial results. As a result of this new guidance, these disposals will generally 
not meet the criteria for recognition as a discontinued operation. The Partnership early adopted this guidance on a prospective basis 
effective January 1, 2014.  

F-17 

 
 
  
Allocation of Net Income  
Under the Partnership Agreement, our General Partner’s interest in net income from the Partnership consists of the incentive distribution rights 
(“IDRs”), which are increasing percentages as noted below:  

Total Quarterly Distribution Per Common and Subordinated Unit 
Target Amount 
above $0.5031 up to $0.5469  
above $0.5469 up to $0.6563  
above $0.6563 

Marginal Percentage Interest in 
Distribution  

Unitholders  

Holders of IDRs  

85% 
75% 
50% 

15% 
25% 
50% 

The Partnership’s undistributed net income is generally allocable pro rata to the common and subordinated unitholders, except where common unitholders 
have received cash distributions in excess of the subordinated unitholders. In that circumstance, net income is allocated to the common unitholders first in 
support of such excess cash distribution paid to them; the remainder of the net income is allocable pro rata to the common and subordinated unitholders. 
Losses are generally allocable pro rata to the common and subordinated unitholders in accordance with the Partnership Agreement.  

Earnings Per-Unit  
In addition to the common and subordinated units, the Partnership has identified the IDRs as participating securities and computes income per unit 
using the two-class method under which any excess of distributions declared over net income shall be allocated to the partners based on their 
respective sharing of income specified in the partnership agreement. Net income per unit applicable to limited partners (including common and 
subordinated unitholders) is computed by dividing the limited partners’ interest in net income, after deducting any incentive distributions, by the 
weighted-average number of outstanding common and subordinated units.  

Reclassifications  
Certain reclassifications were made to prior period amounts to conform to the current year presentation. These reclassifications had no impact on net 
income or partners’ capital for any periods.  

New Accounting Guidance  
Revenue Recognition  
In May 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, which clarifies the principles for recognizing revenue and 
develops a common revenue standard under U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards. Specifically, the core principle of the 
guidance is that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods and services to customers in an amount that reflects the 
consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods and services.  

This guidance is effective January 1, 2017, and provides for modified retrospective transition. Management is currently evaluating the impact of 
adopting this guidance.  

Consolidation  
In February 2015, the FASB issued ASU 2015-02, Consolidation (Topic 810): Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis, which is intended to 
improve targeted areas of consolidation guidance for legal entities such as limited partnerships, limited liability corporations, and securitization 
structures. The amendment simplifies the consolidation evaluation for reporting organizations that are required to evaluate whether they should 
consolidate certain legal entities. The Partnership does not expect the ASU to impact how it currently consolidates its legal entities. The amendments 
in this ASU will be effective for periods beginning after December 15, 2015, for public companies. The Partnership plans to apply the amendment to 
annual and interim periods beginning on January 1, 2016.  

Pushdown Accounting  
In November 2014, the FASB issued ASU 2014-17, Business Combinations (Topic 805): Pushdown Accounting (a consensus of the FASB Emerging 
Issues Task Force). The amendments in this ASU apply to the separate financial statements of an acquired entity and its subsidiaries upon the 
occurrence of an event in which an acquirer obtains control of the acquired entity. The amendments provide an acquired entity with an option to 
apply pushdown accounting in its separate financial statements upon occurrence of an event in which an acquirer obtains control of the acquired 
entity. An acquired entity may elect the option to apply pushdown accounting in the reporting period in which the change-in-control event occurs, or 
in a subsequent reporting period to the acquired entity’s most recent change-in-control event. The amendments in this ASU are effective on 
November 18, 2014. After the effective date, the Partnership can make an election to apply the guidance to future change-in-control events or to its 
most recent change-in-control event. CST has elected not to apply pushdown accounting at this time, but may elect to apply pushdown accounting in 
future periods.  

4. Acquisitions  
In evaluating potential acquisition candidates, the Partnership considers a number of factors, including strategic fit, desirability of location, purchase 
price and the ability to improve the productivity and profitability of a location and/or wholesale supply agreement or distribution rights through the 
implementation of improved operating strategies. The ability to create accretive financial results and/or operational efficiencies due to the relative 
operational scale and/or geographic concentration, among other strategic factors, may result in a purchase price in excess of the fair value of 
identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed, resulting in the recognition of goodwill. The Partnership strives to make acquisitions accretive to 
partners’ capital and provide a reasonable long-term return on investment. Goodwill recorded in connection with these acquisitions is primarily 
attributable to the estimated synergies and enhanced revenue opportunities.  

F-18 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
With respect to the acquisitions discussed below (other than the Express Lane acquisition), the Partnership concluded the historical 
balance sheet and operating information concerning these acquisitions would not be meaningful to investors as the Partnership 
fundamentally changed the nature of the revenue producing assets acquired from the manner in which they were used by the sellers. 
Thus, other than for the Express Lane and PMI acquisitions, the Partnership did not present pro forma revenues and net income as it 
was determined that presenting such financial information regarding such acquisitions may mislead investors.  

Acquisition costs incurred during 2014, 2013 and the period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 were $7.5 million, 
$1.2 million, and $0.8 million, respectively. Acquisition costs incurred by the Predecessor during the period January 1, 2012 through 
October 30, 2012 were $0.5 million. Such costs are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

Nice N Easy Acquisition  
CST and the Partnership entered into an agreement to purchase, effective November 1, 2014, the convenience store assets, franchisor 
rights and associated trademarks of Nice N Easy Grocery Shoppes (“Nice N Easy”). Nice N Easy operates corporate and franchise 
stores in central New York with a concentration in the Syracuse, New York region. Effective on November 1, 2014, CST assigned the 
rights to acquire the real property and underground storage tanks relating to 23 fee sites of Nice N Easy to LGWS and the fuel 
distribution agreements with respect to 25 Nice N Easy operated sites to LGW (collectively, the “Assignment”), for aggregate cash 
consideration of $65 million. The Partnership funded its portion of the acquisition with borrowings under its credit facility. CST 
purchased the working capital, convenience store operations and franchise operations.  

The conflicts committee approved the original allocation of the purchase price between CST and the Partnership and subsequently 
approved an adjustment to the allocation of the purchase price so that the aggregate purchase price paid by the Partnership was 
$53.8 million, resulting in a payment in December 2014 of approximately $11.4 million from CST to the Partnership. In approving the 
transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an opinion from its independent financial advisor that the 
consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of 
view.  

LGWS leases the acquired real estate to a subsidiary of CST, which will operate the sites. In addition, LGW distributes fuel to a 
subsidiary of CST that operates the acquired sites pursuant to a wholesale fuel distribution agreement. See Note 20 for additional 
discussion of the lease and wholesale fuel distribution agreements.  

The following table summarizes the preliminary estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition 
date (in thousands):  

Other current assets 
Property and equipment 
Other assets 

Net identifiable assets 
Goodwill 

Net assets 

Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation 

$ 

220  
33,000  
4,015  

37,235  
16,585  

$ 

53,820  

The above estimated fair values of assets and liabilities acquired are provisional and based on information that was available as of the 
acquisition date, including the allocation of the purchase price between CST and the Partnership. The Partnership believes the 
information provides a reasonable basis for estimating the fair values. The purchase price allocation is preliminary pending a final 
valuation of the assets and liabilities, including a final valuation of property and equipment, intangible assets and the impact of income 
taxes. Thus, the provisional measurements of estimated fair value reflected are subject to change, and such change could be 
significant. The Partnership expects to finalize the valuation and complete the accounting for the transaction as soon as practicable, 
but no later than one year from the acquisition date.  

F-19 

 
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and underground storage tanks.  

Other assets consists of net deferred tax assets associated with the difference between the book and tax bases of the net assets 
acquired.  

A substantial portion of the goodwill represents the value that would have been allocated to wholesale fuel distribution rights. 
However, because the wholesale fuel distribution rights have been acquired as a result of CST assigning them to the Partnership and 
we are entities under common control, this intangible is not permitted to be recognized and so the residual value has been allocated to 
goodwill.  

Aggregate incremental revenues since the closing of the Nice N Easy acquisition included in the Partnership’s statement of operations 
were $13.6 million for 2014.  

PMI Acquisition  
On April 28, 2014, the Partnership exercised an option (the “Option”) to purchase 100% of the membership interests of Pinehurst 
Petroleum, LLC (“Pinehurst”) from Joseph L. Smith III and John A. Kopfer, Jr. (collectively, “Smith/Kopfer”) for $4.0 million. 
Pinehurst’s sole asset was an Agreement and Plan of Merger among Pinehurst, PMI Merger Sub, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of 
Pinehurst (“Sub”), Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated, (“PMI”), Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated Employee Stock Ownership Trust 
and Ronald R. Hare, in his capacity as representative (the “Merger Agreement”), pursuant to which Pinehurst agreed to acquire all of 
the shares of PMI for $73.5 million inclusive of an adjustment for working capital, through the merger (the “Merger”) of Sub and 
PMI. Under the terms of the Merger Agreement, the stockholders of PMI agreed to escrow $5.0 million for 25 months after the 
closing date of the Merger to secure the indemnity provisions contained in the Merger Agreement for the benefit of Pinehurst. The 
transaction was funded with borrowings under the credit facility. On April 30, 2014, pursuant to the Option, the Partnership purchased 
all of the equity interests of Pinehurst ($1.0 million of the consideration has been included in accrued expenses and other current 
liabilities at December 31, 2014). Subsequent to such purchase, the Merger became effective and, as a result, the Partnership became 
the owner of PMI.  

PMI operates two primary lines of business: convenience stores and petroleum products distribution. In its convenience store business, 
PMI operates 87 convenience stores and nine co-located branded quick service restaurants located in Virginia and West Virginia. PMI 
also leases 7 sites to lessee dealers. The convenience stores distribute primarily branded fuel and operate under PMI’s own proprietary 
convenience store brand, “Stop in Food Stores.” The petroleum products business distributes motor fuels and other petroleum products 
to customers throughout Virginia, West Virginia, Tennessee and North Carolina. The acquisition augmented the Partnership’s 
presence in Virginia and complements the existing Tennessee operations.  

In accordance with the Merger Agreement, the Partnership accrued $3.2 million payable to the sellers for the tax benefit received from 
the termination and payment of PMI’s non-qualified retirement plans. Such payment was accounted for as part of the purchase price.  

On May 1, 2014, immediately subsequent to the effectiveness of the Merger, the Partnership caused PMI to divest its lubricants 
business (the “Lubricants Business”) to Zimri Holdings, LLC (“Zimri”), an entity owned by Smith/Kopfer, for the sum of $14.0 
million pursuant to an Asset Purchase Agreement (the “APA”) between PMI and Zimri. A trust controlled by Joseph V. Topper, Jr., 
Chairman and CEO of the General Partner, financed the purchase of the Lubricants Business by Zimri pursuant to a loan to Zimri. The 
financing by Mr. Topper’s trust was approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. In 
2014, the trust that financed the purchase acquired the Lubricants Business.  

F-20 

 
 
  
The following table summarizes the preliminary fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date, the 
fair value of the net assets divested as part of the Lubricants Business and the preliminary fair values of the assets acquired and 
liabilities assumed net of the divestiture (in thousands):  

Accounts receivable 
Inventory 
Other current assets 
Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   
Other noncurrent assets 

Total identifiable assets 
Accounts payable  
Motor fuel taxes payable 
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 
Deferred tax liabilities 
Other noncurrent liabilities 

Net identifiable assets 
Goodwill 

Net assets 

Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation 

Cumulative 
Adjustments 

Adjusted 
Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation 

Divestiture 
of 
Lubricants 
Business 

Adjusted 
Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation net 
of Divestiture 

$ 

21,368   $ 
19,040  
2,903  
48,770  
15,000  
210  

—     $ 
—    
—    
4,022  
13,671  
—    

21,368   $  2,038   $ 
19,040  
2,903  
52,792  
28,671  
210  

6,157  
5  
4,437  
—    
—    

107,291  
36,310  
303  
2,371  
18,787  
—    

49,520  
23,996  

17,693  
—    
—    
3,184  
6,606  
2,530  

5,373  
(5,373) 

124,984  
36,310  
303  
5,555  
25,393  
2,530  

54,893  
18,623  

  12,637  
2,864  
—    
—    
—    
—    

9,773  
4,227  

19,330  
12,883  
2,898  
48,355  
28,671  
210  

112,347  
33,446  
303  
5,555  
25,393  
2,530  

45,120  
14,396  

$ 

73,516   $ 

—     $ 

73,516   $  14,000   $ 

59,516  

During 2014, the Partnership increased the value ascribed to property and equipment, intangible assets, above market lease liabilities 
and recorded the liability to the sellers related to the tax benefit associated with the termination and payment of the non-qualified 
retirement plans discussed previously.  

The above fair values of assets and liabilities acquired are provisional and based on information that was available as of the 
acquisition date. The Partnership believes the information provides a reasonable basis for estimating the fair values. The purchase 
price allocation is preliminary pending a final valuation of the assets and liabilities, including a final valuation of property and 
equipment, intangible assets and the impact of income taxes. Thus, the provisional measurements of fair value reflected are subject to 
change, and such change could be significant. The Partnership expects to finalize the valuation and complete the accounting for the 
transaction as soon as practicable, but no later than one year from the acquisition date.  

The fair value of inventory was estimated at retail selling price less costs and a reasonable profit allowance for the selling effort.  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $7.7 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to 
be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over their estimated 
remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks 
associated with this type of transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant 
assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful life of 
approximately 10 years.  

F-21 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
The $15.2 million fair value of the wholesale fuel supply agreements was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated 
to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel supply agreements over their 
estimated remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, generally assumed to extend through the term of the wholesale 
fuel supply contracts, and using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of agreement. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The wholesale fuel supply 
agreements are being amortized on an accelerated basis over an estimated useful life of approximately 10 years.  

The $5.0 million fair value of the discount related to lease agreements with below average market value and the $2.5 million fair value 
of the discount related to lease agreements with above average market value were based on an income approach, with the fair value 
estimated to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the lease agreements over their estimated 
remaining useful life, generally assumed to extend through the term of the lease agreements, and using discount rates considered 
appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of agreement. The Partnership believes the level and timing of cash flows 
represent relevant market participant assumptions. The discount related to lease agreements with above/below average market value is 
being amortized on a straight-line basis over the term of the respective lease agreements, with an estimated weighted average useful 
life of 5 years.  

The $0.9 million fair value of the trademark was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the present value of 
incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the trademark.  

Goodwill recorded is primarily attributable to the deferred tax liabilities arising from the application of purchase accounting.  

Aggregate incremental revenues since the closing of the PMI acquisition included in the Partnership’s statement of operations were 
$620.0 million for 2014.  

The following is unaudited pro forma information related to the PMI acquisition as if the transaction had occurred on January 1, 2013 
(in thousands):  

Total revenues 
Net income 

Year Ended December 31,  

2014  
$2,936,109  
(7,914) 

2013  
$2,961,737  
13,687  

Atlas Acquisition  
On May 19, 2014, the Partnership completed its acquisition of 52 wholesale supply contracts, one sub-wholesaler contract, nine fee 
sites, six leasehold sites and certain other assets from affiliates of Atlas Oil Company (“Atlas”) for $34.0 million. In addition, the 
Partnership acquired certain short-term notes receivable associated with the wholesale supply and commission marketing contracts for 
$5.2 million, bringing total consideration to $39.2 million, subject to closing adjustments. The transaction was funded by borrowings 
under the Partnership’s credit facility and $4.0 million of proceeds from the sale of the Lubricants Business that were directed to an 
escrow agent as part of an Internal Revenue Code Section 1031 like-kind exchange.  

These assets are located in the Chicago, Illinois area and are branded BP. The wholesale supply contracts have a remaining average 
term of 15 years and the fee or leasehold sites are currently leased to third party commission agents. The short-term notes receivable 
relate to previously negotiated purchase agreements of certain sites by the dealers occupying the locations. All of the notes receivable 
relate to sites supplied under contracts acquired in this transaction.  

In connection with the acquisition, Sam Simon, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Atlas Oil Company, entered into a non-
compete agreement that generally restricts him and entities controlled by him from (a) engaging in the wholesale distribution of motor 
fuel or owning or operating a retail motor fuel facility and/or convenience store within certain territories for one year after the closing 
date, and (b) constructing any new retail motor fuel facility and/or convenience stores within certain territories for five years after the 
closing date.  

F-22 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
The following table summarizes the preliminary fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in 
thousands):  

Inventory 
Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   
Other noncurrent assets 

Total identifiable assets 
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 
Other noncurrent liabilities 

Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation 

$ 

280  
21,735  
15,043  
5,170  

42,228  
1,111  
932  

Cumulative 
Adjustments 
—    
$ 
(2,775) 
2,782  
368  

375  
77  
1,260  

Adjusted 
Preliminary 
Purchase Price 
Allocation 

$ 

280  
18,960  
17,825  
5,538  

42,603  
1,188  
2,192  

Net assets 

$ 

40,185  

$ 

(962) 

$ 

39,223  

During 2014, the Partnership increased the value ascribed to intangible assets, decreased the value ascribed to property and equipment 
and increased the value ascribed to above market lease liabilities.  

The above fair values of assets and liabilities acquired are provisional and based on information that was available as of the 
acquisition date. The Partnership believes the information provides a reasonable basis for estimating the fair values. The purchase 
price allocation is preliminary pending a final valuation of the assets and liabilities, including a final valuation of property and 
equipment, intangible assets and the impact of income taxes. Thus, the provisional measurements of fair value reflected are subject to 
change, and such change could be significant. The Partnership expects to finalize the valuation and complete the accounting for the 
transaction as soon as practicable, but no later than one year from the acquisition date.  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The approximate $15.4 million fair value of the wholesale fuel supply agreements was based on an income approach, with the fair 
value estimated to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel supply agreements 
over their estimated remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, generally assumed to extend through the term of the 
wholesale fuel supply contracts, and using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of 
agreement. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The wholesale 
fuel supply agreements are being amortized on an accelerated basis over an estimated useful life of approximately 10 years.  

The approximate $1.5 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value 
estimated to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over 
their estimated remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the 
inherent risks associated with this type of transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant 
market participant assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated 
useful life of approximately 10 years.  

The approximate $0.6 million fair value of the covenant not to compete was based on an income approach, with the fair value 
estimated to be the difference between the present value of after-tax cash flows with and without the covenant not to compete in place, 
using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of 
transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The covenant 
not to compete intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line basis over a 5-year period.  

F-23 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
The approximate $0.4 million fair value of the discount related to lease agreements with below average market value and the $1.3 
million fair value of the discount related to lease agreements with above average market value were based on an income approach, 
with the fair value estimated to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the lease agreements over 
their estimated remaining useful life, generally assumed to extend through the term of the lease agreements, and using discount rates 
considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of agreement. The Partnership believes the level and timing of 
cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The discount related to lease agreements with above/below average 
market value is being amortized on a straight-line basis over the term of the respective lease agreements, with an estimated weighted 
average useful life of 5 years.  

Aggregate incremental revenues since the closing of the Atlas acquisition included in the Partnership’s statement of operations were 
$134.8 million for 2014.  

Manchester Acquisition  
On December 19, 2013, the Partnership completed its purchase of certain assets from Manchester Marketing, Inc. (“Manchester”), 
pursuant to which the Partnership purchased 44 independent dealer supply contracts, five sub-wholesale supply contracts, two 
leasehold motor fuel stations and certain other assets and equipment, which were held or used by Manchester in connection with their 
motor fuels and related convenience store businesses located in the Richmond, Virginia area, for $10.7 million. The purchase price 
was funded by borrowings under the Credit Facility.  

The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands):  

Accounts receivable 
Inventory 
Property and equipment 
Notes receivable   
Intangible assets   

Total identifiable assets 
Other liabilities 

Net identifiable assets 
Goodwill 

Net assets acquired 

$ 

78  
56  
230  
437  
  10,271  

  11,072  
355  

  10,717  
23  

$ 10,740  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $9.1 million fair value of the wholesale fuel supply agreements was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to 
be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel supply agreements over their 
estimated remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, generally assumed to extend through the term of the wholesale 
fuel supply contracts, and using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of agreement. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The wholesale fuel supply 
agreements are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful life of approximately 10 years.  

The $1.1 million fair value of the covenant not to compete was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the 
difference between the present value of after-tax cash flows with and without the covenant not to compete in place, using probability-
weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of transaction. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The covenant not to 
compete intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line basis over a 5-year period.  

F-24 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Rocky Top Acquisition  
Effective September 24, 2013, the Partnership completed its purchase of certain assets from Rocky Top Markets, LLC and Rocky Top 
Properties, LLC (collectively, “Rocky Top”), pursuant to which the Partnership purchased one motor fuel station, three leasehold 
motor fuel stations, assumed certain third-party supply contracts and purchased certain other assets, which were held or used by Rocky 
Top in connection with their motor fuels and related convenience store businesses located in the Knoxville, Tennessee area. 
Concurrent with the closing, the Partnership entered into a lease for 29 motor fuel stations that the Partnership is obligated to 
purchase, at the election of Rocky Top, either (a) in whole for $26.2 million on or about August 1, 2015, or (b) in approximately equal 
parts over a 5 year period for an average of $5.3 million per year beginning in 2016. Due to the obligation to purchase the sites under 
the lease, the lease is accounted for as a seller financing. In conjunction with the seller financing, the transfer of title of the property 
and equipment recorded as part of the accounting for the business combination is expected to occur at the time of the final payment. 
As such, the Partnership recorded $26.2 million of debt, which was preliminarily determined to be its fair value. See Note 10 for 
additional details. The Partnership paid $10.7 million in cash to Rocky Top at closing, which was funded by borrowings under the 
Credit Facility.  

Simultaneously, LGO completed its purchase of certain retail assets from Rocky Top (including fuel and merchandise inventory). The 
conflicts committee of the General Partner determined that the apportionment of the consideration payable by each of the Partnership 
and LGO and the terms and conditions of the agreements with LGO are fair and reasonable to the Partnership. The income that these 
assets generate is non-qualifying for federal income tax purposes. Subsequent to the closing, the Partnership and LGO entered into a 
sublease agreement for all of the sites and a fuel distribution agreement for the purchase and sale of wholesale fuel.  

The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands):  

Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   

Total identifiable assets 
Other liabilities 

Net identifiable assets acquired 
Goodwill 

Net assets acquired 

$ 33,560  
  3,560  

  37,120  
372  

  36,748  
102  

$ 36,850  

During the fourth quarter of 2013, based on additional valuation analysis completed, the Partnership increased the value ascribed to 
intangible assets and recorded other insignificant adjustments as reflected above.  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $2.8 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to 
be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over their estimated 
remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks 
associated with this type of transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant 
assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful life of 
approximately 10 years.  

The $0.3 million fair value of the trademark was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the present value of 
incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the trademark.  

F-25 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Rogers Acquisition  
On September 19, 2013, the Partnership completed its purchase of certain assets from Rogers Petroleum, Inc. and affiliates 
(“Rogers”), pursuant to which the Partnership purchased 13 motor fuel stations, four leasehold motor fuel stations and certain other 
assets, which were held or used by Rogers in connection with their motor fuels and related convenience store businesses located in the 
Tri-Cities region of Tennessee, for $20.0 million. The purchase price was funded by borrowings under the Credit Facility. One of the 
sites initially leased was purchased on October 23, 2013 for $1.1 million.  

Simultaneously, LGO completed its purchase of certain retail assets from Rogers (including fuel and merchandise inventory). The 
conflicts committee of the General Partner determined that the apportionment of the consideration payable by each of the Partnership 
and LGO and the terms and conditions of the agreements with LGO are fair and reasonable to the Partnership. The income that these 
assets generate is non-qualifying for federal income tax purposes. Subsequent to the closing, the Partnership and LGO entered into a 
sublease agreement for all of the sites and a fuel distribution agreement for the purchase and sale of wholesale fuel.  

The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands):  

Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   

Total identifiable assets 
Other liabilities 

Net identifiable assets acquired 
Goodwill 

Net assets acquired 

$ 18,930  
  2,370  

  21,300  
273  

  21,027  
98  

$ 21,125  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $1.7 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to 
be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over their estimated 
remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks 
associated with this type of transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant 
assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful life of 
approximately 10 years.  

The $0.4 million fair value of the covenant not to compete was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the 
difference between the present value of after-tax cash flows with and without the covenant not to compete in place, using probability-
weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of transaction. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The covenant not to 
compete intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line basis over a 5-year period.  

F-26 

 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Dunmore Acquisition  
On December 21, 2012 (the “Dunmore Acquisition Date), the Partnership completed (the “Dunmore Closing”) its acquisition of 
certain assets (the “Dunmore Acquisition”) of Dunmore Oil Company, Inc. and JoJo Oil Company, Inc. (together, the “Dunmore 
Sellers”) as contemplated by the Asset Purchase Agreement, as amended (the “Dunmore Purchase Agreement”), by and among the 
Partnership, a subsidiary of the Partnership, the Dunmore Sellers, and, for limited purposes, Joseph Gentile, Jr. Pursuant to the 
Dunmore Purchase Agreement, the Dunmore Sellers sold to the Partnership substantially all of the assets (collectively, the “Dunmore 
Assets”) held and used by the Dunmore Sellers in connection with their gasoline and diesel retail outlet and related convenience store 
businesses (the “Dunmore Retail Business”). In connection with this transaction, the Partnership acquired the real estate of 24 motor 
fuel service stations, 23 of which are fee simple interests and one of which is a leasehold interest.  

LGO leases the sites from the Partnership and operates the Dunmore Retail Business. In addition, as contemplated by the Dunmore 
Purchase Agreement, certain of the non-qualifying income generating Dunmore Assets (for federal income tax purposes) and certain 
non-qualifying liabilities of the Dunmore Sellers were assigned by the Partnership to LGO. LGO paid the Partnership $0.5 million for 
advanced rent payments. The Dunmore Sellers are permitted to continue to operate certain portions of their business relating to sales 
of heating oil, propane and unbranded motor fuels.  

As consideration for the Dunmore Assets, the Partnership paid (i) $28.0 million in cash to the Dunmore Sellers; (ii) $0.5 million in 
cash to Mr. Gentile as consideration for his agreeing, for a period of five years following the Dunmore Closing, to not compete in the 
Dunmore Retail Business, to not engage in the sale or distribution of branded motor fuels, and to not solicit or hire any of the 
Partnership affiliates’ employees; and (iii) $0.5 million in cash to be held in escrow and delivered to the Dunmore Sellers upon the 
Partnership’s receipt of written evidence concerning the payment of certain of the Dunmore Sellers’ pre-closing tax liabilities.  

The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands):  

Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   

Total identifiable assets 
Other liabilities 

Net identifiable assets acquired 
Goodwill 

Net assets acquired 

$ 22,800  
  6,800  

  29,600  
967  

  28,633  
367  

$ 29,000  

The fair value of land, buildings, and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence, and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $6.3 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to 
be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over their estimated 
remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks 
associated with this type of transaction. Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant 
assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful life of 
approximately 10 years.  

The $0.5 million fair value of the covenant not to compete was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the 
difference between the present value of after-tax cash flows with and without the covenant not to compete in place, using probability-
weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of transaction. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The covenant not to 
compete intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line basis over the 5-year term of the covenant.  

F-27 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Express Lane Acquisition  
On December 21, 2012, LGWS entered into a Stock Purchase Agreement (the “Express Lane Stock Purchase Agreement”) with James 
E. Lewis, Jr., Linda N. Lewis, James E. Lewis, III and Reid D. Lewis (collectively, the “Express Lane Sellers”), pursuant to which the 
Express Lane Sellers sold to LGWS all of the outstanding capital stock (collectively, the “Express Lane Shares”) of Express Lane, Inc. 
(“Express Lane”), the owner and operator of various retail convenience stores, which include the retail sale of motor fuels and quick 
service restaurants, at various locations in Florida.  

In connection with the purchase of the Express Lane Shares, LGWS acquired forty-one motor fuel service stations, one as a fee simple 
interest and forty as leasehold interests. In connection with the purchase of the Express Lane Shares, on December 21, 2012, LGPR 
entered into a Purchase and Sale Agreement (the “Express Lane Purchase and Sale Agreement” and, together with the Express Lane 
Stock Purchase Agreement, the “Express Lane Agreements”) with Express Lane. Under the Express Lane Purchase and Sale 
Agreement, LGPR acquired, prior to the Express Lane Purchaser’s acquisition of the Express Lane Shares, an additional fee simple 
interest in six properties and two fuel purchase agreements (collectively, the “Express Lane Property”) from Express Lane.  

On December 21, 2012, LGPR completed the acquisition of the Express Lane Property from the Express Lane Sellers, as 
contemplated by the Express Lane Purchase and Sale Agreement. In addition, on December 22, 2012, LGWS completed (the “Express 
Lane Closing”) the acquisition of the Express Lane Shares from the Express Lane Sellers, as contemplated by the Express Lane Stock 
Purchase Agreement. The transactions contemplated by the Express Lane Agreements are together referred to as the “Express Lane 
Acquisition.”  

As a result of the Express Lane acquisition, LGO leases the sites from the Partnership and operates Express Lane’s gasoline and diesel 
retail outlet business and its related convenience store business (the “Express Lane Retail Business”). In addition, certain of the non-
qualifying income generating assets (for federal income tax purposes) related to the Express Lane Retail Business and certain non-
qualifying liabilities of the Express Lane Sellers were assigned to LGO. LGO paid the Partnership $1.0 million for advanced rent 
payments. During the three months ended September 30, 2013, the Partnership paid $1.7 million of additional purchase price 
consideration for the net working capital of the Express Lane Retail Business (see Note 7). Because the net working capital was 
transferred to LGO at the acquisition date, LGO repaid this amount to the Partnership in October 2013.  

Under the Express Lane Agreements, the aggregate purchase price (the “Express Lane Purchase Price”) for the Express Lane Property 
and the Express Lane Shares was $45.2 million, inclusive of $1.7 million of certain post-closing adjustments. Of the Express Lane 
Purchase Price, LGWS paid an aggregate of $41.9 million to the Express Lane Sellers and placed an aggregate of $1.1 million into 
escrow, of which $1.0 million has been placed into escrow to fund any indemnification or similar claims made under the Express Lane 
Agreements by the parties thereto, and $0.1 million has been placed into escrow pending the completion of certain environmental 
remediation measures. In addition to the Express Lane Purchase Price, LGPR also placed $0.5 million into escrow to indemnify the 
Express Lane Sellers for certain tax obligations resulting from the sale of the Express Lane Property.  

Under the Express Lane Stock Purchase Agreement, the Express Lane Sellers have agreed not to compete in the retail motor fuel or 
convenience store business within the State of Florida for a period of four years following the Express Lane Closing. In addition, 
pursuant to the Express Lane Stock Purchase Agreement, each of the Express Lane Sellers executed a general release in favor of 
LGWS, Express Lane and their respective affiliates.  

F-28 

 
 
  
The following table summarizes the fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands):  

Net working capital 
Property and equipment 
Intangible assets   
Environmental indemnification asset 

Total identifiable assets 
Environmental liabilities 
Other liabilities 

Total identifiable liabilities 

Net identifiable assets acquired 
Goodwill 

Net assets acquired 

$  1,720  
  28,645  
  19,700  
  1,177  

  51,242  
  1,177  
  9,566  

  10,743  

  40,499  
  4,714  

$ 45,213  

The fair value of land, buildings and equipment was based on a cost approach, with the fair value of an asset estimated by reference to 
the replacement cost to obtain a substitute asset of comparable features and functionality, and is the amount a willing market 
participant would pay for such an asset, taking into consideration the asset condition as well as any physical deterioration, functional 
obsolescence and/or economic obsolescence. The buildings and equipment are being depreciated on a straight-line basis, with 
estimated useful lives of 20 years for buildings and 5 to 15 years for equipment.  

The $15.4 million fair value of the wholesale fuel distribution rights was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated 
to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the wholesale fuel distribution rights over their 
estimated remaining useful life, using probability-weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent 
risks associated with this type of transaction. The Partnership believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market 
participant assumptions. The wholesale fuel distribution rights are being amortized on a straight-line basis over an estimated useful 
life of approximately 10 years.  

The $3.8 million fair value of the discount related to lease agreements with below average market value and the $2.6 million fair value 
of the discount related to lease agreements with above average market value were based on an income approach, with the fair value 
estimated to be the present value of incremental after-tax cash flows attributable solely to the lease agreements over their estimated 
remaining useful life, generally assumed to extend through the term of the lease agreements, and using discount rates considered 
appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of agreement. The Partnership believes the level and timing of cash flows 
represent relevant market participant assumptions. The discount related to lease agreements with above/below average market value is 
being amortized on a straight-line basis over the term of the respective lease agreements, with an estimated weighted average useful 
life of 5 years.  

The $0.5 million fair value of the covenant not to compete was based on an income approach, with the fair value estimated to be the 
difference between the present value of after-tax cash flows with and without the covenant not to compete in place, using probability-
weighted cash flows, using discount rates considered appropriate given the inherent risks associated with this type of transaction. 
Management believes the level and timing of cash flows represent relevant market participant assumptions. The covenant not to 
compete intangible asset is being amortized on a straight-line basis over the 4-year term of the covenant.  

5. Discontinued Operations and Assets Held for Sale  
Discontinued Operations  
As part of certain sale transactions, the Partnership may continue to distribute motor fuels on a wholesale basis to a divested site. In 
addition, the Partnership and Predecessor Entity may have the right to monitor and, if necessary, impose conditions on the operations 
of a divested site to ensure that the purchaser is complying with the terms and conditions of the franchise agreement covering such 
site. Accordingly, the Partnership and Predecessor Entity may have the ability to exert significant influence over the divested site and 
thus the Partnership and Predecessor Entity may have significant continuing involvement. Such sites were not deemed discontinued 
operations prior to the adoption of ASU 2014-08 on January 1, 2014.  

F-29 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
The Predecessor Entity classifies sites as discontinued when operations and cash flows will be eliminated from ongoing operations and 
the Predecessor Entity will not retain any significant continuing involvement in the operations after the respective sale transactions. 
All of the operating results for these discontinued operations were removed from continuing operations and were presented separately 
as discontinued operations in the statements of operations. The notes to the financial statements were adjusted to exclude discontinued 
operations unless otherwise noted. The Partnership has no discontinued operations.  

The following results are included in discontinued operations for the period January 1, 2012 to October 30, 2012 (in thousands):  

Revenues: 

Revenues from fuel sales 
Rent income 

Total revenues  

Costs and Expenses: 

Cost of revenues from fuel sales 
Operating expenses   
Depreciation and amortization 
Gain on sales of assets, net 

Total costs and operating expenses 

Operating income  
Interest expense, net 

Income from discontinued operations 

$ 4,132  
104  

  4,236  

  4,019  
49  
50  
(237) 

  3,881  

355  
(46) 

$  309  

Assets Held for Sale  
The Partnership classified five and two sites as held for sale at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These assets were classified 
as held for sale as they did not fit the Partnership’s strategy and are expected to be sold in 2015. In connection with the classification 
as held for sale, the Partnership recognized a loss of $0.3 million and $0.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, 
respectively. The loss represents the impairment recognized to present the held-for-sale sites at the lower of cost or fair value, less 
costs to sell. The fair values, less costs to sell were determined based on negotiated amounts in agreements with unrelated third parties. 
Assets held for sale were as follows (in thousands):  

Property and equipment, at cost: 
Land 
Buildings and improvements 
Equipment and other 

Total property and equipment, at cost 

Less accumulated depreciation 

Net assets held for sale 

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

$ 

1,984  
782  
464  

3,230  

(646) 

$ 

932  
543  
299  

1,774  

(446) 

$ 

2,584  

$ 

1,328  

F-30 

 
 
  
  
 
 
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
6. Inventory  
As a result of the PMI acquisition, the Partnership began recording food and merchandise inventory as well as motor fuel inventory at 
the sites it operates. Inventory consisted of the following (in thousands):  

Motor fuel inventory 
Gasoline 
Diesel 
Other 

Total motor fuel inventory  
Food and merchandise inventory 

Inventory 

7. Property and Equipment  
Property and equipment, net consisted of the following at (in thousands):  

Land 
Buildings and improvements 
Leasehold improvements   
Equipment and other 

Property and equipment in service, at cost 
Accumulated depreciation and amortization   

Property and equipment in service, net 
Construction in progress 

Property and equipment, net 

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

$ 

$ 

3,737  
1,014  
489  

5,240  
6,829  

$ 

12,069  

$ 

1,901  
240  
—    

2,141  
—    

2,141  

December 31, 
2014  
$  153,181  
176,839  
8,660  
111,285  

449,965  
(63,339) 

386,626  
4,873  

December 31, 
2013  
$  122,126  
124,479  
7,437  
76,236  

330,278  
(43,808) 

286,470  
2,259  

$  391,499  

$  288,729  

Approximately $290.1 million of property and equipment, net was used for leasing purposes at December 31, 2014.  

The Partnership is the lessee in certain sale-leaseback transactions for certain sites, and as the Partnership has continuing involvement 
in the underlying sites, or the lease agreement has a repurchase feature, the sale-leaseback arrangements are accounted for as lease 
financing obligations. The table above includes these sites, as well as certain leases accounted for as capital leases. These total cost 
and accumulated amortization of property and equipment recorded under sale-leaseback transactions and capital leases was 
$54.0 million and $12.5 million at December 31, 2014, and $52.6 million and $8.4 million at December 31, 2013, respectively. See 
Note 11 for further information.  

Depreciation expense, including amortization of assets recorded under sale-leasebacks and capital lease obligations, was 
approximately $22.0 million, $16.5 million, $2.2 million, and $11.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the 
period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 and the period from January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, 
respectively.  

In addition to the business combinations discussed in Note 4, the following asset purchases and divestitures occurred in 2014:  

• 

•  

•  

The Partnership sold four sites during 2014, resulting in a gain of $1.7 million.  
In May 2013, the Partnership repurchased four sites in Ohio for $7.1 million. These sites were previously leased through 
sale-leaseback transactions that were accounted for as lease financing obligations with a remaining balance of $5.1 
million. The $2.0 million difference between the purchase price and the remaining balance of the lease financing 
obligation was recorded as an increase to property and equipment.  
In June 2013, the Partnership purchased two sites in Florida for $1.6 million, of which $0.6 million was paid in cash and 
the remaining balance was financed as a note payable. See Note 8 for additional details.  

F-31 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
8. Goodwill and Intangible Assets  
Changes in goodwill consisted of the following at (in thousands):  

Beginning balance 
Acquisitions 
Divestitures 

Ending balance 

Wholesale Segment  

Retail Segment  

2014  
$  9,324  
  29,473  
  (4,227) 

$ 34,570  

2013  
$ 5,636  
  3,688  
  —    

$ 9,324  

2014  

—    
5,758  
—    

5,758  

$ 

$ 

No impairment losses have been recorded to goodwill. See Note 4 for additional information on the acquisitions. The amount of 
goodwill expected to be deductible for tax purposes was $5.7 million at December 31, 2014.  

Intangible assets consist of the following (in thousands):  

Wholesale fuel supply agreements   
Wholesale fuel distribution rights 
Trademarks 
Covenant not to compete 
Below market leases 

Total 

December 31, 2014  

December 31, 2013  

Gross 
Amount  
$  56,326  
  31,803  
1,484  
2,951  
  10,161  

Accumulated 
Amortization  
(15,915) 
$ 
(4,860) 
(433) 
(776) 
(2,961) 

Net 
Carrying 
Amount  
$ 40,411  
  26,943  
  1,051  
  2,175  
  7,200  

Gross 
Amount  
$ 25,736  
  26,180  
634  
  2,676  
  4,761  

Accumulated 
Amortization  
(9,059) 
$ 
(2,282) 
(78) 
(253) 
(1,310) 

Net 
Carrying 
Amount  
$ 16,677  
  23,898  
556  
  2,423  
  3,451  

$102,725  

$ 

(24,945) 

$ 77,780  

$ 59,987  

$ 

(12,982) 

$ 47,005  

See Note 4 for additional information on the acquisitions, which resulted in additional intangible assets being recorded in 2014.  

The aggregate amortization expense, including amortization of above and below market lease intangible assets which is classified as 
rent expense, was approximately $11.3 million, $4.6 million, $0.3 million, and $1.9 million for 2014, 2013, the period October 31, 
2012 through December 31, 2012 and the period January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, respectively.  

The following represents expected amortization expense for the next five years, including amortization of above and below market 
lease intangible assets (in thousands):  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 

$ 7,775  
  7,461  
  6,991  
  6,225  
  5,294  

F-32 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
9. Accrued Expenses and Other Current Liabilities  
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities consisted of the following at (in thousands):  

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

Interest expense   
Professional fees   
Equity-based incentive compensation (Note 17) 
Taxes other than income 
Management fees payable to affiliate 
Termination benefits (Note 17) 
Acquisition costs  
Other 

$ 

$ 

569  
1,243  
4,994  
3,410  
188  
2,357  
3,783  
4,417  

Total accrued expenses and other current liabilities 

$ 

20,961  

$ 

444  
1,365  
3,141  
1,169  
139  
—    
—    
1,750  

8,008  

10. Debt  
Debt outstanding was as follows:  

Revolving credit facility 
Financing associated with Rocky Top acquisition 
Note payable 

Total 
Current portion—included in accrued expenses and other 

current liabilities 

Total 

December 31, 
2014  
$  200,400  
26,250  
929  

227,579  

26,303  

December 31, 
2013  
$  146,330  
26,250  
980  

173,560  

51  

$  201,276  

$  173,509  

The following represents principal payments due for the next five years (in thousands). The financing issued in connection with the 
Rocky Top acquisition was assumed to be payable in 2015 in its entirety (see further discussion below).  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 

Total 

$  26,303  
55  
57  
764  
  200,400  

$ 227,579  

Credit Facility  
In March 2014, the Partnership entered into an amended and restated credit agreement, which was amended and restated on 
September 30, 2014 (the “Credit Facility”). The Credit Facility is a senior secured revolving credit facility maturing on March 4, 2019, 
with a total borrowing capacity of $550.0 million, under which swing-line loans may be drawn up to $10.0 million and standby letters 
of credit may be issued up to an aggregate of $45.0 million. The Credit Facility may be increased, from time to time, upon the 
Partnership’s written request, subject to certain conditions, up to an additional $100.0 million. All obligations under the Credit Facility 
are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Partnership and its subsidiaries. The notional amount of availability at 
December 31, 2014, was $333.2 million. As a result of the composition of lenders changing with the March and September 
amendments, deferred financing costs of $0.7 million were written off during 2014.  

F-33 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Borrowings under the Credit Facility bear interest, at the Partnership’s option, at (1) a rate equal to the London Interbank Offering 
Rate (“LIBOR”), for interest periods of one week or one, two, three or six months, plus a margin of 2.00% to 3.25% per annum, 
depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio (as defined) or (2) (a) a base rate equal to the greatest of: (i) the federal funds rate, 
plus 0.5%, (ii) LIBOR for one month interest periods, plus 1.00% per annum or (iii) the rate of interest established by the agent, from 
time to time, as its prime rate, plus (b) a margin of 1.00% to 2.25% per annum depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio. In 
addition, the Partnership incurs a commitment fee based on the unused portion of the revolving credit facility at a rate of 0.35% to 
0.50% per annum depending on the Partnership’s total leverage ratio. The weighted-average interest rate on outstanding borrowings at 
December 31, 2014, was 2.7%. Letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2014 and 2013, totaled $16.4 million and $12.3 million, 
respectively.  

The Partnership is required to comply with certain financial covenants under the Credit Facility. Effective July 2, 2014, the 
Partnership is required to maintain a total leverage ratio (as defined) for the most recently completed four fiscal quarters of less than or 
equal to 4.50:1.00 for periods after December 31, 2014, except for periods following a material acquisition. However, if an offering of 
Equity Interests (as defined) in the Partnership occurs after July 2, 2014, but prior to December 31, 2014, the total leverage ratio shall 
not exceed 4.50:1.00 for the fiscal quarter ending December 31, 2014; and the total leverage ratio shall not exceed 5.00:1.00 for the 
first two full fiscal quarters following the closing of a material acquisition or 5.50 : 1:00 upon the issuance of Qualified Senior Notes 
(as defined) in the aggregate principal amount of $175.0 million or greater. The Partnership is also required to maintain a senior 
leverage ratio (as defined) after the issuance of Qualified Senior Notes of $175.0 million or greater of less than or equal to 3.00:1.00 
and a consolidated interest coverage ratio (as defined) of at least 2.75 to 1.00.  

The Credit Facility prohibits the Partnership from making distributions to its unitholders if any potential default or event of default 
occurs or would result from the distribution, or the Partnership is not in compliance with its financial covenants. In addition, the Credit 
Facility contains various covenants which may limit, among other things, the Partnership’s ability to grant liens; create, incur, assume, 
or suffer to exist other indebtedness; or make any material change to the nature of the Partnership’s business, including mergers, 
liquidations, and dissolutions; and make certain investments, acquisitions or dispositions.  

Note Payable  
In connection with the June 2013 acquisition of certain sites in Florida noted previously, the Partnership issued a $1.0 million note 
payable with interest at 4.0%. The note matures July 1, 2018, at which time a balloon payment for all outstanding principal and any 
unpaid interest is due. The loan is secured by all the real and personal property at these sites.  

Financing Issued in Rocky Top Acquisition  
In connection with the Rocky Top acquisition as described in Note 4, the Partnership entered into a lease for certain sites for which the 
Partnership is obligated to purchase these sites, at the election of the seller, either (a) in whole on or about August 1, 2015, or (b) in 
approximately equal parts over a 5 year period for an average of $5.3 million per year beginning in 2016. Due to the obligation to 
purchase the sites under the lease, the lease is accounted for as a financing. Interest accrues at an annual rate of 7.7%. The Partnership 
recorded $26.2 million of debt, which was determined to be its fair value, and the payments made until the purchase will be classified 
as interest expense.  

In February 2015, the sellers gave notice that the put option would not be exercised, and thus the Partnership will purchase the sites 
over a 5 year period beginning in 2016.  

Predecessor Debt  
The Predecessor Entity had a credit facility and various other debt obligations. All borrowings were paid in full with proceeds from 
the IPO.  

11. Lease Financing Obligations and Operating Leases  
Lease Financing Obligations  
The Partnership is the lessee in certain sale-leaseback transactions for certain sites, and as the Partnership has continuing involvement 
in the underlying sites, or the lease agreement has a repurchase feature, the sale-leaseback arrangements are accounted for as lease 
financing obligations and are included in the table below. The Partnership also leases certain fuel stations and equipment under lease 
agreements accounted for as capital lease obligations.  

F-34 

 
 
  
The future minimum lease payments under lease financing obligations as of December 31, 2014 are as follows (in thousands):  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 
Thereafter 

Total future minimum lease payments 

Less interest component 

Present value of minimum lease payments 

Current portion 

Long-term portion 

$  6,112  
6,108  
6,059  
6,115  
6,250  
  64,339  

$  94,983  

  (32,195) 

  62,788  

2,780  

$  60,008  

Operating Leases of Sites as Lessee  
The Partnership leases sites from third parties under certain non-cancelable operating leases that expire from time to time through 
2028.  

The future minimum lease payments under operating leases as of December 31, 2014 were as follows (in thousands):  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 
Thereafter 

Total future minimum lease payments 

$  16,417  
  14,325  
  12,801  
  11,122  
  10,014  
  51,529  

$ 116,208  

The future minimum lease payments presented above do not include contingent rent based on future inflation, future revenues or 
volumes, or amounts that may be paid as reimbursements for certain operating costs incurred by the lessor. Most lease agreements 
include provisions for renewals.  

Contingent rent expense, based on gallons sold, was approximately $1.0 million, $1.0 million, $0.2 million, and $1.7 million for 2014, 
2013, the period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 and the period from January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, 
respectively.  

Getty Lease  
In May 2012, the Predecessor Entity entered into a 15-year master lease agreement with renewal options of up to an additional 
20 years with Getty. Pursuant to the lease, the Predecessor Entity leased 105 gas station sites in Massachusetts, New Hampshire and 
Maine. The lease was assigned to the Partnership. In December 2012, the agreement was amended to add an additional 25 sites in 
New Jersey. In December 2013, the agreement was amended to add one site in Delaware and one site in Maryland. The Partnership 
pays fixed rent, which increases 1.5% per year. In addition, the lease requires contingent rent payments based on gallons of fuel sold. 
During the initial 3 years of the lease, the Partnership is required to make capital expenditures of at least $4.3 million plus $0.01 per 
gallon of fuel sold at the New England sites. However, the Partnership is entitled to a rent credit equal to 50% of the capital 
expenditures up to a maximum of $2.1 million. During the initial 3.5 years of the lease, the Partnership is required to make capital 
expenditures of at least $1.0 million at the New Jersey sites.  

F-35 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
Because the fair value of the land at lease inception was estimated to represent more than 25% of the total fair value of the real 
property subject to the lease, the land element of the lease was analyzed for operating or capital treatment separately from the rest of 
the property subject to the lease. The land element of the lease was classified as an operating lease and all of the other property was 
classified as a capital lease. As such, future minimum lease payments are included in both the lease financing obligations and 
operating lease tables above.  

Through December 31, 2014, nine sites have been terminated from the lease and the Partnership notified Getty of its intent to 
terminate five additional sites from the lease. Any property and equipment or lease financing obligations associated with these sites 
were removed from the balance sheet, which resulted in a gain of $0.4 million and $0.2 million for 2014 and 2013, respectively, which 
is classified as a reduction of rent expense.  

Operating Leases of Sites as Lessor  
Motor fuel stations are leased to tenants under operating leases with various expiration dates ranging through 2028.  

The future minimum lease payments under non-cancelable operating leases with third parties, CST and LGO as of December 31, 2014 
were as follows (in thousands):  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 
Thereafter 

Total future minimum lease payments 

Third Parties 
$  17,678  
14,092  
9,441  
5,996  
5,475  
16,338  

$  69,020  

CST 
$  2,475  
  2,475  
  2,475  
  2,475  
  2,475  
  11,756  

$ 24,131  

LGO 
$  11,861  
  12,038  
  12,219  
  12,402  
  12,588  
  110,111  

Total 
$  32,014  
  28,605  
  24,135  
  20,873  
  20,538  
  138,205  

$ 171,219  

$ 264,370  

The future minimum lease payments presented above do not include contingent rent based on future inflation, future revenues or 
volumes of the lessee, or amounts that may be received as tenant reimbursements for certain operating costs. Most lease agreements 
include provisions for renewals.  

12. Asset Retirement Obligations  
As discussed in Note 3, prior to the GP Purchase, we recorded asset retirement obligations related to the removal of underground 
storage tanks when 1) the site was being sold and removing the tank was a condition of the sale; or 2) the lessor could require us to 
remove the tanks at the end of the lease.  

On October 1, 2014, concurrent with the GP Purchase and in an effort to conform operating and accounting policies we have asset 
retirement obligations for the removal of USTs at owned and leased retail sites. There is no legal obligation to remove USTs while 
they remain in service. However, environmental laws in the U.S. require that USTs be removed within one to two years after the USTs 
are no longer in service, depending on the jurisdiction in which the USTs are located. We have estimated that USTs at our owned 
retail sites will remain in service approximately 30 years and that we will have an obligation to remove those USTs at that time. For 
our leased retail sites, our lease agreements generally require that we remove certain improvements, primarily USTs and signage, upon 
termination of the lease. There are no assets that are legally restricted for purposes of settling our asset retirement obligations.  

F-36 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
A rollforward of the Partnership’s asset retirement obligation is below (in thousands):  

Beginning balance 
Recognition of new asset retirement obligations 
Changes in estimated cash flows or settlement dates 
Accretion 
Obligations settled 

Balance at December 31, 2014 
Current portion, classified within accrued expenses and other current 

liabilities 

2014  
$  2,151  
  —    
  17,149  
359  
(550) 

$ 19,109  

2013  
$  588  
187  
  1,398  
50  
(72) 

$ 2,151  

5  

280  

Long-term portion, classified within noncurrent other liabilities 

$ 19,104  

$ 1,871  

13. Environmental Matters  
The Partnership currently owns or leases sites where refined petroleum products are being or have been handled. These sites and the 
refined petroleum products handled thereon may be subject to federal and state environmental laws and regulations. Under such laws 
and regulations, the Partnership could be required to remove or remediate containerized hazardous liquids or associated generated 
wastes (including wastes disposed of or abandoned by prior owners or operators), to remediate contaminated property arising from the 
release of liquids or wastes into the environment, including contaminated groundwater, or to implement best management practices to 
prevent future contamination.  

The Partnership maintains insurance of various types with varying levels of coverage that is considered adequate under the 
circumstances to cover operations and properties. The insurance policies are subject to deductibles that are considered reasonable and 
not excessive. In addition, the Partnership has entered into indemnification and escrow agreements with various sellers in conjunction 
with several of their respective acquisitions, as further described below. Financial responsibility for environmental remediation is 
negotiated in connection with each acquisition transaction. In each case, an assessment is made of potential environmental liability 
exposure based on available information. Based on that assessment and relevant economic and risk factors, a determination is made 
whether to, and the extent to which the Partnership will, assume liability for existing environmental conditions.  

The table below presents a rollforward of the Partnership’s environmental liability (in thousands).  

Beginning balance 
Provision for new environmental losses 
Liabilities assumed in acquisitions   
Changes in estimates for previously incurred losses 
Payments 

Ending balance 
Current portion 

Long-term portion 

2014  
$ 1,238  
  —    
150  
30  
(344) 

  1,074  
372  

$  702  

2013  
$ 1,177  
650  
  —    
(144) 
(445) 

  1,238  
477  

$  761  

At December 31, 2014, the Partnership was indemnified by third-party escrow funds, state funds or insurance totaling $1.1 million, 
which are recorded as indemnification assets. State funds represent probable state reimbursement amounts. Reimbursement will 
depend upon the continued maintenance and solvency of the state. Insurance coverage represents amounts deemed probable of 
reimbursement under insurance policies.  

F-37 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
The estimates used in these reserves are based on all known facts at the time and an assessment of the ultimate remedial action 
outcomes. The Partnership will adjust loss accruals as further information becomes available or circumstances change. Among the 
many uncertainties that impact the estimates are the necessary regulatory approvals for, and potential modifications of remediation 
plans, the amount of data available upon initial assessment of the impact of soil or water contamination, changes in costs associated 
with environmental remediation services and equipment and the possibility of existing legal claims giving rise to additional claims.  

Environmental liabilities related to the contributed sites have not been assigned to the Partnership, and are still the responsibility of 
certain of the Predecessor Entities. Under the Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement among the Partnership, DMI, LGO, 
Mr. Topper, and CST (the “Amended Omnibus Agreement”), certain of the Predecessor Entities must indemnify the Partnership for 
any costs or expenses that the Partnership incurs for environmental liabilities and third-party claims, regardless of when a claim is 
made, that are based on environmental conditions in existence prior to the closing of the IPO for contributed sites. Certain of the 
Predecessor Entities are beneficiaries of escrow accounts created to cover the cost to remediate certain environmental liabilities. In 
addition, certain of the Predecessor Entities maintain insurance policies to cover environmental liabilities and/or, where available, 
participate in state programs that may also assist in funding the costs of environmental liabilities. Certain sites that were contributed to 
the Partnership were identified as having existing environmental liabilities that are not covered by escrow accounts, state funds or 
insurance policies. For more information on the Amended Omnibus Agreement, see Note 20.  

The following table presents a summary roll forward of the Predecessor Entity’s environmental liabilities, on an undiscounted basis 
(in thousands):  

Beginning balance 
Changes in estimates for previously incurred losses 
Payments 

Ending balance 

2014  
$ 18,259  
(626) 
  (2,968) 

$ 14,665  

2013  
$ 21,208  
373  
  (3,322) 

$ 18,259  

A significant portion of the Predecessor Entities’ environmental reserves have corresponding indemnification assets. The breakdown 
of the indemnification assets is as follows (in thousands):  

Third-party escrows 
State funds 
Insurance coverage 

Total indemnification assets 

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

$ 

$ 

5,136  
2,398  
4,967  

6,707  
3,210  
5,460  

$ 

12,501  

$ 

15,377  

F-38 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
14. Commitments and Contingencies  
Purchase Commitments  
The future minimum volume purchase requirements under the existing supply agreements are approximate gallons, with a purchase 
price at prevailing market rates for wholesale distributions. The Partnership and the Predecessor Entity purchased approximately 
869.5 million, 586.3 million, 90.0 million, and 431.2 million gallons of product under the existing supply agreements for 2014, 2013, 
the period from October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 and the period from January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, 
respectively. The following provides total future minimum volume purchase requirements (in thousands of gallons):  

2015 
2016 
2017 
2018 
2019 
Thereafter 

Total 

  414,280  
  320,213  
  256,755  
  242,089  
  233,005  
 2,307,748  

 3,774,090  

In the event for a given contract year the Partnership fails to purchase the required minimum volume, the underlying third party’s 
exclusive remedies (depending on the magnitude of the failure) are either termination of the supply agreement and/or a financial 
penalty per gallon based on the volume shortfall for the given year. Neither the Partnership nor the Predecessor Entity incurred any 
significant penalties for the periods presented.  

Legal Actions  
In the normal course of business, the Partnership and the Predecessor Entity have and may become involved in legal actions relating to 
the ownership and operation of their properties and business. In management’s opinion, the resolutions of any such pending legal 
actions are not expected to have a material adverse effect on its financial position, results of operations and cash flows. The 
Partnership and the Predecessor Entity maintain liability insurance on certain aspects of its businesses in amounts deemed adequate by 
management. However, there is no assurance that this insurance will be adequate to protect them from all material expenses related to 
potential future claims or these levels of insurance will be available in the future at economically acceptable prices.  

Environmental Liabilities  
See Note 13 for a discussion of the Partnership and the Predecessor Entity’s environmental liabilities.  

15. Fair Value Measurements  
The Partnership measures and reports certain financial and non-financial assets and liabilities on a fair value basis. Fair value is the 
price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the 
measurement date (exit price). GAAP specifies a three-level hierarchy that is used when measuring and disclosing fair value. The fair 
value hierarchy gives the highest priority to quoted prices available in active markets (i.e., observable inputs) and the lowest priority to 
data lacking transparency (i.e., unobservable inputs). An instrument’s categorization within the fair value hierarchy is based on the 
lowest level of significant input to its valuation. The following is a description of the three hierarchy levels.  

Level 1  Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted 

assets or liabilities. Active markets are considered to be those in which transactions for the assets or liabilities occur in 
sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis. 

Level 2  Quoted prices in markets that are not active, or inputs which are observable, either directly or indirectly, for 

substantially the full term of the asset or liability. This category includes quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities 
in active markets and quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in inactive markets. 

Level 3  Unobservable inputs are not corroborated by market data. This category is comprised of financial and non-financial 

assets and liabilities whose fair value is estimated based on internally developed models or methodologies using 
significant inputs that are generally less readily observable from objective sources. 

F-39 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfers into or out of any hierarchy level are recognized at the end of the reporting period in which the transfers occurred. There 
were no transfers between any levels in 2014, 2013 or 2012.  

As further discussed in Note 17, the Partnership has accrued for unvested phantom units and vested and unvested profits interests as a 
liability and adjusts that liability on a recurring basis based on the market price of the Partnership’s common units each balance sheet 
date. Such fair value measurements are deemed Level 1 measurements.  

For assets and liabilities measured on a non-recurring basis during the year, accounting guidance requires quantitative disclosures 
about the fair value measurements separately for each major category. See Note 5 for a discussion of impairment charges to reduce the 
net book value of assets held for sale to fair value less cost to sell. Such fair value measurements were based on negotiated sales 
prices, or sales of comparable sites, and represent level 2 measurements.  

Financial Instruments  
The fair value of the Partnership’s accounts receivable, notes receivable, and accounts payable approximated their carrying values as 
of December 31, 2014 and 2013 due to the short-term maturity of these instruments. The fair value of the Partnership’s long-term debt 
approximated its carrying value as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 due to the frequency with which interest rates are reset based on 
changes in prevailing interest rates. The fair value of debt, classified as a Level 2 measurement, was estimated using an income 
approach by discounting future cash flows at estimated current cost of funding rates, which incorporate the credit risk of the 
Partnership.  

16. Partners’ Capital  
In connection with the IPO, the Predecessor Entities contributed the Contributed Assets to the Partnership. In consideration of the 
Contributed Assets, the Partnership issued and/or distributed to the Predecessor an aggregate of 625,000 common units and 7,525,000 
subordinated units. The Partnership issued 6,900,000 common units, inclusive of the underwriter’s over-allotment option, in 
connection with the IPO.  

In January 2013, the Partnership issued an aggregate of 1,044 units to members of the board of directors of the Partnership’s General 
Partner related to director compensation.  

In December 2013, the Partnership issued 3,565,000 common units, inclusive of the underwriter’s over-allotment option, for $26.90 
per unit, resulting in proceeds of $91.4 million, net of underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses. The Partnership 
used the proceeds to reduce indebtedness outstanding under its Credit Facility and for general purposes.  

In December 2013, DMI purchased 6,304 common units from the Partnership and granted them to Joseph V. Topper, Jr., the then 
Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer of the General Partner. The grant was made to Mr. Topper, at his election, in lieu 
of cash compensation due to Mr. Topper as consideration for his services to the Partnership as Chief Executive Officer of the General 
Partner. DMI paid the Partnership the grant-date fair value of the units, which was $0.2 million.  

In March 2014, the Partnership issued 4,172 common units to certain members of the board of directors of the Partnership’s General 
Partner as part of their 2013 compensation.  

In March 2014, 92,683 common units were issued (net of units withheld for income taxes) to employees of DMI as a result of the 
vesting of phantom units (see Note 17 for additional information).  

In September 2014, the Partnership issued 4,140,000 common units, inclusive of the underwriter’s over-allotment option, for $33.99 
per unit, resulting in proceeds of $135.0 million, net of underwriting discounts and commissions and offering expenses. The 
Partnership used the proceeds to reduce indebtedness outstanding under its Credit Facility.  

In October 2014, 101,456 common units were issued (net of units withheld for income taxes) to employees of DMI and 2,045 
common units were issued to former members of the board of directors of the General Partner as a result of the vesting of phantom 
units (see Note 17 for additional information).  

F-40 

 
 
  
17. Equity-Based Incentive Compensation  
In connection with the IPO, the General Partner adopted the Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan (the “Plan”), a long-
term incentive plan for employees, officers, consultants and directors of the General Partner and any of its affiliates, including DMI, 
who perform services for the Partnership. The maximum number of common units that may be delivered with respect to awards under 
the Plan is 1,505,000. Generally, the Plan provides for grants of restricted units, unit options, performance awards, phantom units, unit 
awards, unit appreciation rights, distribution equivalent rights, and other unit-based awards, with various limits and restrictions 
attached to these awards on a grant-by-grant basis. The Plan is administered by the board of directors of the Partnership’s General 
Partner or a committee thereof, which is referred to as the Plan Administrator.  

The Plan Administrator may terminate or amend the Plan at any time with respect to any common units for which a grant has not yet 
been made. The Plan Administrator also has the right to alter or amend the Plan or any part of the Plan from time to time, including 
increasing the number of common units that may be granted, subject to unitholder approval as required by the exchange upon which 
common units are listed at that time; however, no change in any outstanding grant may be made that would adversely affect the rights 
of a participant with respect to awards granted to a participant prior to the effective date of such amendment or termination, except 
that the board of directors of our General Partner may amend any award to satisfy the requirements of Section 409A of the Internal 
Revenue Code. The Plan will expire on the tenth anniversary of its approval, when common units are no longer available under the 
Plan for grants or upon its termination by the Plan Administrator, whichever occurs first.  

In March 2014, the Partnership contributed its investments in its operating subsidiaries and certain other assets and liabilities to LGP 
Operations LLC (“LGP Operations”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Partnership. Also in March 2014, LGP Operations granted 
profits interests to certain employees of DMI, which are represented by Class B Units in LGP Operations. Upon vesting, Class B 
Unitholders will be entitled to receive cash distributions proportionate to those received by common unitholders. Class B Units are 
redeemable two years after they were granted, subject to certain limitations, for cash or common units at the discretion of the board of 
directors of the General Partner.  

Because the Class B Units are an interest in the equity of LGP Operations, they represent a noncontrolling interest from the 
perspective of the Partnership. As such, the Class B Units are presented as a noncontrolling interest on the balance sheet and the Class 
B Unitholders’ interest in the net income of LGP Operations is presented as net income attributable to noncontrolling interests on the 
statement of operations.  

Awards to Employees of Affiliates  
The following is a summary of the award activity for 2014:  

Non-vested at beginning of period   

Granted 
Forfeited 
Vested on March 14, 2014 (a)  
Vested on October 1, 2014 (b) 

Non-vested at end of period 

Phantom 
Units  
  433,373  
  132,180  
(4,829) 
 (143,954) 
 (167,535) 

  249,235  

Profits 
Interests  
  —    
  18,689  
  —    
  —    
  (9,622) 

  9,067  

(a)  Of the phantom units that vested on March 14, 2014, 51,271 common units were withheld for taxes.  
(b)  Of the phantom units that vested on October 1, 2014, 66,079 common units were withheld for taxes.  

Awards generally vest 33.0% on March 15 of the year following the year of grant, 33.0% on March 15 of the second year following 
the year of grant, and 34.0% on March 15 of the third year following the year of grant.  

In connection with the October 1, 2014 GP purchase, as specified in the Lehigh Gas Partners LP Executive Income Continuity Plan, 
all unvested awards held by covered persons vested on October 1, 2014. As a result, 167,535 phantom units and 9,622 profits interests 
granted to employees of DMI vested. The incremental charge recorded in 2014 associated with the accelerated vesting of these awards 
was approximately $4.5 million, included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

F-41 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
The fair value of the non-vested awards outstanding at December 31, 2014 was $10.4 million. Compensation expense for 2014 and 
2013 was $9.4 million and $3.1 million, respectively. Unrecognized compensation expense related to the non-vested awards is 
expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.7 years.  

It is the intent of the Partnership to settle the phantom units upon vesting by issuing common units and to settle the profits interests 
upon conversion by the grantee by issuing common units, as permitted under the Plan. However, the awards may be settled in cash at 
the discretion of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

Since the Partnership grants awards to employees of DMI, and since the grants may be settled in cash, unvested phantom units and 
vested and unvested profits interests are measured at fair value at each balance sheet reporting date and the cumulative compensation 
cost recognized is classified as a liability, which is included in accrued expenses and other current liabilities on the balance sheet.  

Termination Benefits Payable under Executive Income Continuity Plan  
In addition to the incremental charge associated with the accelerated vesting of awards discussed above, the Partnership accrued $2.4 
million of severance and benefit costs in 2014 related to certain covered persons under the Executive Income Continuity Plan who 
have terminated their employment. Such costs are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.  

Awards to Members of the Board of Directors  
During 2014, the Partnership also granted the following awards to members of the board of directors of the General Partner as a 
portion of director compensation:  

Non-vested at beginning of period   

Granted 
Vested on March 14, 2014 
Vested on October 1, 2014 

Non-vested at end of period 

Phantom 
Units  
  —    
  12,358  
  (4,172) 
  (2,045) 

  6,141  

Profits 
Interests  
  —    
  15,429  
  —    
 (15,429) 

  —    

In connection with the October 1, 2014 GP Purchase, all unvested awards held by members of the former board of directors of the 
General Partner vested on October 1, 2014. As a result, 2,045 phantom units and 15,429 profits interests vested. The incremental 
charge recorded in 2014 associated with the accelerated vesting of these awards was approximately $0.1 million, included in selling, 
general and administrative expenses.  

On November 10, 2014, 6,141 phantom units were granted to the non-employee members of the current board of directors as a part of 
director compensation. Such grants will vest November 10, 2015. The fair value of these awards at December 31, 2014, was $0.2 
million. Unrecognized compensation expense related to the non-vested awards is expected to be recognized through November 10, 
2015.  

18. Income Taxes  
Certain legal entities of the Partnership do not pay income taxes because their income is taxed to the owners. For those entities, the 
reported amount of their assets, net of the reported amount of their liabilities, was less than the related tax basis of their assets and 
liabilities by $3.7 million and $4.5 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Net earnings for financial statement purposes 
may differ significantly from taxable income reportable to the owners as a result of this basis difference and the allocation of taxable 
income under the Partnership Agreement.  

The non-taxed entities of the Partnership are subject to a statutory requirement that non-qualifying income cannot exceed 10% of total 
gross income for the calendar year. If the amount of its non-qualifying income exceeds the statutory limit, these entities would be 
subject to income tax on their earnings as if they were taxable corporations. The non-qualifying income did not exceed the statutory 
limit in any period for the non-taxed entities.  

F-42 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
The provision (benefit) for income taxes consisted of (in thousands):  

Year Ended 
December 31, 2014  

Year Ended 
December 31, 2013  

Period October 31, 2012 to 
December 31, 2012  

Current expense 

Federal 
State 

$ 

Total current income tax expense 

Deferred expense (benefit) 

Federal 
State 

Total deferred income tax 

expense (benefit) 

Total income tax expense 

(benefit) 

$ 

141  
265  

406  

(1,963) 
203  

(1,760) 

$ 

1,111  
121  

1,232  

(2,329) 
(619) 

(2,948) 

$ 

(1,354) 

$ 

(1,716) 

$ 

269  
73  

342  

—    
—    

—    

342  

The significant components of deferred tax assets and liabilities are as follows (in thousands).  

Deferred income tax assets 
Deferred rent income 
Deferred rent expense 
Lease financing obligations 
Asset retirement obligations   
Above market lease liability   
Other 

Total deferred income tax assets 
Valuation allowance  

Net deferred income tax assets 

Deferred income tax liabilities 

Deferred rent income 
Property and equipment 
Intangible assets 
Other 

Total deferred income tax liabilities 

December 31, 
2014  

December 31, 
2013  

$ 

—    
241  
24,737  
6,057  
2,053  
496  

33,584  
(5,675) 

27,909  

271  
39,563  
10,650  
372  

50,856  

$ 

319  
365  
23,936  
787  
1,024  
61  

26,492  
(7,093) 

19,399  

—    
22,964  
1,274  
—    

24,238  

Net deferred income tax liabilities 

$ 

22,947  

$ 

4,839  

Deferred tax assets of $0.8 million are included in other current assets at December 31, 2014.  

At December 31, 2012, net deferred tax assets totaling $9.9 million were fully reserved against with a valuation allowance. During 
2013, based on updates to the purchase price allocations for the 2012 and 2013 acquisitions and subsequent assignment of assets and 
liabilities by the Partnership to LGWS, the Partnership recorded a deferred tax liability of $7.8 million. Concurrent with the 
recognition of the $7.8 million net deferred tax liability noted above, and based on the expected reversal of the cumulative temporary 
differences and anticipated future earnings as of December 31, 2013, the Partnership released $2.8 million of the valuation allowance 
during 2013.  

F-43 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
In 2014, based on updates to the purchase price allocations for the 2014 acquisitions, the Partnership recorded net deferred tax 
liabilities of $19.9 million. In addition, as a result of conforming operating and accounting policies around asset retirement obligations 
to CST’s policies, the Partnership recorded a deferred tax asset of $5.2 million. Based on the increase in net deferred tax liabilities and 
the expected reversal of the cumulative temporary differences and anticipated future earnings as of December 31, 2014, the 
Partnership released an additional $1.4 million of the valuation allowance during 2014.  

The valuation allowance at December 31, 2014 relates primarily to the uncertainty of the availability of future profits to realize the tax 
benefit of the existing deductible temporary differences. The Partnership believes that it will generate sufficient future taxable income 
to realize the benefits related to the remaining deferred tax asset. The valuation allowance decrease primarily relates to the change in 
the net deferred tax position. In conjunction with the Partnership’s ongoing review of its actual results and anticipated future earnings, 
the Partnership continuously reassesses the possibility of releasing the valuation allowance on its deferred tax assets. It is reasonably 
possible that a significant portion of the valuation allowance will be released within the next twelve months.  

The difference between the actual income tax provision and income taxes computed by applying the U.S. federal statutory rate to 
earnings (losses) before income taxes is attributable to the following (in thousands):  

Consolidated income (loss) from 

continuing operations before income 
taxes – all domestic 

(Income) loss from continuing 

operations before income taxes 
of non-taxable entities 
Income (loss) from continuing 

operations before income taxes of 
LGWS 

Federal income taxes at statutory rate 
Increase (decrease) due to: 

Nondeductible expenses 
Change in valuation 

allowance 

State income taxes, net of 
federal income tax 
benefit and other 

Year Ended 
December 31, 2014  

Year Ended 
December 31, 2013  

Period October 31, 2012 to 
December 31, 2012  

$ 

(7,525) 

$ 

16,354  

$ 

(1,014 ) 

325  

(15,638) 

1,037   

(7,200) 

(2,448) 

3,094  

(1,972) 

716  

244  

—    

(1,543) 

(28) 

(417) 

23   

8   

—     

332   

2   

342   

Total income tax expense   

$ 

(1,354) 

$ 

(1,716) 

$ 

The Partnership files income tax returns with the U.S. federal government as well as the many state jurisdictions in which it operates. 
The statute remains open for tax years 2014 and 2013; therefore, these years remain subject to examination by federal, state and local 
jurisdiction authorities.  

19. Net Income per Limited Partnership Unit  
Under the Partnership Agreement, the holders of the Partnership’s IDRs have an interest in distributions from the Partnership that are 
increasing percentages starting at 15% of quarterly distributions out of the operating surplus (as defined) in excess of $0.5031 per 
limited partner unit. The Partnership’s undistributed net income is generally allocable pro rata to the common and subordinated 
unitholders, except where common unitholders have received cash distributions in excess of the subordinated unitholders. In that 
circumstance, net income is allocated to the common unitholders first in support of such excess cash distribution paid to them and the 
remainder of the net income is allocable pro rata to the common and subordinated unitholders. Losses are generally allocable pro rata 
to the common and subordinated unitholders in accordance with the Partnership Agreement unless a loss would create or increase a 
Partnership deficit balance, in which case the loss would be allocated to the General Partner.  

F-44 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
In addition to the common and subordinated units, the Partnership has identified the IDRs as participating securities and computes 
income per unit using the two-class method under which any excess of distributions declared over net income shall be allocated to the 
partners based on their respective sharing of income specified in the Partnership Agreement. Net income per unit applicable to limited 
partners (including common and subordinated unitholders) is computed by dividing the limited partners’ interest in net income, after 
deducting any incentive distributions, by the weighted-average number of outstanding common and subordinated units. There were no 
participating IDRs for 2013. However, the distributions declared since March 2014 exceeded the threshold and so IDRs participated in 
these distributions as summarized on the statements of operations.  

The following provides a reconciliation of net income and the allocation of net income to the limited partners’ interest for purposes of 
computing net income per limited partner unit for the following periods (in thousands, except unit and per unit amounts):  

Numerator: 
Distributions paid (a) 
Allocation of distributions in excess of net 

income (b) 

Limited partners’ interest in net income (loss) -

basic   

Adjustment for phantom units 

Limited partners’ interest in net income (loss) -

diluted 

Denominator: 
Weighted average limited partnership units 

outstanding-basic 

Adjustment for phantom units 

Weighted average limited partnership units 

outstanding-diluted 

Year Ended December 31, 2014 

Year Ended December 31, 2013 

Common 
Units 

Subordinated 
Units 

Common 
Units 

Subordinated 
Units 

$ 

25,544  

$  15,652  

$  12,999  

$  12,999  

(29,532) 

(18,071) 

(3,842) 

(4,086) 

(3,988) 
—    

(2,419) 
—    

(3,988) 

(2,419) 

9,157  
29  

9,186  

8,913  
—    

8,913  

  12,402,938  
—    

  7,525,000  
—    

  7,731,471  
48,886  

  7,525,000  
—    

  12,402,938  

  7,525,000  

  7,780,357  

  7,525,000  

Net income per limited partnership unit-basic 

Net income per limited partnership unit-diluted 

$ 

$ 

(0.32) 

(0.32) 

$ 

$ 

(0.32) 

(0.32) 

$ 

$ 

1.18  

1.18  

$ 

$ 

1.18  

1.18  

(a)  Distributions paid per unit were $2.08 and $1.7273 for 2014 and 2013, respectively.  
(b)  Allocation of distributions in excess of net income is based on a pro rata proportion to the common and subordinated units as 

outlined in the Partnership Agreement.  

In accordance with the Partnership Agreement, on February 25, 2015, the Partnership declared a quarterly dividend, to be paid from 
the operating surplus, totaling $13.3 million or $0.5425 per unit.  

20. Related-Party Transactions  
Revenues from Related Parties  
Revenues from CST  
On October 1, 2014, the Partnership entered into a fuel distribution agreement and a lease agreement with CST that covers sites owned 
by the Partnership and operated by CST. For 2014, these agreements mandate the terms related to the sites acquired in the Nice N 
Easy acquisition that CST has operated since November 1, 2014. The fuel distribution and lease agreements have initial 10-year terms 
with 5-year renewal terms until the agreements are terminated as permitted in the agreements. The fuel distribution agreement 
provides the Partnership with a fixed mark-up per gallon ($0.06 in the case of the Nice N Easy sites) and the lease agreement is a triple 
net lease.  

F-45 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Revenues from fuel sales, cost of revenues from fuel sales and rent income amounted to $13.2 million, $12.8 million and $0.4 million 
in 2014, respectively. Amounts receivable from CST totaled $3.2 million at December 31, 2014, which included $2.2 million for fuel 
sales and $1.0 million as reimbursement for certain transaction costs associated with the sale of the General Partner. Such transaction 
costs have been excluded from the statements of operations.  

Revenues from LGO  
In connection with the IPO, the Partnership and LGO entered into a PMPA Franchise Agreement pursuant to which the Partnership is 
the exclusive distributor of motor fuel to all sites operated by LGO for a period of 15 years. The Partnership has the right to impose 
the brand of fuel that is distributed to LGO. There are no minimum volume requirements that LGO is required to satisfy. The 
Partnership charged LGO the “dealer tank wagon” prices for each grade of product in effect at the time title to the product passes to 
LGO. The Partnership leases certain motor fuel stations to LGO under operating leases.  

The Partnership entered into an Amendment to the PMPA Franchise Agreement, effective as of October 1, 2014 (the “Wholesale Fuel 
Supply Agreement Amendment”) pursuant to which the pricing terms were amended. Prior to the Wholesale Fuel Supply Agreement 
Amendment, the agreement provided that the Partnership charge LGO dealer tank wagon pricing, which provided for a variable cent-
per-gallon margin for each grade of product in effect at the time title to the product passed to LGO. The Wholesale Fuel Supply 
Agreement Amendment amends the pricing terms of the agreement to provide for rack plus pricing and was approved by the former 
conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner.  

On May 28, 2014, the Partnership entered into a Master Lease Agreement (the “Lease”) with LGO, with an effective date of June 1, 
2014 which consolidated all of the individual leases then in effect into a single master lease. The terms and conditions of the Lease are 
substantially identical to the existing individual leases except as follows: the Partnership’s right to terminate each lease was deleted, 
and in its place, each party has the right to either sever, in the case of LGO, up to 7.0% of the leased premises each year, or recapture, 
in the case of the Partnership, up to 5.0% of the leased premises each year from the Lease at any time prior to the fifth anniversary of 
the commencement date (as defined) for such leased premises. Each party’s right is cumulative in that if a party does not sever or 
recapture, as applicable, the full amount of leased premises for which it has rights, then the non-utilized amount may be carried 
forward into subsequent years. The Lease was approved by the former conflicts committee of the General Partner of the Partnership.  

Revenues from fuel sales, cost of revenues from fuel sales and rent income were as follows (in thousands):  

Revenues from fuel sales to related parties 
Rent income from related parties 
Cost of revenues from fuel sales to related parties 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  
$  676,210   
20,404   
660,147   

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  
912,629  
25,337  
887,804  

$ 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  
145,168     
3,228     
139,736     

$ 

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  
$  621,139  
5,708  
609,371  

Amounts receivable from LGO totaled $10.3 million and $16.3 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

Revenues from Other Related Parties  
In addition, the Partnership sells motor fuel and leases property to a related party owned by a relative of the Chief Executive Officer of 
the General Partner. Total revenues amounted to $75.8 million, $103.2 million, $17.7 million, and $88.8 million for 2014, 2013, the 
period from October 31 to December 31, 2012 and the period from January 1 to October 30, 2012, respectively. Accounts receivable 
amounted to $0.4 million and $1.1 million as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

F-46 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assumption of Commission Agreements and Subleases from LGO  
Prior to September 1, 2013, the Partnership leased certain sites to LGO, which, in turn, subleased certain of these sites (the 
“Subleases”) to third party commission agents (the “Commission Sites”) and entered into commission agreements with the agents to 
sell motor fuel on behalf of LGO to retail customers (the “Commission Agreements”). In connection with the Commission 
Agreements, LGO also purchased motor fuel from a subsidiary of the Partnership at wholesale prices. Effective September 1, 2013, 
the Partnership assumed the Commission Agreements and Subleases from LGO and terminated its leases with LGO for the 
Commission Sites. As a result, the Partnership records the retail sale of motor fuels to the end customer and accrues a commission 
payable to the commission agent at the Commission Sites. Further, the Partnership records inventory from the time of the purchase of 
motor fuels from third party suppliers until the retail sale to the end customer at these sites. The Commission Sites generate non-
qualifying income for federal income tax purposes that is recorded in Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc., the taxable subsidiary of 
the Partnership as further described below. The Partnership paid LGO $3.5 million (the “Purchase Price”) for the Subleases and 
Commission Agreements and $2.1 million for the motor fuel inventory. Because the transaction was between entities under common 
control, the assets and liabilities assumed were recorded at LGO’s book value. The Purchase Price is presented as a distribution from 
partners’ capital.  

Sale of Wholesale Fuel Supply Contracts and Assignment of Leases to DMI  
The Partnership, DMI and LGO consummated a series of transactions pursuant to which DMI acquired, for an aggregate purchase 
price of $5.7 million and an earn-out in the amount of $0.8 million if DMI renews a single contract expiring in 2015, the wholesale 
fuel supply rights for 78 locations in Pennsylvania and New York previously supplied by the Partnership and the fuel supply rights of 
the Partnership to such sites was terminated. In addition, subleases for 12 of the sites, previously leased to the Partnership, were 
assigned to DMI or its affiliates. The terms of the transaction were approved by the former conflicts committee of the board of 
directors of the General Partner. The volume associated with these sites for 2013 was approximately 94 million gallons, of which 
approximately 36 million gallons represents sales to a sub-wholesaler at a de minimus margin and approximately 28 million gallons 
relates to a single contract expiring in 2015. In addition, rent expense for the leasehold sites included in the transaction exceeded the 
rent income on an annual basis by approximately $0.6 million for 2013.  

Because this was a transaction between entities under common control, the Partnership derecognized the assets and liabilities 
associated with the wholesale fuel supply contracts and leases and recognized the approximate $2.3 million excess of the purchase 
price over the net book value of the net assets divested as a contribution to partners’ capital on October 1, 2014.  

Operating Leases of Gasoline Stations as Lessee  
The Partnership and the Predecessor Entity lease certain motor fuel stations from related parties under cancelable operating leases. 
Rent expense under these agreements was $1.1 million, $1.0 million, $0.2 million, and $0.6 million for 2014, 2013, the period 
October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 and the period January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, respectively.  

Omnibus Agreement and Management Fees  
In connection with the IPO, the Partnership entered into an Omnibus Agreement (the “Original Omnibus Agreement”) by and among 
the Partnership, the General Partner, DMI, LGO and, for limited purposes, Joseph V. Topper, Jr. Pursuant to the Original Omnibus 
Agreement, among other things, DMI provides the Partnership and the General Partner with management, administrative and 
operating services. These services include accounting, tax, legal, internal audit, risk management and compliance, environmental 
compliance and remediation management oversight, treasury, information technology and other administrative functions. As the 
Partnership does not have any employees, DMI provides the Partnership with personnel necessary to carry out the services provided 
under the Original Omnibus Agreement and any other services necessary to operate the Partnership’s business. The Original Omnibus 
Agreement also provides for certain indemnification obligations between DMI and the Partnership, which is inclusive of the 
environmental liabilities. The Partnership incurred $6.1 million, $6.6 million and $1.1 million in management fees under the Original 
Omnibus Agreement in 2014, 2013 and for the period October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012, respectively, classified as 
selling, general and administrative expenses in the statements of operations.  

F-47 

 
 
  
The Partnership entered into an Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, dated October 1, 2014, by and among the Partnership, 
the General Partner, DMI, CST Services, LGO and Mr. Topper (the “Amended Omnibus Agreement”), which amends and restates the 
Original Omnibus Agreement. The terms of the Amended Omnibus Agreement were approved by the former conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner.  

General. Pursuant to the Amended Omnibus Agreement, CST Services agrees, among other things, to provide, or cause to be 
provided, to the Partnership the management services previously provided by DMI on substantially the same terms and conditions as 
were applicable to DMI under the Original Omnibus Agreement. Pursuant to the terms of a transition services agreement by and 
between DMI and CST Services, DMI provided the management services it provided under the Original Omnibus Agreement to the 
Partnership on behalf of CST Services through December 31, 2014.  

The initial term of the Amended Omnibus Agreement is five years and will automatically renew for additional one year terms unless 
any party provides written notice to the other parties 180 days prior to the end of the then current term. The Partnership has the right to 
terminate the agreement at any time upon 180 days’ prior written notice.  

Rights of First Refusal. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, that for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, if 
(a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates have the opportunity to acquire assets used, or a controlling interest in 
any business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, and (b) the assets or 
businesses proposed to be acquired have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate, then Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their 
controlled affiliates will offer such acquisition opportunity to the Partnership and give the Partnership a reasonable opportunity to 
acquire, at the same price plus any related transaction costs and expenses, such assets or business, either before or promptly after the 
consummation of such acquisition by Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates. The decision to acquire or not acquire any 
such assets or businesses requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. Any assets 
or businesses that the Partnership does not acquire pursuant to the right of first refusal may be acquired and operated by Mr. Topper, 
DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates.  

Rights of First Offer. The Amended Omnibus Agreement provides that Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO agree, and are required to cause 
their controlled affiliates to agree, for so long as Mr. Topper is an officer or director of the General Partner or CST, to notify the 
Partnership of their desire to sell any of their assets or businesses if (a) Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or any of their controlled affiliates, 
decides to attempt to sell (other than to another controlled affiliate of Mr. Topper, DMI or LGO) any assets used, or any interest in any 
business primarily engaged, in the wholesale motor fuel distribution or retail gas station operation businesses, to a third party and 
(b) the assets or businesses proposed to be sold have a value exceeding $5.0 million in the aggregate. Prior to selling such assets or 
businesses to a third party, Mr. Topper, DMI and LGO are required to negotiate with the Partnership exclusively and in good faith for 
a reasonable period of time in order to give the Partnership an opportunity to enter into definitive documentation for the purchase and 
sale of such assets or businesses on terms that are mutually acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and the 
Partnership. If the Partnership and Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates have not entered into a letter of intent or a 
definitive purchase and sale agreement with respect to such assets or businesses within such period, Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, and their 
controlled affiliates, have the right to sell such assets or businesses to a third party following the expiration of such period on any 
terms that are acceptable to Mr. Topper, DMI, LGO, or their controlled affiliates, and such third party. The decision to acquire or not 
to acquire assets or businesses pursuant to this right requires the approval of the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the 
General Partner.  

In accordance with the Amended Omnibus Agreement, the Partnership is required to pay CST a management fee, which is initially 
$670,000 per month plus a variable fee of between zero and $0.003 per gallon for wholesale fuel distribution and $0.015 per gallon for 
retail fuel distribution at sites we operate. In addition, and subject to certain restrictions on CST’s ability to incur third-party fees, 
costs, taxes and expenses, the Partnership is required to reimburse CST and the General Partner for all reasonable out-of-pocket third-
party fees, costs, taxes and expenses incurred by CST or the General Partner on the Partnership’s behalf in connection with providing 
the services required to be provided by CST under the Amended Omnibus Agreement. The Partnership incurred $2.5 million in 
management fees under the Amended Omnibus Agreement in 2014, classified as selling, general and administrative expenses in the 
statements of operations.  

F-48 

 
 
  
The Predecessor Entity charged management fees to its affiliates and these amounts are included as contra-expense amounts in selling, 
general and administrative expenses in the statements of operations. The amounts recorded for these management fees were 
approximately $3.7 million for the period January 1, 2012 through October 31, 2012. These management fees reflect the allocation of 
certain overhead expenses of the Predecessor Entity and include costs of centralized corporate functions, such as legal, accounting, 
information technology, insurance and other corporate services. The allocation methods for these costs included: estimates of the costs 
and level of support attributable to its affiliates for legal, accounting, and usage and headcount for information technology.  

PMI Staffing Agreement  
Similar to the Partnership, PMI has no employees. The management and store personnel are generally employees of a related party, 
Pinehurst Services LLC, to which PMI pays a management fee. PMI incurred $15.4 million with this related party in 2014, which is 
primarily included in operating expenses on the statement of operations.  

Maintenance and Environmental Costs  
Certain maintenance and environmental monitoring and remediation activities are undertaken by a related party of the Partnership as 
approved by the conflicts committee of the board of directors of the General Partner. The Partnership incurred $1.1 million and $0.3 
million with this related party in 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

Aircraft Usage Costs  
The Partnership uses aircraft owned by a group of individuals that includes the CEO and another member of the board of directors of 
the General Partner as approved by the disinterested members of the former conflicts committee of the board of directors of the 
General Partner. The Partnership incurred $0.3 million and $0.1 million for the use of these aircraft in 2014 and 2013, respectively.  

Sites Previously Leased by LGO  
Through February 2013, the Partnership leased certain sites in the Cleveland, Ohio market to LGO, who operated or contracted to 
third parties the operation of the motor fuel and convenience store activities conducted at those sites. In March 2013, the Partnership 
entered into an agreement with an unrelated third-party to lease and conduct the convenience store activities at 19 of these sites in the 
Cleveland, Ohio market. Concurrently, the lease agreements between the Partnership and LGO were amended to reflect the lease of 
just the motor fuel-related property and terminate the lease of the convenience store. Through December 31, 2013, the unrelated third-
party paid $1.7 million directly to LGO for its agreement to vacate the convenience store space. Although the Partnership did not 
participate directly in the transaction between LGO and the unrelated third-party, it was deemed for accounting purposes to have an 
intermediary role in the transaction in its capacity as the entity controlling these sites (either through fee ownership or leasehold 
interest). Accordingly, the Partnership recorded $1.7 million in deferred initial direct costs, which is included in other assets, and a 
corresponding deferred rent income liability, which is included in other liabilities, both of which are recognized ratably over the term 
of the leases with the unrelated third-party lessee.  

The retail motor fuel business at these sites was operated by LGO through August 31, 2013. These sites were included in the 
Commission Sites operated by the Partnership commencing September 1, 2013 (see Note 1 for additional information). As such, the 
leases with LGO were terminated on September 1, 2013. The transaction was approved by the conflicts committee of the board of 
directors of the General Partner.  

In addition, the Partnership terminated leases with LGO at the Commission Sites and closed sites, which resulted in a write-off of 
deferred rent income of $0.4 million, classified as a charge against rent income from related parties.  

Advances to Related Parties  
As disclosed in Note 4, during 2013, the Partnership paid $1.7 million of additional purchase price consideration for the net working 
capital of the Express Lane Retail Business. Because the net working capital was transferred to LGO at the acquisition date, LGO 
repaid this amount to the Partnership in October 2013. The payment to the Express Lane sellers was classified as a financing activity 
on the statement of cash flows and is included within the line item “Advances (to) from affiliates.”  

F-49 

 
 
  
During 2014, the Partnership advanced $5.4 million to Zimri in order for them to begin operating on their own. Of that amount, $3.0 
million has been repaid and the balance is expected to be repaid in 2015.  

Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Equity  
In December 2008, the Predecessor Entity issued non-voting preferred member interests of $12.0 million to certain related individuals. 
From February 2011 through August 31, 2012, the holders of preferred member interests received semi-annual dividend payments at a 
rate of 12.0%. Pursuant to an amendment in May 2012, the dividend rate increased to 15.0% for the period from September 1, 2012 
through August 31, 2013. Dividend payments, including accrued dividends, are recorded as interest expense. For the period from 
January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012, the Predecessor Entity recorded interest expense of $1.3 million.  

In September 2012, the Predecessor Entity and the holders entered into an agreement for an aggregate $13.0 million payment, 
including $12.0 million for the face value of the mandatorily redeemable preferred equity and $1.0 million in consideration for a 
contractual modification to provide for the early cancellation and redemption of the mandatorily redeemable preferred equity (the 
cancellation payment), along with dividend payments accrued and unpaid at the applicable rate discussed above. As the cancellation 
payment was simultaneous with the IPO, the $1.0 million cancellation payment was accounted for on the Predecessor’s financial 
statements in the accounting period corresponding with the closing of the IPO. The mandatorily redeemable preferred equity was 
redeemed in full, at par, with proceeds from the IPO.  

F-50 

 
 
  
21. Segment Reporting  
Effective September 1, 2013, the Partnership engages in both the wholesale and retail distribution of motor fuels, primarily gasoline 
and diesel fuel. Effective with the PMI acquisition, the Partnership now also engages in the operation of convenience stores and 
branded quick-service restaurants. Given these changes, the Partnership conducts its business in two segments: 1) the wholesale 
segment and 2) the retail segment. The Partnership’s measure of segment profit or loss is net income. Unallocated costs consist 
primarily of interest expense associated with the Credit Facility, selling, general and administrative expenses, income taxes and the 
elimination of the retail segment’s intersegment cost of revenues from fuel sales against the wholesale segment’s intersegment 
revenues from fuel sales. The profit in ending inventory generated by the intersegment fuel sale is also eliminated. Total assets by 
segment are not presented as the chief operating decision maker does not currently assess performance or allocate resources based on 
that data. Financial data for each segment is as follows (in thousands):  

Revenues from fuel sales to external customers 
Intersegment revenues from fuel sales 
Revenues from food and merchandise sales   
Rent income 
Other revenue 

Total revenues 
Depreciation and amortization 
Interest expense   
Income tax expense (benefit) 
Net income (loss)  
Expenditures for long-lived assets 

Revenues from fuel sales to external customers 
Intersegment revenues from fuel sales 
Rent income 
Other revenue 

Total revenues 
Depreciation and amortization 
Interest expense   
Income tax expense (benefit) 
Net income (loss)  
Expenditures for long-lived assets 

Wholesale 
$2,104,128  
204,276  
—    
38,498  
837  

  2,347,739  
28,955  
(5,678) 
—    
40,589  
124,078  

Wholesale 
$1,824,568  
57,988  
40,210  
1,676  

  1,922,766  
20,288  
(4,479) 
—    
41,841  
49,144  

Year Ended December 31, 2014 

Retail 
$449,344  
  —    
  71,307  
4,760  
443  

  525,854  
4,026  
(503) 
  —    
2,761  
  53,456  

Unallocated 
$  —    
  (204,276) 
—    
—    
—    

  (204,276) 
—    
(10,450) 
(1,354) 
(49,521) 
—    

Year Ended December 31, 2013 

Retail 
$  68,238  
  —    
1,367  
  —    

  69,605  
675  
(169) 
  —    
623  
149  

Unallocated 
$  —    
(57,988) 
—    
—    

(57,988) 
—    
(9,534) 
(1,716) 
(24,394) 
—    

Consolidated 
$2,553,472  
—    
71,307  
43,258  
1,280  

  2,669,317  
32,981  
(16,631) 
(1,354) 
(6,171) 
177,534  

Consolidated 
$1,892,806  
—    
41,577  
1,676  

  1,936,059  
20,963  
(14,182) 
(1,716) 
18,070  
49,293  

F-51 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
22. Interim Financial Results (unaudited)  
Interim financial results for the Partnership for 2014 and 2013 were as follows (in thousands, except per unit data):  

Total revenues 
Operating income (loss) 
Net income (loss)  
Net income (loss) attributable to 

partners 

Net income (loss) per common and 
subordinated unit—basic (a) 
Net income (loss) per common and 
subordinated unit—diluted (a) 

Total revenues 
Operating income  
Net income 
Limited partners’ interest in net 

income 

Net income per common and 

subordinated unit—basic (a) 

Net income per common and 

subordinated unit—diluted (a) 

Year Ended 
December 31, 2014  
2,669,317  
$ 
8,640  
(6,171) 

Fourth Quarter 
2014  
587,363 (b) 

$ 

(6,850) (c) 
(13,654) (c) 

$ 

Third Quarter 
2014  
832,742  
8,430  
4,163  

Second Quarter 
2014  

$ 

767,191  
1,574  
1,892  

$ 

First Quarter 
2014  
482,021  
5,486  
1,428  

(6,162) 

(13,637) (c) 

4,155  

1,892  

1,428  

$ 

$ 

(0.32) 

(0.32) 

$ 

$ 

(0.60) 

(0.60) 

$ 

$ 

0.21  

0.21  

$ 

$ 

0.10  

0.10  

$ 

$ 

0.07  

0.07  

Year Ended 
December 31, 2013  
1,936,059  
$ 
30,177  
18,070  

$ 

Fourth Quarter 
2013  
485,428  
6,113  
3,920  

$ 

Third Quarter 
2013  
490,574  
7,457  
4,924  

Second Quarter 
2013  

$ 

488,196  
9,109  
5,469  

$ 

First Quarter 
2013  
471,861  
7,498  
3,757  

18,070  

1.18  

1.18  

$ 

$ 

3,920  

0.25  

0.25  

$ 

$ 

4,924  

5,469  

3,757  

$ 

$ 

0.33  

0.33  

$ 

$ 

0.36  

0.36  

$ 

$ 

0.25  

0.25  

(a)  The sum of the quarterly amounts may not equal annual earnings per unit due to changes in the number of units outstanding 

during the year or rounding.  

(b)  The decrease compared to the third quarter of 2014 was due primarily to the reduction in selling prices during the fourth quarter.  
(c)  The decrease compared to the third quarter of 2014 was due primarily to an increase in equity-based compensation (see 

Note 17), expense and termination benefits.  

F-52 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
23. Supplemental Cash Flow Information  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions, were as follows (in thousands):  

Accounts receivable 
Accounts receivable from related parties 
Inventories 
Environmental indemnification asset 
Other current assets 
Other assets 
Accounts payable  
Motor fuel taxes payable 
Income taxes payable 
Accrued expenses and other current liabilities 
Environmental liability 
Other long-term liabilities   

Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net 

of acquisitions  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

$ 

$ 

2,619  
4,511  
3,235  
164  
(67) 
(3,218) 
(20,438) 
2,553  
—    
478  
(164) 
(95) 

$ 

(1,684) 
(8,377) 
(2,085) 
(61) 
(1,452) 
(396) 
4,288  
(2,269) 
(333) 
1,313  
61  
(1,342) 

12,850   
(6,720 ) 
—     
—     
(503 ) 
(542 ) 
(3,207 ) 
(519 ) 
342   
(671 ) 
—     
1,111   

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

$ 

5,015  
(28,061) 
1,049  
3,795  
(1,038) 
(246) 
6,355  
2,197  
—    
2,490  
(3,929) 
1,417  

$ 

(10,422) 

$ 

(12,337) 

$ 

2,141   

$ 

(10,956) 

F-53 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
  
 
 
 
 
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
Other supplemental cash flow information was as follows (in thousands):  

Supplemental Disclosure of Cash Flow 

Information: 

Cash paid for interest 
Cash paid for income taxes 

Supplemental Schedule of Noncash Investing 

and Financing Activities 

Sales of property and equipment in 
Section 1031 like-kind exchange 
transaction 

Removal of property and equipment and 

capital lease obligation for sites 
terminated from Getty lease 

Change in estimate of asset retirement 

obligations 

Lessor direct costs incurred and deferred 
rent income recorded related to lease 
transaction between affiliate and 
unrelated third-party 

Issuance of note payable in connection 

with purchase of sites 

Issuance of note payable in connection 

with Rocky Top acquisition 

Issuance of capital lease obligations and 

recognition of asset retirement 
obligation related to Getty lease 
Issuance of capital lease obligation 
Expiration of call option related to lease 

financing 

Transfer of assets from Predecessor Entity 

to affiliate 

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2014  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
For the Year 
Ended 
December 31, 
2013  

Consolidated 
CrossAmerica 
Partners LP 
Period from 
October 31 to 
December 31, 
2012  

Combined 
Lehigh Gas 
Entities 
(Predecessor) 
Period from 
January 1 to 
October 30, 
2012  

14,134  
632  

11,375  
1,729  

2,355     
—       

11,134 
—   

Increase (Decrease) in Assets / Liabilities 

(4,670) 

—    

(1,613) 

16,877  

—    

—    

—    

—    
—    

—    

—    

(2,138) 

1,087  

1,700  

1,000  

26,250  

360  
—    

—    

—    

—       

—       

—       

—       

—       

—       

4,823     
—       

—       

—       

—   

—   

—   

—   

—   

—   

33,930 
1,313 

3,375 

588 

24. Subsequent Events  
Drop Down of Fuel Supply Interests  
Pursuant to a Contribution Agreement (the “Contribution Agreement”), dated December 16, 2014, by and among the Partnership, CST 
and CST Services, an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of CST, on January 2, 2015, the Partnership completed the acquisition, 
effective January 1, 2015, of a 5% limited partner interest in CST Fuel Supply LP (“CST Fuel”) from CST Services in exchange for 
1,497,946 newly issued common units representing limited partner interests in the Partnership.  

CST Fuel owns 100% of the issued and outstanding membership interests in CST Marketing and Supply LLC (“CSTMS”), which is a 
party to a fuel supply agreement with a subsidiary of Valero Energy Corporation. The general partner of CST Fuel is CST USA, Inc., 
a wholly owned subsidiary of CST. CST will continue to indirectly own a 95% limited partner interest in CST Fuel.  

F-54 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Immediately prior to closing and effective January 1, 2015, CST Services, CSTMS and certain subsidiaries of CST Services 
(“Purchasers”) entered into a fuel distribution agreement (the “Fuel Distribution Agreement”), pursuant to which CSTMS, on an 
annual basis, sells and delivers to the Purchasers, and the Purchasers will purchase, for at least 10 years no less than 1.57 billion 
gallons of branded and unbranded motor fuels at a fixed net margin of $0.05 per gallon for resale at retail sites operated by such 
Purchasers.  

The terms of the Contribution Agreement and Fuel Distribution Agreement were approved by the independent conflicts committee of 
the board of directors of the General Partner. The conflicts committee retained independent legal and financial advisors to assist in 
evaluating and negotiating the transaction. In approving the transaction, the conflicts committee based its decisions in part on an 
opinion from its independent financial advisor that the consideration to be paid by the Partnership is fair to the unaffiliated common 
unitholders of the Partnership from a financial point of view.  

Landmark Acquisition  
On January 8, 2015, CST and the Partnership jointly purchased 22 convenience stores from Landmark Industries. The stores operate 
under the Timewise brand name and provide Shell branded fuel. The sites are all owned fee simple and are located primarily in the 
San Antonio area. The Partnership purchased all of the real property and underground storage tanks as well as certain wholesale fuel 
distribution assets for $43.5 million, funded by borrowings under its Credit Facility. CST purchased the remaining personal property, 
working capital and the convenience store operations. The allocation of the purchase price between the Partnership and CST is subject 
to adjustment following completion of real property appraisals.  

LGWS leases the acquired real estate to CST under triple net leases and LGW distributes wholesale fuel to CST under long term 
agreements with a fuel gross profit margin of approximately 5 cents per gallon.  

The Partnership has not yet completed its preliminary valuation analysis and thus a purchase price allocation is not available.  

Erickson Acquisition  
On February 17, 2015, the Partnership completed the acquisition of all of the outstanding capital stock of Erickson Oil Products, Inc. 
(“Erickson”) and certain related assets from GST Non-Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust 
UAD May 12, 2010 and GST Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 2010 
(collectively, the “Stock Sellers”), and certain real estate from Team Investments, LLC (together with the Stock Sellers, the “Sellers”). 
The purchase price was $85 million, subject to certain post-closing adjustments and indemnification and environmental remediation 
escrows, and was funded by borrowings under the Credit Facility.  

Erickson operates 64 convenience store sites located in Minnesota, Michigan, Wisconsin and South Dakota, with a concentration in 
the Minneapolis / St. Paul region, of which 59 are owned in fee simple and five are leased under long term leases. Certain of the 
convenience store sites owned in fee simple are subject to a right of first refusal held by SuperAmerica Franchising LLC, which, if 
exercised, will reduce the purchase price.  

In connection with the purchase, the Sellers and certain principals of the Sellers have agreed, subject to certain exceptions, not to 
engage directly or indirectly in the retail petroleum or convenience store business in a designated geographic area surrounding the 
purchased convenience store sites for a period of four years following the closing.  

The Partnership has not yet completed its preliminary valuation analysis and thus a purchase price allocation is not available.  

Grant of Equity-Based Incentive Compensation  
Effective as of October 1, 2014, Mr. Topper is an employee of CST and no longer an employee of DMI. The disinterested members of 
the former board of directors of the General Partner authorized a grant of 10,997 profits interests pursuant to the Lehigh Gas Partners 
LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan to Mr. Topper, based on compensation earned by Mr. Topper for services rendered from January 1, 
2014 through September 30, 2014. The profits interests will be granted in March 2015 and will be fully vested upon grant.  

F-55 

 
 
  
SCHEDULE II—VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS  

CrossAmerica Partners LP and Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor)  
For the Years Ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, for the Period October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012  
and for the Period January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012  
(In thousands)  

Description 
Year ended December 31, 2014 
Allowance for doubtful accounts—accounts 

receivable 

Valuation allowance—deferred tax assets 

Year ended December 31, 2013 
Allowance for doubtful accounts—accounts 

receivable 

Valuation allowance—deferred tax assets 

October 31, 2012 through December 31, 2012 
Allowance for doubtful accounts—accounts 

receivable 

Valuation allowance—deferred tax assets (a)  

Lehigh Gas Entities (Predecessor) 
January 1, 2012 through October 30, 2012 
Allowance for doubtful accounts—accounts 

receivable 

Balance at 
Beginning of 
Period  

Charged 
to 
Costs and 
Expenses  

Charged to 
Other 
Accounts  

Recoveries  

Write 
Offs  

Balance at 
End of 
Period  

$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 

$ 
$ 

$ 

136  
7,093  

$ 
618  
$  (1,418) 

$  —    
$  —    

$  —    
$  —    

$ —     
$ —     

$ 
754  
$  5,675  

—    
9,893  

$ 
161  
$  (1,543) 

$  —    
$ 

$  —    
(1,257)  $  —    

$  25   
$ —     

$ 
136  
$  7,093  

—    
—    

$  —    
332  
$ 

$  —    
9,561  
$ 

$  —    
$  —    

$ —     
$ —     

$  —    
$  9,893  

37  

$ 

87  

$  —    

$  —    

$ —     

$ 

124  

(a)  Upon the contribution from the Predecessor Entity, which was a non-taxable entity, to the Partnership, which has a wholly 

owned taxable subsidiary, a valuation allowance was recorded to fully reserve against the deferred tax assets recorded for the 
temporary differences between book and tax bases in the net liabilities contributed. As such, the valuation allowance recorded at 
the time of the contribution was charged against the Partners’ Capital—affiliates account of the Partnership. During 2013, in 
connection with updates to purchase accounting and subsequent assignment of assets and liabilities by the Partnership to LGWS, 
the Partnership reviewed its cumulative permanent and temporary differences. As a result of that review, the Partnership 
increased its net deferred tax assets that existed on the date of the contribution of net assets by the Predecessor to the Partnership 
by $8.5 million and increased its valuation allowance to fully offset these additional net deferred tax assets. The amount charged 
to other accounts has been revised to reflect this increase.  

F-56 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
  
  
  
  
  
 
  
EXHIBIT INDEX  

    2.1 

    2.2 

    2.3 

    2.4 

    3.1 

    3.2 

    3.3 

    3.4 

    3.5 

  10.1 

Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of March 20, 2014, among Pinehurst Petroleum, LLC, PMI Merger Sub, Inc., 
Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated, Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated Employee Stock Ownership Trust and Ronald R. 
Hare, in his capacity as Representative (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on  
Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 1, 2014) 

Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of May 1, 2014, by and between Petroleum Marketers, Incorporated and Zimri 
Holdings, LLC (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica 
Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 1, 2014) 

Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of December 9, 2014, by and among Minnesota Nice Holdings Inc., CrossAmerica 
Partners LP, GST Non-Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 2010, 
and GST Exempt Family Trust Created Under the David B. Erickson Revocable Trust UAD May 12, 2010 (incorporated 
by reference herein to Exhibit 2.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the 
Securities and Exchange Commission on December 12, 2014) 

Real Estate Purchase and Sale Agreement, dated as of December 9, 2014, by and among Minnesota Nice Holdings Inc., 
CrossAmerica Partners LP and Team Investments LLC (incorporated by reference herein to Exhibit 2.2 to the Current 
Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 
December 12, 2014) 

Certificate of Limited Partnership of Lehigh Gas Partners LP (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the 
Registration Statement on Form S-1 for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission 
on May 11, 2012) 

Certificate of Amendment to Certificate of Limited Partnership of Lehigh Gas Partners LP (incorporated by referenced to 
Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on October 3, 2014) 

First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Lehigh Gas Partners LP, dated October 30, 2012, by 
and among Lehigh Gas Partners LP, Lehigh Gas GP LLC and Lehigh Gas Corporation (incorporated herein by reference 
to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on October 30, 2012) 

First Amendment to First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of Lehigh Gas Partners LP, dated as 
of October 1, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica 
Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

Second Amendment to First Amended and Restated Agreement of Limited Partnership of CrossAmerica Partners LP, 
dated as of December 3, 2014 (incorporated by reference herein to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for 
CrossAmerica Partners, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on December 9, 2014) 

Omnibus Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2012, by and among Lehigh Gas Partners LP, Lehigh Gas GP LLC, Lehigh 
Gas Corporation, Lehigh Gas—Ohio, LLC and Joseph V. Topper, Jr. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the 
Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 
October 30, 2012) 

 
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  10.2 

  10.3 

  10.4 

  10.5 

  10.6 

  10.7 

  10.8 

  10.9 

  10.10 

Amendment to Omnibus Agreement, dated as of May 1, 2014, by and among Lehigh Gas Partners LP, Lehigh Gas GP 
LLC and Lehigh Gas Corporation (incorporated by referenced to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for 
CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 1, 2014) 

Amended and Restated Omnibus Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2014, by and among Lehigh Gas Partners LP, 
Lehigh Gas GP LLC, Lehigh Gas Corporation, CST Services, LLC and Lehigh Gas-Ohio LLC (incorporated by 
reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities 
and Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of March 4, 2014, by and among the Lehigh Gas Partners 
LP, as borrower, certain domestic subsidiaries of Lehigh Gas Partners LP from time to time party thereto, the lenders 
party thereto, and RBS Citizens, N.A., KeyBank National Association and Wells Fargo Securities, LLC, as joint lead 
arranger and joint bookrunners, Wells Fargo Bank National Association, as co-syndication agent, and KeyBank 
National Association, as co-syndication agent, Bank of America, N.A., as documentation agent, Manufacturers and 
Traders Trust Company, as documentation agent, Manufacturers And Traders Trust Company, as co-documentation 
agent, Royal Bank of Canada, as co-documentation agent, Santander Bank, N.A., as co-documentation agent, and 
Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania, as administrative agent for the lenders thereunder (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on March 6, 2014) 

First Amendment to Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of July 2, 2014, by and among Lehigh 
Gas Partners LP, certain domestic subsidiaries of Lehigh Gas Partners LP, the lenders from party thereto, and Citizens 
Bank of Pennsylvania, as administration agent for the lenders thereunder (incorporated by referenced to Exhibit 10.1 
to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on July 3, 2014) 

Waiver, Second Amendment to Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement and Joinder, dated as of September 
30, 2014, by and among Lehigh Gas Partners LP and Lehigh Gas Wholesale Services, Inc., certain domestic 
subsidiaries of Lehigh Gas Partners LP, the lenders party thereto, and Citizens Bank of Pennsylvania, as 
administrative agent for the lenders thereunder (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on 
Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2012, by and among CrossAmerica Partners LP, Joseph V. 
Topper, Jr., John B. Reilly, III, Lehigh Gas Corporation and certain of their affiliates (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on October 30, 2012) 

PMPA Franchise Agreement, dated as of October 30, 2012, by and between Lehigh Gas Wholesale LLC and Lehigh 
Gas—Ohio, LLC (Supply Agreement with Lehigh Gas—Ohio, LLC) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the 
Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 
October 30, 2012) 

Amendment to PMPA Franchise Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2014, by and between Lehigh Gas Wholesale 
LLC and Lehigh Gas-Ohio, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for 
CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

Voting Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2014, by and among CST Brands, Inc., Joseph V. Topper, Jr., The 2004 
Irrevocable Agreement of Trust of Joseph V. Topper, Sr. and Lehigh Gas Corporation (incorporated by reference to 
Exhibit 10.4 to the Current Report on Form 8-K For CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and 
Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  10.11 

  10.12 

  10.13 

  10.14 

  10.15 

  10.16 

  10.17 

  10.18 

  10.19 

  10.20 * 

  10.21 * 

Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Registration 
Statement on Form S-1 for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on 
August 10, 2012) 

Form of Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan Award Agreement for Phantom Units granted to 
executive officers from March 15, 2013 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6(a) to the Annual Report on 
Form 10-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 28, 2013) 

Form of Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan Award Agreement for Profits Interests with immediate 
vesting, granted to directors from March 14, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6(b) to the Current Report 
on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 10, 2014) 

Form of Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan Award Agreement for Profits Interests, with one year 
vesting, granted to directors from March 14, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6(c) to the Current Report 
on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 10, 2014) 

Form of Lehigh Gas Partners LP 2012 Incentive Award Plan Award Agreement for Profits Interests granted to 
executive officers from March 14, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6(d) to the Current Report on  
Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 10, 2014) 

Lehigh Gas Partners LP Executive Income Continuity Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Current 
Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on  
May 30, 2014) 

Lehigh Gas Partners LP Executive Income Continuity Plan (as amended) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to 
the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange 
Commission on November 7, 2014) 

Employment Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2014, by and between CST Services LLC and Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to the Current Report on Form 8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed 
with the Securities and Exchange Commission on October 3, 2014) 

Master Lease Agreement, dated May 28, 2014, by and among LGP Realty Holdings LP, Lehigh Gas Wholesale 
Services, Inc. and Lehigh Gas-Ohio, LLC. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 
8-K for CrossAmerica Partners LP, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 30, 2014) 

GP Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 6, 2014, by and among Lehigh Gas Corporation, CST GP, LLC and CST 
Brands, Inc. 

IDR Purchase Agreement, dated as of August 6, 2014, by and among The 2004 Irrevocable Agreement of Trust of 
Joseph V. Topper, Sr., The 2008 Irrevocable Agreement of Trust of John B. Reilly, Jr., CST Brands Holdings, LLC 
and CST Brands, Inc. 

  10.22 * 

Contribution Agreement, dated as of December 16, 2014, by and among CST Brands, Inc., CST Services LLC and 
CrossAmerica Partners LP 

  21.1 * 

  23.1 * 

  31.1 * 

  31.2 * 

List of Subsidiaries of CrossAmerica Partners LP 

Consent of Grant Thornton LLP 

Certification of Principal Executive Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC as required by Rule 13a-14(a) of the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934 

Certification of Principal Financial Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC as required by Rule 13a-14(a) of the Securities 
Exchange Act of 1934 

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  32.1*† 

  32.2*† 

Certification of Principal Executive Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350 

Certification of Principal Financial Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350 

101.INS * 

XBRL Instance Document 

101.SCH * 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document 

101.CAL * 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document 

101.LAB * 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document 

101.PRE * 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document 

101.DEF * 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document 

*  Filed herewith  
†  Not considered to be “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 or otherwise subject to the 

liabilities of that section.  

 
 
  
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  
CERTIFICATION  

Exhibit 31.1  

I, Joseph V. Topper, Jr., certify that:  
1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of CrossAmerica Partners LP (the “registrant”);  
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact 
necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading 
with respect to the period covered by this report;  
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all 
material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods 
presented in this report;  
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures 
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in 
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:  
(a)  Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under 
our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is 
made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;  

(b)  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be 

designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;  

(c)  Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our 

conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this 
report based on such evaluation; and  

(d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the 
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has 
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; 
and  

5. 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over 
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons 
performing the equivalent functions):  
(a)  All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting 

which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial 
information; and  

(b)  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the 

registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.  

Date: February 27, 2015  

 /s/ JOSEPH V. TOPPER, JR. 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
Chief Executive Officer and President 
CrossAmerica GP LLC 
(as General Partner of CrossAmerica Partners LP) 

 
 
  
  
  
CERTIFICATION  

Exhibit 31.2  

I, Mark L. Miller, certify that:  
1. 

2. 

3. 

4. 

I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of CrossAmerica Partners LP (the “registrant”);  
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact 
necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading 
with respect to the period covered by this report;  
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all 
material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods 
presented in this report;  
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures 
(as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in 
Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:  
(a)  Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under 
our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is 
made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;  

(b)  Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be 

designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the 
preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;  

(c)  Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our 

conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this 
report based on such evaluation; and  

(d)  Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the 
registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has 
materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; 
and  

5. 

The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over 
financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons 
performing the equivalent functions):  
(a)  All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting 

which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial 
information; and  

(b)  Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the 

registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.  

Date: February 27, 2015  

 /S/ MARK L. MILLER 
Mark L. Miller 
Chief Financial Officer 
CrossAmerica GP LLC 
(as General Partner of CrossAmerica Partners LP) 

 
 
  
  
  
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO  
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,  
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO  
SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002  

Exhibit 32.1  

In connection with this Annual Report on Form 10-K of CrossAmerica Partners LP (the “Partnership”) for the year ended 
December 31, 2014, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Joseph V. Topper, Jr., 
Chief Executive Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC, the general partner of the Partnership, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, as 
adopted pursuant to § 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 that, to my knowledge:  

(1)  The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as 

amended; and  

(2)  The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of 

operations of the Partnership.  

Date: February 27, 2015  

 /s/ JOSEPH V. TOPPER, JR. 
Joseph V. Topper, Jr. 
Chief Executive Officer and President 
CrossAmerica GP LLC 
(as General Partner of CrossAmerica Partners LP) 

 
 
  
  
  
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO  
18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,  
AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO  
SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002  

Exhibit 32.2  

In connection with this Annual Report on Form 10-K of CrossAmerica Partners LP (the “Partnership”) for the year ended 
December 31, 2014, as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Mark L. Miller, Chief 
Financial Officer of CrossAmerica GP LLC, the general partner of the Partnership, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. § 1350, as adopted 
pursuant to § 906 of the Sarbanes- Oxley Act of 2002 that, to my knowledge:  

(1)  The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as 

amended; and  

(2)  The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of 

operations of the Partnership.  

Date: February 27, 2015  

 /s/ MARK L. MILLER 
Mark L. Miller 
Chief Financial Officer 
CrossAmerica GP LLC 
(as General Partner of CrossAmerica Partners LP)